]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - doc/misc/org.texi
3a840d3b90c10eb33879a5214a501605d1e0f8e3
[gnu-emacs] / doc / misc / org.texi
1 \input texinfo
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename ../../info/org
4 @settitle The Org Manual
5
6 @set VERSION 6.20c
7 @set DATE January 2009
8
9 @dircategory Emacs
10 @direntry
11 * Org Mode: (org). Outline-based notes management and organizer
12 @end direntry
13
14 @c Version and Contact Info
15 @set MAINTAINERSITE @uref{http://orgmode.org,maintainers webpage}
16 @set AUTHOR Carsten Dominik
17 @set MAINTAINER Carsten Dominik
18 @set MAINTAINEREMAIL @email{carsten at orgmode dot org}
19 @set MAINTAINERCONTACT @uref{mailto:carsten at orgmode dot org,contact the maintainer}
20 @c %**end of header
21 @finalout
22
23 @c Macro definitions
24
25 @c Subheadings inside a table.
26 @macro tsubheading{text}
27 @ifinfo
28 @subsubheading \text\
29 @end ifinfo
30 @ifnotinfo
31 @item @b{\text\}
32 @end ifnotinfo
33 @end macro
34
35 @copying
36 This manual is for Org (version @value{VERSION}).
37
38 Copyright @copyright{} 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008, 2009 Free Software Foundation
39
40 @quotation
41 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
42 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
43 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
44 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
45 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the license
46 is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License.''
47
48 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have the freedom to copy and
49 modify this GNU manual. Buying copies from the FSF supports it in
50 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
51
52 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
53 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
54 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
55 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
56 @end quotation
57 @end copying
58
59 @titlepage
60 @title The Org Manual
61
62 @subtitle Release @value{VERSION}
63 @author by Carsten Dominik
64
65 @c The following two commands start the copyright page.
66 @page
67 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
68 @insertcopying
69 @end titlepage
70
71 @c Output the table of contents at the beginning.
72 @contents
73
74 @ifnottex
75 @node Top, Introduction, (dir), (dir)
76 @top Org Mode Manual
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @menu
82 * Introduction:: Getting started
83 * Document Structure:: A tree works like your brain
84 * Tables:: Pure magic for quick formatting
85 * Hyperlinks:: Notes in context
86 * TODO Items:: Every tree branch can be a TODO item
87 * Tags:: Tagging headlines and matching sets of tags
88 * Properties and Columns:: Storing information about an entry
89 * Dates and Times:: Making items useful for planning
90 * Capture:: Creating tasks and attaching files
91 * Agenda Views:: Collecting information into views
92 * Embedded LaTeX:: LaTeX fragments and formulas
93 * Exporting:: Sharing and publishing of notes
94 * Publishing:: Create a web site of linked Org files
95 * Miscellaneous:: All the rest which did not fit elsewhere
96 * Extensions:: Add-ons for Org mode
97 * Hacking:: How to hack your way around
98 * History and Acknowledgments:: How Org came into being
99 * Main Index:: An index of Org's concepts and features
100 * Key Index:: Key bindings and where they are described
101
102 @detailmenu
103 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
104
105 Introduction
106
107 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
108 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
109 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
110 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
111 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
112
113 Document Structure
114
115 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
116 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
117 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
118 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
119 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
120 * Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place
121 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
122 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
123 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
124 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
125 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
126
127 Archiving
128
129 * ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive
130 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
131
132 Tables
133
134 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
135 * Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables
136 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
137 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
138 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
139 * Org Plot:: Plotting from org tables
140
141 The spreadsheet
142
143 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
144 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
145 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
146 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
147 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
148 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
149 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
150 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
151
152 Hyperlinks
153
154 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
155 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
156 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
157 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
158 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
159 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
160 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
161 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
162
163 Internal links
164
165 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
166
167 TODO Items
168
169 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
170 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
171 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
172 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
173 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
174 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
175
176 Extended use of TODO keywords
177
178 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
179 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
180 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
181 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
182 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
183 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
184 * TODO dependencies:: When one tasks needs to wait for others
185
186 Progress logging
187
188 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
189 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
190
191 Tags
192
193 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
194 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
195 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
196
197 Properties and Columns
198
199 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
200 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
201 * Property searches:: Matching property values
202 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
203 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
204 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
205
206 Column view
207
208 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
209 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
210 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
211
212 Defining columns
213
214 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
215 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
216
217 Dates and Times
218
219 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
220 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
221 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
222 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
223 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
224 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
225
226 Creating timestamps
227
228 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
229 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
230
231 Deadlines and scheduling
232
233 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
234 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
235
236 Capture
237
238 * Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
239 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
240
241 Remember
242
243 * Setting up Remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
244 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
245 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
246 * Refiling notes:: Moving a note or task to a project
247
248 Agenda Views
249
250 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
251 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
252 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
253 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
254 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
255 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
256 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
257
258 The built-in agenda views
259
260 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
261 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
262 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
263 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
264 * Keyword search:: Finding entries by keyword
265 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
266
267 Presentation and sorting
268
269 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
270 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
271 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
272
273 Custom agenda views
274
275 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
276 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
277 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
278 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files
279 * Using the agenda elsewhere:: Using agenda information in other programs
280
281 Embedded LaTeX
282
283 * Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters
284 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
285 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
286 * Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing
287 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
288
289 Exporting
290
291 * Markup rules:: Which structures are recognized?
292 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
293 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
294 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
295 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
296 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
297 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
298 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
299 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
300
301 Markup rules
302
303 * Document title:: How the document title is determined
304 * Headings and sections:: The main structure of the exported document
305 * Table of contents:: If, where, how to create a table of contents
306 * Initial text:: Text before the first headline
307 * Lists:: Plain lists are exported
308 * Paragraphs:: What determines beginning and ending
309 * Literal examples:: Source code and other examples
310 * Include files:: Include the contents of a file during export
311 * Tables exported:: Tables are exported richly
312 * Inlined images:: How to inline images during export
313 * Footnote markup::
314 * Emphasis and monospace:: To bold or not to bold
315 * TeX macros and LaTeX fragments:: Create special, rich export.
316 * Horizontal rules:: A line across the page
317 * Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported
318
319 HTML export
320
321 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
322 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
323 * Links:: Transformation of links for HTML
324 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
325 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
326 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
327 * Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
328
329 LaTeX and PDF export
330
331 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
332 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
333 * Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in LaTeX output
334 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
335 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
336
337 Publishing
338
339 * Configuration:: Defining projects
340 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
341 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
342
343 Configuration
344
345 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
346 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
347 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
348 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
349 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
350 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
351 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
352
353 Sample configuration
354
355 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
356 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
357
358 Miscellaneous
359
360 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
361 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
362 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
363 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
364 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
365 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
366 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
367 * Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly
368
369 Interaction with other packages
370
371 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
372 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
373
374 Extensions
375
376 * Extensions in the contrib directory:: These come with the Org distro
377 * Other extensions:: These you have to find on the web.
378
379 Hacking
380
381 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
382 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
383 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
384 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
385 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
386 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
387
388 Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
389
390 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving
391 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
392 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
393 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
394
395 @end detailmenu
396 @end menu
397
398 @node Introduction, Document Structure, Top, Top
399 @chapter Introduction
400 @cindex introduction
401
402 @menu
403 * Summary:: Brief summary of what Org does
404 * Installation:: How to install a downloaded version of Org
405 * Activation:: How to activate Org for certain buffers
406 * Feedback:: Bug reports, ideas, patches etc.
407 * Conventions:: Type-setting conventions in the manual
408 @end menu
409
410 @node Summary, Installation, Introduction, Introduction
411 @section Summary
412 @cindex summary
413
414 Org is a mode for keeping notes, maintaining TODO lists, and doing
415 project planning with a fast and effective plain-text system.
416
417 Org develops organizational tasks around NOTES files that contain
418 lists or information about projects as plain text. Org is
419 implemented on top of Outline mode, which makes it possible to keep the
420 content of large files well structured. Visibility cycling and
421 structure editing help to work with the tree. Tables are easily created
422 with a built-in table editor. Org supports TODO items, deadlines,
423 time stamps, and scheduling. It dynamically compiles entries into an
424 agenda that utilizes and smoothly integrates much of the Emacs calendar
425 and diary. Plain text URL-like links connect to websites, emails,
426 Usenet messages, BBDB entries, and any files related to the projects.
427 For printing and sharing of notes, an Org file can be exported as a
428 structured ASCII file, as HTML, or (TODO and agenda items only) as an
429 iCalendar file. It can also serve as a publishing tool for a set of
430 linked web pages.
431
432 An important design aspect that distinguishes Org from for example
433 Planner/Muse is that it encourages to store every piece of information
434 only once. In Planner, you have project pages, day pages and possibly
435 other files, duplicating some information such as tasks. In Org,
436 you only have notes files. In your notes you mark entries as tasks,
437 label them with tags and timestamps. All necessary lists like a
438 schedule for the day, the agenda for a meeting, tasks lists selected by
439 tags etc are created dynamically when you need them.
440
441 Org keeps simple things simple. When first fired up, it should
442 feel like a straightforward, easy to use outliner. Complexity is not
443 imposed, but a large amount of functionality is available when you need
444 it. Org is a toolbox and can be used in different ways, for
445 example as:
446
447 @example
448 @r{@bullet{} outline extension with visibility cycling and structure editing}
449 @r{@bullet{} ASCII system and table editor for taking structured notes}
450 @r{@bullet{} ASCII table editor with spreadsheet-like capabilities}
451 @r{@bullet{} TODO list editor}
452 @r{@bullet{} full agenda and planner with deadlines and work scheduling}
453 @r{@bullet{} environment to implement David Allen's GTD system}
454 @r{@bullet{} a basic database application}
455 @r{@bullet{} simple hypertext system, with HTML and LaTeX export}
456 @r{@bullet{} publishing tool to create a set of interlinked webpages}
457 @end example
458
459 Org's automatic, context sensitive table editor with spreadsheet
460 capabilities can be integrated into any major mode by activating the
461 minor Orgtbl mode. Using a translation step, it can be used to maintain
462 tables in arbitrary file types, for example in La@TeX{}. The structure
463 editing and list creation capabilities can be used outside Org with
464 the minor Orgstruct mode.
465
466 @cindex FAQ
467 There is a website for Org which provides links to the newest
468 version of Org, as well as additional information, frequently asked
469 questions (FAQ), links to tutorials etc. This page is located at
470 @uref{http://orgmode.org}.
471
472 @page
473
474
475 @node Installation, Activation, Summary, Introduction
476 @section Installation
477 @cindex installation
478 @cindex XEmacs
479
480 @b{Important:} @i{If Org is part of the Emacs distribution or an
481 XEmacs package, please skip this section and go directly to
482 @ref{Activation}.}
483
484 If you have downloaded Org from the Web, either as a distribution @file{.zip}
485 or @file{.tar} file, or as a GIT archive, you must take the following steps
486 to install it: Go into the unpacked Org distribution directory and edit the
487 top section of the file @file{Makefile}. You must set the name of the Emacs
488 binary (likely either @file{emacs} or @file{xemacs}), and the paths to the
489 directories where local Lisp and Info files are kept. If you don't have
490 access to the system-wide directories, you can simply run Org directly from
491 the distribution directory by adding the @file{lisp} subdirectory to the
492 Emacs load path. To do this, add the following line to @file{.emacs}:
493
494 @example
495 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/lisp" load-path))
496 @end example
497
498 @noindent
499 If you plan to use code from the @file{contrib} subdirectory, do a similar
500 step for this directory:
501
502 @example
503 (setq load-path (cons "~/path/to/orgdir/contrib/lisp" load-path))
504 @end example
505
506 @b{XEmacs users now need to install the file @file{noutline.el} from
507 the @file{xemacs} sub-directory of the Org distribution. Use the
508 command:}
509
510 @example
511 @b{make install-noutline}
512 @end example
513
514 @noindent Now byte-compile the Lisp files with the shell command:
515
516 @example
517 make
518 @end example
519
520 @noindent If you are running Org from the distribution directory, this is
521 all. If you want to install into the system directories, use
522
523 @example
524 make install
525 make install-info
526 @end example
527
528 @noindent Then add to @file{.emacs}:
529
530 @lisp
531 ;; This line only if Org is not part of the X/Emacs distribution.
532 (require 'org-install)
533 @end lisp
534
535 Do not forget to activate Org as described in the following section.
536
537 @node Activation, Feedback, Installation, Introduction
538 @section Activation
539 @cindex activation
540 @cindex autoload
541 @cindex global key bindings
542 @cindex key bindings, global
543
544 @iftex
545 @b{Important:} @i{If you use copy-and-paste to copy lisp code from the
546 PDF documentation as viewed by some PDF viewers to your .emacs file, the
547 single quote character comes out incorrectly and the code will not work.
548 You need to fix the single quotes by hand, or copy from Info
549 documentation.}
550 @end iftex
551
552 Add the following lines to your @file{.emacs} file. The last three lines
553 define @emph{global} keys for the commands @command{org-store-link},
554 @command{org-agenda}, and @command{org-iswitchb} - please choose suitable
555 keys yourself.
556
557 @lisp
558 ;; The following lines are always needed. Choose your own keys.
559 (add-to-list 'auto-mode-alist '("\\.org\\'" . org-mode))
560 (global-set-key "\C-cl" 'org-store-link)
561 (global-set-key "\C-ca" 'org-agenda)
562 (global-set-key "\C-cb" 'org-iswitchb)
563 @end lisp
564
565 Furthermore, you must activate @code{font-lock-mode} in Org
566 buffers, because significant functionality depends on font-locking being
567 active. You can do this with either one of the following two lines
568 (XEmacs user must use the second option):
569 @lisp
570 (global-font-lock-mode 1) ; for all buffers
571 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-font-lock) ; Org buffers only
572 @end lisp
573
574 @cindex Org mode, turning on
575 With this setup, all files with extension @samp{.org} will be put
576 into Org mode. As an alternative, make the first line of a file look
577 like this:
578
579 @example
580 MY PROJECTS -*- mode: org; -*-
581 @end example
582
583 @noindent which will select Org mode for this buffer no matter what
584 the file's name is. See also the variable
585 @code{org-insert-mode-line-in-empty-file}.
586
587 Many commands in Org work on the region if the region is active. To make use
588 of this, you need to have @code{transient-mark-mode} (@code{zmacs-regions} in
589 XEmacs) turned on. In Emacs 23 this is the default, in Emacs 22 you need to
590 do this yourself with
591
592 @lisp
593 (transient-mark-mode 1)
594 @end lisp
595
596 @node Feedback, Conventions, Activation, Introduction
597 @section Feedback
598 @cindex feedback
599 @cindex bug reports
600 @cindex maintainer
601 @cindex author
602
603 If you find problems with Org, or if you have questions, remarks, or ideas
604 about it, please mail to the Org mailing list @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org}.
605 If you are not a member of the mailing list, your mail will be reviewed by a
606 moderator and then passed through to the list.
607
608 For bug reports, please provide as much information as possible,
609 including the version information of Emacs (@kbd{C-h v emacs-version
610 @key{RET}}) and Org (@kbd{C-h v org-version @key{RET}}), as well as
611 the Org related setup in @file{.emacs}. If an error occurs, a
612 backtrace can be very useful (see below on how to create one). Often a
613 small example file helps, along with clear information about:
614
615 @enumerate
616 @item What exactly did you do?
617 @item What did you expect to happen?
618 @item What happened instead?
619 @end enumerate
620 @noindent Thank you for helping to improve this mode.
621
622 @subsubheading How to create a useful backtrace
623
624 @cindex backtrace of an error
625 If working with Org produces an error with a message you don't
626 understand, you may have hit a bug. The best way to report this is by
627 providing, in addition to what was mentioned above, a @emph{Backtrace}.
628 This is information from the built-in debugger about where and how the
629 error occurred. Here is how to produce a useful backtrace:
630
631 @enumerate
632 @item
633 Start a fresh Emacs or XEmacs, and make sure that it will load the
634 original Lisp code in @file{org.el} instead of the compiled version in
635 @file{org.elc}. The backtrace contains much more information if it is
636 produced with uncompiled code. To do this, either rename @file{org.elc}
637 to something else before starting Emacs, or ask Emacs explicitly to load
638 @file{org.el} by using the command line
639 @example
640 emacs -l /path/to/org.el
641 @end example
642 @item
643 Go to the @code{Options} menu and select @code{Enter Debugger on Error}
644 (XEmacs has this option in the @code{Troubleshooting} sub-menu).
645 @item
646 Do whatever you have to do to hit the error. Don't forget to
647 document the steps you take.
648 @item
649 When you hit the error, a @file{*Backtrace*} buffer will appear on the
650 screen. Save this buffer to a file (for example using @kbd{C-x C-w}) and
651 attach it to your bug report.
652 @end enumerate
653
654 @node Conventions, , Feedback, Introduction
655 @section Typesetting conventions used in this manual
656
657 Org uses three types of keywords: TODO keywords, tags, and property
658 names. In this manual we use the following conventions:
659
660 @table @code
661 @item TODO
662 @itemx WAITING
663 TODO keywords are written with all capitals, even if they are
664 user-defined.
665 @item boss
666 @itemx ARCHIVE
667 User-defined tags are written in lowercase; built-in tags with special
668 meaning are written with all capitals.
669 @item Release
670 @itemx PRIORITY
671 User-defined properties are capitalized; built-in properties with
672 special meaning are written with all capitals.
673 @end table
674
675 @node Document Structure, Tables, Introduction, Top
676 @chapter Document Structure
677 @cindex document structure
678 @cindex structure of document
679
680 Org is based on outline mode and provides flexible commands to
681 edit the structure of the document.
682
683 @menu
684 * Outlines:: Org is based on Outline mode
685 * Headlines:: How to typeset Org tree headlines
686 * Visibility cycling:: Show and hide, much simplified
687 * Motion:: Jumping to other headlines
688 * Structure editing:: Changing sequence and level of headlines
689 * Archiving:: Move done task trees to a different place
690 * Sparse trees:: Matches embedded in context
691 * Plain lists:: Additional structure within an entry
692 * Drawers:: Tucking stuff away
693 * Footnotes:: How footnotes are defined in Org's syntax
694 * Orgstruct mode:: Structure editing outside Org
695 @end menu
696
697 @node Outlines, Headlines, Document Structure, Document Structure
698 @section Outlines
699 @cindex outlines
700 @cindex Outline mode
701
702 Org is implemented on top of Outline mode. Outlines allow a
703 document to be organized in a hierarchical structure, which (at least
704 for me) is the best representation of notes and thoughts. An overview
705 of this structure is achieved by folding (hiding) large parts of the
706 document to show only the general document structure and the parts
707 currently being worked on. Org greatly simplifies the use of
708 outlines by compressing the entire show/hide functionality into a single
709 command @command{org-cycle}, which is bound to the @key{TAB} key.
710
711 @node Headlines, Visibility cycling, Outlines, Document Structure
712 @section Headlines
713 @cindex headlines
714 @cindex outline tree
715
716 Headlines define the structure of an outline tree. The headlines in
717 Org start with one or more stars, on the left margin@footnote{See
718 the variable @code{org-special-ctrl-a/e} to configure special behavior
719 of @kbd{C-a} and @kbd{C-e} in headlines.}. For example:
720
721 @example
722 * Top level headline
723 ** Second level
724 *** 3rd level
725 some text
726 *** 3rd level
727 more text
728
729 * Another top level headline
730 @end example
731
732 @noindent Some people find the many stars too noisy and would prefer an
733 outline that has whitespace followed by a single star as headline
734 starters. @ref{Clean view} describes a setup to realize this.
735
736 An empty line after the end of a subtree is considered part of it and
737 will be hidden when the subtree is folded. However, if you leave at
738 least two empty lines, one empty line will remain visible after folding
739 the subtree, in order to structure the collapsed view. See the
740 variable @code{org-cycle-separator-lines} to modify this behavior.
741
742 @node Visibility cycling, Motion, Headlines, Document Structure
743 @section Visibility cycling
744 @cindex cycling, visibility
745 @cindex visibility cycling
746 @cindex trees, visibility
747 @cindex show hidden text
748 @cindex hide text
749
750 Outlines make it possible to hide parts of the text in the buffer.
751 Org uses just two commands, bound to @key{TAB} and
752 @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} to change the visibility in the buffer.
753
754 @cindex subtree visibility states
755 @cindex subtree cycling
756 @cindex folded, subtree visibility state
757 @cindex children, subtree visibility state
758 @cindex subtree, subtree visibility state
759 @table @kbd
760 @kindex @key{TAB}
761 @item @key{TAB}
762 @emph{Subtree cycling}: Rotate current subtree among the states
763
764 @example
765 ,-> FOLDED -> CHILDREN -> SUBTREE --.
766 '-----------------------------------'
767 @end example
768
769 The cursor must be on a headline for this to work@footnote{see, however,
770 the option @code{org-cycle-emulate-tab}.}. When the cursor is at the
771 beginning of the buffer and the first line is not a headline, then
772 @key{TAB} actually runs global cycling (see below)@footnote{see the
773 option @code{org-cycle-global-at-bob}.}. Also when called with a prefix
774 argument (@kbd{C-u @key{TAB}}), global cycling is invoked.
775
776 @cindex global visibility states
777 @cindex global cycling
778 @cindex overview, global visibility state
779 @cindex contents, global visibility state
780 @cindex show all, global visibility state
781 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
782 @item S-@key{TAB}
783 @itemx C-u @key{TAB}
784 @emph{Global cycling}: Rotate the entire buffer among the states
785
786 @example
787 ,-> OVERVIEW -> CONTENTS -> SHOW ALL --.
788 '--------------------------------------'
789 @end example
790
791 When @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} is called with a numeric prefix argument N, the
792 CONTENTS view up to headlines of level N will be shown. Note that inside
793 tables, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} jumps to the previous field.
794
795 @cindex show all, command
796 @kindex C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
797 @item C-u C-u C-u @key{TAB}
798 Show all, including drawers.
799 @kindex C-c C-r
800 @item C-c C-r
801 Reveal context around point, showing the current entry, the following heading
802 and the hierarchy above. Useful for working near a location that has been
803 exposed by a sparse tree command (@pxref{Sparse trees}) or an agenda command
804 (@pxref{Agenda commands}). With a prefix argument show, on each
805 level, all sibling headings.
806 @kindex C-c C-x b
807 @item C-c C-x b
808 Show the current subtree in an indirect buffer@footnote{The indirect
809 buffer
810 @ifinfo
811 (@pxref{Indirect Buffers,,,emacs,GNU Emacs Manual})
812 @end ifinfo
813 @ifnotinfo
814 (see the Emacs manual for more information about indirect buffers)
815 @end ifnotinfo
816 will contain the entire buffer, but will be narrowed to the current
817 tree. Editing the indirect buffer will also change the original buffer,
818 but without affecting visibility in that buffer.}. With a numeric
819 prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
820 negative then go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove
821 the previously used indirect buffer.
822 @end table
823
824 When Emacs first visits an Org file, the global state is set to
825 OVERVIEW, i.e. only the top level headlines are visible. This can be
826 configured through the variable @code{org-startup-folded}, or on a
827 per-file basis by adding one of the following lines anywhere in the
828 buffer:
829
830 @example
831 #+STARTUP: overview
832 #+STARTUP: content
833 #+STARTUP: showall
834 @end example
835
836 @noindent
837 Furthermore, any entries with a @samp{VISIBILITY} property (@pxref{Properties
838 and Columns}) will get their visibility adapted accordingly. Allowed values
839 for this property are @code{folded}, @code{children}, @code{content}, and
840 @code{all}.
841 @table @kbd
842 @kindex C-u C-u @key{TAB}
843 @item C-u C-u @key{TAB}
844 Switch back to the startup visibility of the buffer, i.e. whatever is
845 requested by startup options and @samp{VISIBILITY} properties in individual
846 entries.
847 @end table
848
849 @node Motion, Structure editing, Visibility cycling, Document Structure
850 @section Motion
851 @cindex motion, between headlines
852 @cindex jumping, to headlines
853 @cindex headline navigation
854 The following commands jump to other headlines in the buffer.
855
856 @table @kbd
857 @kindex C-c C-n
858 @item C-c C-n
859 Next heading.
860 @kindex C-c C-p
861 @item C-c C-p
862 Previous heading.
863 @kindex C-c C-f
864 @item C-c C-f
865 Next heading same level.
866 @kindex C-c C-b
867 @item C-c C-b
868 Previous heading same level.
869 @kindex C-c C-u
870 @item C-c C-u
871 Backward to higher level heading.
872 @kindex C-c C-j
873 @item C-c C-j
874 Jump to a different place without changing the current outline
875 visibility. Shows the document structure in a temporary buffer, where
876 you can use the following keys to find your destination:
877 @example
878 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
879 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
880 @key{RET} @r{Select this location.}
881 @kbd{/} @r{Do a Sparse-tree search}
882 @r{The following keys work if you turn off @code{org-goto-auto-isearch}}
883 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
884 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
885 u @r{One level up.}
886 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
887 q @r{Quit}
888 @end example
889 See also the variable@code{org-goto-interface}.
890 @end table
891
892 @node Structure editing, Archiving, Motion, Document Structure
893 @section Structure editing
894 @cindex structure editing
895 @cindex headline, promotion and demotion
896 @cindex promotion, of subtrees
897 @cindex demotion, of subtrees
898 @cindex subtree, cut and paste
899 @cindex pasting, of subtrees
900 @cindex cutting, of subtrees
901 @cindex copying, of subtrees
902 @cindex subtrees, cut and paste
903
904 @table @kbd
905 @kindex M-@key{RET}
906 @item M-@key{RET}
907 Insert new heading with same level as current. If the cursor is in a
908 plain list item, a new item is created (@pxref{Plain lists}). To force
909 creation of a new headline, use a prefix argument, or first press @key{RET}
910 to get to the beginning of the next line. When this command is used in
911 the middle of a line, the line is split and the rest of the line becomes
912 the new headline@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split,
913 customize the variable @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If the
914 command is used at the beginning of a headline, the new headline is
915 created before the current line. If at the beginning of any other line,
916 the content of that line is made the new heading. If the command is
917 used at the end of a folded subtree (i.e. behind the ellipses at the end
918 of a headline), then a headline like the current one will be inserted
919 after the end of the subtree.
920 @kindex C-@key{RET}
921 @item C-@key{RET}
922 Just like @kbd{M-@key{RET}}, except when adding a new heading below the
923 current heading, the new heading is placed after the body instead of before
924 it. This command works from anywhere in the entry.
925 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
926 @item M-S-@key{RET}
927 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading.
928 @kindex C-S-@key{RET}
929 @item C-S-@key{RET}
930 Insert new TODO entry with same level as current heading. Like
931 @kbd{C-@key{RET}}, the new headline will be inserted after the current
932 subtree.
933 @kindex M-@key{left}
934 @item M-@key{left}
935 Promote current heading by one level.
936 @kindex M-@key{right}
937 @item M-@key{right}
938 Demote current heading by one level.
939 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
940 @item M-S-@key{left}
941 Promote the current subtree by one level.
942 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
943 @item M-S-@key{right}
944 Demote the current subtree by one level.
945 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
946 @item M-S-@key{up}
947 Move subtree up (swap with previous subtree of same
948 level).
949 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
950 @item M-S-@key{down}
951 Move subtree down (swap with next subtree of same level).
952 @kindex C-c C-x C-w
953 @item C-c C-x C-w
954 Kill subtree, i.e. remove it from buffer but save in kill ring.
955 With a numeric prefix argument N, kill N sequential subtrees.
956 @kindex C-c C-x M-w
957 @item C-c C-x M-w
958 Copy subtree to kill ring. With a numeric prefix argument N, copy the N
959 sequential subtrees.
960 @kindex C-c C-x C-y
961 @item C-c C-x C-y
962 Yank subtree from kill ring. This does modify the level of the subtree to
963 make sure the tree fits in nicely at the yank position. The yank level can
964 also be specified with a numeric prefix argument, or by yanking after a
965 headline marker like @samp{****}.
966 @kindex C-y
967 @item C-y
968 Depending on the variables @code{org-yank-adjusted-subtrees} and
969 @code{org-yank-folded-subtrees}, Org's internal @code{yank} command will
970 paste subtrees folded and in a clever way, using the same command as @kbd{C-c
971 C-x C-y}. With the default settings, level adjustment will take place and
972 yanked trees will be folded unless doing so would swallow text previously
973 visible. Any prefix argument to this command will force a normal @code{yank}
974 to be executed, with the prefix passed along. A good way to force a normal
975 yank is @kbd{C-u C-y}. If you use @code{yank-pop} after a yank, it will yank
976 previous kill items plainly, without adjustment and folding.
977 @kindex C-c C-w
978 @item C-c C-w
979 Refile entry or region to a different location. @xref{Refiling notes}.
980 @kindex C-c ^
981 @item C-c ^
982 Sort same-level entries. When there is an active region, all entries in the
983 region will be sorted. Otherwise the children of the current headline are
984 sorted. The command prompts for the sorting method, which can be
985 alphabetically, numerically, by time (using the first time stamp in each
986 entry), by priority, or by TODO keyword (in the sequence the keywords have
987 been defined in the setup). Reverse sorting is possible as well. You can
988 also supply your own function to extract the sorting key. With a @kbd{C-u}
989 prefix, sorting will be case-sensitive. With two @kbd{C-u C-u} prefixes,
990 duplicate entries will also be removed.
991 @kindex C-x n s
992 @item C-x n s
993 Narrow buffer to current subtree.
994 @kindex C-x n w
995 @item C-x n w
996 Widen buffer to remove a narrowing.
997 @kindex C-c *
998 @item C-c *
999 Turn a normal line or plain list item into a headline (so that it becomes a
1000 subheading at its location). Also turn a headline into a normal line by
1001 removing the stars. If there is an active region, turn all lines in the
1002 region into headlines. If the first line in the region was an item, turn
1003 only the item lines into headlines. Finally, if the first line is a
1004 headline, remove the stars from all headlines in the region.
1005 @end table
1006
1007 @cindex region, active
1008 @cindex active region
1009 @cindex Transient mark mode
1010 When there is an active region (Transient mark mode), promotion and
1011 demotion work on all headlines in the region. To select a region of
1012 headlines, it is best to place both point and mark at the beginning of a
1013 line, mark at the beginning of the first headline, and point at the line
1014 just after the last headline to change. Note that when the cursor is
1015 inside a table (@pxref{Tables}), the Meta-Cursor keys have different
1016 functionality.
1017
1018 @node Archiving, Sparse trees, Structure editing, Document Structure
1019 @section Archiving
1020 @cindex archiving
1021
1022 When a project represented by a (sub)tree is finished, you may want
1023 to move the tree out of the way and to stop it from contributing to the
1024 agenda. Org mode knows two ways of archiving. You can mark a tree with
1025 the ARCHIVE tag, or you can move an entire (sub)tree to a different
1026 location.
1027
1028 @menu
1029 * ARCHIVE tag:: Marking a tree as inactive
1030 * Moving subtrees:: Moving a tree to an archive file
1031 @end menu
1032
1033 @node ARCHIVE tag, Moving subtrees, Archiving, Archiving
1034 @subsection The ARCHIVE tag
1035 @cindex internal archiving
1036
1037 A headline that is marked with the ARCHIVE tag (@pxref{Tags}) stays at
1038 its location in the outline tree, but behaves in the following way:
1039 @itemize @minus
1040 @item
1041 It does not open when you attempt to do so with a visibility cycling
1042 command (@pxref{Visibility cycling}). You can force cycling archived
1043 subtrees with @kbd{C-@key{TAB}}, or by setting the option
1044 @code{org-cycle-open-archived-trees}. Also normal outline commands like
1045 @code{show-all} will open archived subtrees.
1046 @item
1047 During sparse tree construction (@pxref{Sparse trees}), matches in
1048 archived subtrees are not exposed, unless you configure the option
1049 @code{org-sparse-tree-open-archived-trees}.
1050 @item
1051 During agenda view construction (@pxref{Agenda Views}), the content of
1052 archived trees is ignored unless you configure the option
1053 @code{org-agenda-skip-archived-trees}, in which case these trees will always
1054 be included. In the agenda you can press the @kbd{v} key to get archives
1055 temporarily included.
1056 @item
1057 Archived trees are not exported (@pxref{Exporting}), only the headline
1058 is. Configure the details using the variable
1059 @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}.
1060 @end itemize
1061
1062 The following commands help managing the ARCHIVE tag:
1063
1064 @table @kbd
1065 @kindex C-c C-x a
1066 @item C-c C-x a
1067 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline. When the tag is set,
1068 the headline changes to a shadowed face, and the subtree below it is
1069 hidden.
1070 @kindex C-u C-c C-x a
1071 @item C-u C-c C-x a
1072 Check if any direct children of the current headline should be archived.
1073 To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries. If none are
1074 found, the command offers to set the ARCHIVE tag for the child. If the
1075 cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command is invoked, the
1076 level 1 trees will be checked.
1077 @kindex C-@kbd{TAB}
1078 @item C-@kbd{TAB}
1079 Cycle a tree even if it is tagged with ARCHIVE.
1080 @end table
1081
1082 @node Moving subtrees, , ARCHIVE tag, Archiving
1083 @subsection Moving subtrees
1084 @cindex external archiving
1085
1086 Once an entire project is finished, you may want to move it to a different
1087 location. Org can move it to an @emph{Archive Sibling} in the same tree, to a
1088 different tree in the current file, or to a different file, the archive file.
1089
1090 @table @kbd
1091 @kindex C-c C-x A
1092 @item C-c C-x A
1093 Move the current entry to the @emph{Archive Sibling}. This is a sibling of
1094 the entry with the heading @samp{Archive} and the tag @samp{ARCHIVE}
1095 (@pxref{ARCHIVE tag}). The entry becomes a child of that sibling and in this
1096 way retains a lot of its original context, including inherited tags and
1097 approximate position in the outline.
1098 @kindex C-c C-x C-s
1099 @item C-c C-x C-s
1100 Archive the subtree starting at the cursor position to the location
1101 given by @code{org-archive-location}. Context information that could be
1102 lost like the file name, the category, inherited tags, and the TODO
1103 state will be store as properties in the entry.
1104 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-s
1105 @item C-u C-c C-x C-s
1106 Check if any direct children of the current headline could be moved to
1107 the archive. To do this, each subtree is checked for open TODO entries.
1108 If none are found, the command offers to move it to the archive
1109 location. If the cursor is @emph{not} on a headline when this command
1110 is invoked, the level 1 trees will be checked.
1111 @end table
1112
1113 @cindex archive locations
1114 The default archive location is a file in the same directory as the
1115 current file, with the name derived by appending @file{_archive} to the
1116 current file name. For information and examples on how to change this,
1117 see the documentation string of the variable
1118 @code{org-archive-location}. There is also an in-buffer option for
1119 setting this variable, for example@footnote{For backward compatibility,
1120 the following also works: If there are several such lines in a file,
1121 each specifies the archive location for the text below it. The first
1122 such line also applies to any text before its definition. However,
1123 using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is incompatible
1124 with the outline structure of the document. The correct method for
1125 setting multiple archive locations in a buffer is using properties.}:
1126
1127 @example
1128 #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
1129 @end example
1130
1131 @noindent
1132 If you would like to have a special ARCHIVE location for a single entry
1133 or a (sub)tree, give the entry an @code{:ARCHIVE:} property with the
1134 location as the value (@pxref{Properties and Columns}).
1135
1136 When a subtree is moved, it receives a number of special properties that
1137 record context information like the file from where the entry came, it's
1138 outline path the archiving time etc. Configure the variable
1139 @code{org-archive-save-context-info} to adjust the amount of information
1140 added.
1141
1142 @node Sparse trees, Plain lists, Archiving, Document Structure
1143 @section Sparse trees
1144 @cindex sparse trees
1145 @cindex trees, sparse
1146 @cindex folding, sparse trees
1147 @cindex occur, command
1148
1149 An important feature of Org mode is the ability to construct @emph{sparse
1150 trees} for selected information in an outline tree, so that the entire
1151 document is folded as much as possible, but the selected information is made
1152 visible along with the headline structure above it@footnote{See also the
1153 variables @code{org-show-hierarchy-above}, @code{org-show-following-heading},
1154 @code{org-show-siblings}, and @code{org-show-entry-below} for detailed
1155 control on how much context is shown around each match.}. Just try it out
1156 and you will see immediately how it works.
1157
1158 Org mode contains several commands creating such trees, all these
1159 commands can be accessed through a dispatcher:
1160
1161 @table @kbd
1162 @kindex C-c /
1163 @item C-c /
1164 This prompts for an extra key to select a sparse-tree creating command.
1165 @kindex C-c / r
1166 @item C-c / r
1167 Occur. Prompts for a regexp and shows a sparse tree with all matches. If
1168 the match is in a headline, the headline is made visible. If the match is in
1169 the body of an entry, headline and body are made visible. In order to
1170 provide minimal context, also the full hierarchy of headlines above the match
1171 is shown, as well as the headline following the match. Each match is also
1172 highlighted; the highlights disappear when the buffer is changed by an
1173 editing command@footnote{depending on the option
1174 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}}, or by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}.
1175 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, previous highlights are kept,
1176 so several calls to this command can be stacked.
1177 @end table
1178
1179 @noindent
1180 For frequently used sparse trees of specific search strings, you can
1181 use the variable @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} to define fast
1182 keyboard access to specific sparse trees. These commands will then be
1183 accessible through the agenda dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
1184 For example:
1185
1186 @lisp
1187 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
1188 '(("f" occur-tree "FIXME")))
1189 @end lisp
1190
1191 @noindent will define the key @kbd{C-c a f} as a shortcut for creating
1192 a sparse tree matching the string @samp{FIXME}.
1193
1194 The other sparse tree commands select headings based on TODO keywords,
1195 tags, or properties and will be discussed later in this manual.
1196
1197 @kindex C-c C-e v
1198 @cindex printing sparse trees
1199 @cindex visible text, printing
1200 To print a sparse tree, you can use the Emacs command
1201 @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} which does not print invisible parts
1202 of the document @footnote{This does not work under XEmacs, because
1203 XEmacs uses selective display for outlining, not text properties.}.
1204 Or you can use the command @kbd{C-c C-e v} to export only the visible
1205 part of the document and print the resulting file.
1206
1207 @node Plain lists, Drawers, Sparse trees, Document Structure
1208 @section Plain lists
1209 @cindex plain lists
1210 @cindex lists, plain
1211 @cindex lists, ordered
1212 @cindex ordered lists
1213
1214 Within an entry of the outline tree, hand-formatted lists can provide
1215 additional structure. They also provide a way to create lists of
1216 checkboxes (@pxref{Checkboxes}). Org supports editing such lists,
1217 and the HTML exporter (@pxref{Exporting}) parses and formats them.
1218
1219 Org knows ordered lists, unordered lists, and description lists.
1220 @itemize @bullet
1221 @item
1222 @emph{Unordered} list items start with @samp{-}, @samp{+}, or
1223 @samp{*}@footnote{When using @samp{*} as a bullet, lines must be indented or
1224 they will be seen as top-level headlines. Also, when you are hiding leading
1225 stars to get a clean outline view, plain list items starting with a star are
1226 visually indistinguishable from true headlines. In short: even though
1227 @samp{*} is supported, it may be better to not use it for plain list items.}
1228 as bullets.
1229 @item
1230 @emph{Ordered} list items start with a numeral followed by either a period or
1231 a right parenthesis, such as @samp{1.} or @samp{1)}.
1232 @item
1233 @emph{Description} list items are like unordered list items, but contain the
1234 separator @samp{ :: } to separate the description @emph{term} from the
1235 description.
1236 @end itemize
1237
1238 Items belonging to the same list must have the same indentation on the first
1239 line. In particular, if an ordered list reaches number @samp{10.}, then the
1240 2--digit numbers must be written left-aligned with the other numbers in the
1241 list. Indentation also determines the end of a list item. It ends before
1242 the next line that is indented like the bullet/number, or less. Empty lines
1243 are part of the previous item, so you can have several paragraphs in one
1244 item. If you would like an empty line to terminate all currently open plain
1245 lists, configure the variable @code{org-empty-line-terminates-plain-lists}.
1246 Here is an example:
1247
1248 @example
1249 @group
1250 ** Lord of the Rings
1251 My favorite scenes are (in this order)
1252 1. The attack of the Rohirrim
1253 2. Eowyn's fight with the witch king
1254 + this was already my favorite scene in the book
1255 + I really like Miranda Otto.
1256 3. Peter Jackson being shot by Legolas
1257 - on DVD only
1258 He makes a really funny face when it happens.
1259 But in the end, no individual scenes matter but the film as a whole.
1260 Important actors in this film are:
1261 - @b{Elijah Wood} :: He plays Frodo
1262 - @b{Sean Austin} :: He plays Sam, Frodo's friend. I still remember
1263 him very well from his role as Mikey Walsh in the Goonies.
1264 @end group
1265 @end example
1266
1267 Org supports these lists by tuning filling and wrapping commands to
1268 deal with them correctly@footnote{Org only changes the filling
1269 settings for Emacs. For XEmacs, you should use Kyle E. Jones'
1270 @file{filladapt.el}. To turn this on, put into @file{.emacs}:
1271 @code{(require 'filladapt)}}, and by exporting them properly
1272 (@pxref{Exporting}).
1273
1274 The following commands act on items when the cursor is in the first line
1275 of an item (the line with the bullet or number).
1276
1277 @table @kbd
1278 @kindex @key{TAB}
1279 @item @key{TAB}
1280 Items can be folded just like headline levels if you set the variable
1281 @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists}. The level of an item is then
1282 given by the indentation of the bullet/number. Items are always
1283 subordinate to real headlines, however; the hierarchies remain
1284 completely separated.
1285
1286 If @code{org-cycle-include-plain-lists} has not been set, @key{TAB}
1287 fixes the indentation of the current line in a heuristic way.
1288 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1289 @item M-@key{RET}
1290 Insert new item at current level. With a prefix argument, force a new
1291 heading (@pxref{Structure editing}). If this command is used in the middle
1292 of a line, the line is @emph{split} and the rest of the line becomes the new
1293 item@footnote{If you do not want the line to be split, customize the variable
1294 @code{org-M-RET-may-split-line}.}. If this command is executed in the
1295 @emph{whitespace before a bullet or number}, the new item is created
1296 @emph{before} the current item. If the command is executed in the white
1297 space before the text that is part of an item but does not contain the
1298 bullet, a bullet is added to the current line.
1299 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
1300 @item M-S-@key{RET}
1301 Insert a new item with a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
1302 @kindex S-@key{up}
1303 @kindex S-@key{down}
1304 @item S-@key{up}
1305 @itemx S-@key{down}
1306 @cindex shift-selection-mode
1307 Jump to the previous/next item in the current list, but only if
1308 @code{org-support-shift-select} is off. If not, you can still use paragraph
1309 jumping commands like @kbd{C-@key{up}} and @kbd{C-@key{down}} to quite
1310 similar effect.
1311 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1312 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1313 @item M-S-@key{up}
1314 @itemx M-S-@key{down}
1315 Move the item including subitems up/down (swap with previous/next item
1316 of same indentation). If the list is ordered, renumbering is
1317 automatic.
1318 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1319 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1320 @item M-S-@key{left}
1321 @itemx M-S-@key{right}
1322 Decrease/increase the indentation of the item, including subitems.
1323 Initially, the item tree is selected based on current indentation.
1324 When these commands are executed several times in direct succession,
1325 the initially selected region is used, even if the new indentation
1326 would imply a different hierarchy. To use the new hierarchy, break
1327 the command chain with a cursor motion or so.
1328 @kindex C-c C-c
1329 @item C-c C-c
1330 If there is a checkbox (@pxref{Checkboxes}) in the item line, toggle the
1331 state of the checkbox. If not, this command makes sure that all the
1332 items on this list level use the same bullet. Furthermore, if this is
1333 an ordered list, make sure the numbering is OK.
1334 @kindex C-c -
1335 @item C-c -
1336 Cycle the entire list level through the different itemize/enumerate bullets
1337 (@samp{-}, @samp{+}, @samp{*}, @samp{1.}, @samp{1)}). With a numeric prefix
1338 argument N, select the Nth bullet from this list. If there is an active
1339 region when calling this, all lines will be converted to list items. If the
1340 first line already was a list item, any item markers will be removed from the
1341 list. Finally, even without an active region, a normal line will be
1342 converted into a list item.
1343 @kindex S-@key{left}
1344 @kindex S-@key{right}
1345 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
1346 This command also cycles bullet styles when the cursor in on the bullet or
1347 anywhere in an item line, details depending on
1348 @code{org-support-shift-select}.
1349 @end table
1350
1351 @node Drawers, Footnotes, Plain lists, Document Structure
1352 @section Drawers
1353 @cindex drawers
1354 @cindex visibility cycling, drawers
1355
1356 Sometimes you want to keep information associated with an entry, but you
1357 normally don't want to see it. For this, Org mode has @emph{drawers}.
1358 Drawers need to be configured with the variable
1359 @code{org-drawers}@footnote{You can define drawers on a per-file basis
1360 with a line like @code{#+DRAWERS: HIDDEN PROPERTIES STATE}}. Drawers
1361 look like this:
1362
1363 @example
1364 ** This is a headline
1365 Still outside the drawer
1366 :DRAWERNAME:
1367 This is inside the drawer.
1368 :END:
1369 After the drawer.
1370 @end example
1371
1372 Visibility cycling (@pxref{Visibility cycling}) on the headline will
1373 hide and show the entry, but keep the drawer collapsed to a single line.
1374 In order to look inside the drawer, you need to move the cursor to the
1375 drawer line and press @key{TAB} there. Org mode uses a drawer for
1376 storing properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}), and another one for
1377 storing clock times (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
1378
1379 @node Footnotes, Orgstruct mode, Drawers, Document Structure
1380 @section Footnotes
1381 @cindex footnotes
1382
1383 Org-mode supports the creation of footnotes. In contrast to the
1384 @file{footnote.el} package, Org-mode's footnotes are designed for work on a
1385 larger document, not only for one-off documents like emails. The basic
1386 syntax is similar to the one used by @file{footnote.el}, i.e. a footnote is
1387 defined in a paragraph that is started by a footnote marker in square
1388 brackets in column 0, no indentation allowed. If you need a paragraph break
1389 inside a footnote, use the LaTeX idiom @samp{\par}. The footnote reference
1390 is simply the marker in square brackets, inside text. For example:
1391
1392 @example
1393 The Org homepage[fn:1] now looks a lot better than it used to.
1394 ...
1395 [fn:1] The link is: http://orgmode.org
1396 @end example
1397
1398 Org-mode extends the number-based syntax to @emph{named} footnotes and
1399 optional inline definition. Using plain numbers as markers (as
1400 @file{footnote.el} does) is supported for backward compatibility, but not
1401 encouraged because of possible conflicts with LaTeX snippets @pxref{Embedded
1402 LaTeX}. Here are the valid references:
1403
1404 @table @code
1405 @item [1]
1406 A plain numeric footnote marker.
1407 @item [fn:name]
1408 A named footnote reference, where @code{name} is a unique label word, or, for
1409 simplicity of automatic creation, a number.
1410 @item [fn:: This is the inline definition of this footnote]
1411 A LaTeX-like anonymous footnote where the definition is given directly at the
1412 reference point.
1413 @item [fn:name: a definition]
1414 An inline definition of a footnote, which also specifies a name for the note.
1415 Since Org allows multiple references to the same note, you can then use use
1416 @code{[fn:name]} to create additional references.
1417 @end table
1418
1419 Footnote labels can be created automatically, or you create names yourself.
1420 This is handled by the variable @code{org-footnote-auto-label} and its
1421 corresponding @code{#+STARTUP} keywords, see the docstring of that variable
1422 for details.
1423
1424 @noindent The following command handles footnotes:
1425
1426 @table @kbd
1427 @kindex C-c C-x f
1428 @item C-c C-x f
1429 The footnote action command.
1430
1431 When the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. When it
1432 is at a definition, jump to the (first) reference.
1433
1434 Otherwise, create a new footnote. Depending on the variable
1435 @code{org-footnote-define-inline}@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer
1436 setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: fninline} or @code{#+STARTUP: nofninline}}, the
1437 definition will be placed right into the text as part of the reference, or
1438 separately into the location determined by the variable
1439 @code{org-footnote-section}.
1440
1441 When this command is called with a prefix argument, a menu of additional
1442 options is offered:
1443 @example
1444 s @r{Sort the footnote definitions by reference sequence. During editing,}
1445 @r{Org makes no effort to sort footnote definitions into a particular}
1446 @r{sequence. If you want them sorted, use this command, which will}
1447 @r{also move entries according to @code{org-footnote-section}.}
1448 n @r{Normalize the footnotes by collecting all definitions (including}
1449 @r{inline definitions) into a special section, and then numbering them}
1450 @r{in sequence. The references will then also be numbers. This is}
1451 @r{meant to be the final step before finishing a document (e.g. sending}
1452 @r{off an email). The exporters do this automatically, and so could}
1453 @r{something like @code{message-send-hook}.}
1454 d @r{Delete the footnote at point, and all definitions of and references}
1455 @r{to it.}
1456 @end example
1457 @kindex C-c C-c
1458 @item C-c C-c
1459 If the cursor is on a footnote reference, jump to the definition. If it is a
1460 the definition, jump back to the reference. When called at a footnote
1461 location with a prefix argument, offer the same menu as @kbd{C-c C-x f}.
1462 @kindex C-c C-o
1463 @kindex mouse-1
1464 @kindex mouse-2
1465 @item C-c C-c @r{or} mouse-1/2
1466 Footnote labels are also links to the corresponding definition/reference, and
1467 you can use the usual commands to follow these links.
1468 @end table
1469
1470 @node Orgstruct mode, , Footnotes, Document Structure
1471 @section The Orgstruct minor mode
1472 @cindex Orgstruct mode
1473 @cindex minor mode for structure editing
1474
1475 If you like the intuitive way the Org mode structure editing and list
1476 formatting works, you might want to use these commands in other modes
1477 like Text mode or Mail mode as well. The minor mode Orgstruct mode
1478 makes this possible. You can always toggle the mode with @kbd{M-x
1479 orgstruct-mode}. To turn it on by default, for example in Mail mode,
1480 use
1481
1482 @lisp
1483 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgstruct)
1484 @end lisp
1485
1486 When this mode is active and the cursor is on a line that looks to
1487 Org like a headline of the first line of a list item, most
1488 structure editing commands will work, even if the same keys normally
1489 have different functionality in the major mode you are using. If the
1490 cursor is not in one of those special lines, Orgstruct mode lurks
1491 silently in the shadow.
1492
1493 @node Tables, Hyperlinks, Document Structure, Top
1494 @chapter Tables
1495 @cindex tables
1496 @cindex editing tables
1497
1498 Org comes with a fast and intuitive table editor. Spreadsheet-like
1499 calculations are supported in connection with the Emacs @file{calc}
1500 package
1501 @ifinfo
1502 (@pxref{Top,Calc,,Calc,Gnu Emacs Calculator Manual}).
1503 @end ifinfo
1504 @ifnotinfo
1505 (see the Emacs Calculator manual for more information about the Emacs
1506 calculator).
1507 @end ifnotinfo
1508
1509 @menu
1510 * Built-in table editor:: Simple tables
1511 * Narrow columns:: Stop wasting space in tables
1512 * Column groups:: Grouping to trigger vertical lines
1513 * Orgtbl mode:: The table editor as minor mode
1514 * The spreadsheet:: The table editor has spreadsheet capabilities
1515 * Org Plot:: Plotting from org tables
1516 @end menu
1517
1518 @node Built-in table editor, Narrow columns, Tables, Tables
1519 @section The built-in table editor
1520 @cindex table editor, built-in
1521
1522 Org makes it easy to format tables in plain ASCII. Any line with
1523 @samp{|} as the first non-whitespace character is considered part of a
1524 table. @samp{|} is also the column separator. A table might look like
1525 this:
1526
1527 @example
1528 | Name | Phone | Age |
1529 |-------+-------+-----|
1530 | Peter | 1234 | 17 |
1531 | Anna | 4321 | 25 |
1532 @end example
1533
1534 A table is re-aligned automatically each time you press @key{TAB} or
1535 @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} inside the table. @key{TAB} also moves to
1536 the next field (@key{RET} to the next row) and creates new table rows
1537 at the end of the table or before horizontal lines. The indentation
1538 of the table is set by the first line. Any line starting with
1539 @samp{|-} is considered as a horizontal separator line and will be
1540 expanded on the next re-align to span the whole table width. So, to
1541 create the above table, you would only type
1542
1543 @example
1544 |Name|Phone|Age|
1545 |-
1546 @end example
1547
1548 @noindent and then press @key{TAB} to align the table and start filling in
1549 fields. Even faster would be to type @code{|Name|Phone|Age} followed by
1550 @kbd{C-c @key{RET}}.
1551
1552 When typing text into a field, Org treats @key{DEL},
1553 @key{Backspace}, and all character keys in a special way, so that
1554 inserting and deleting avoids shifting other fields. Also, when
1555 typing @emph{immediately after the cursor was moved into a new field
1556 with @kbd{@key{TAB}}, @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} or @kbd{@key{RET}}}, the
1557 field is automatically made blank. If this behavior is too
1558 unpredictable for you, configure the variables
1559 @code{org-enable-table-editor} and @code{org-table-auto-blank-field}.
1560
1561 @table @kbd
1562 @tsubheading{Creation and conversion}
1563 @kindex C-c |
1564 @item C-c |
1565 Convert the active region to table. If every line contains at least one
1566 TAB character, the function assumes that the material is tab separated.
1567 If every line contains a comma, comma-separated values (CSV) are assumed.
1568 If not, lines are split at whitespace into fields. You can use a prefix
1569 argument to force a specific separator: @kbd{C-u} forces CSV, @kbd{C-u
1570 C-u} forces TAB, and a numeric argument N indicates that at least N
1571 consecutive spaces, or alternatively a TAB will be the separator.
1572 @*
1573 If there is no active region, this command creates an empty Org
1574 table. But it's easier just to start typing, like
1575 @kbd{|Name|Phone|Age @key{RET} |- @key{TAB}}.
1576
1577 @tsubheading{Re-aligning and field motion}
1578 @kindex C-c C-c
1579 @item C-c C-c
1580 Re-align the table without moving the cursor.
1581 @c
1582 @kindex @key{TAB}
1583 @item @key{TAB}
1584 Re-align the table, move to the next field. Creates a new row if
1585 necessary.
1586 @c
1587 @kindex S-@key{TAB}
1588 @item S-@key{TAB}
1589 Re-align, move to previous field.
1590 @c
1591 @kindex @key{RET}
1592 @item @key{RET}
1593 Re-align the table and move down to next row. Creates a new row if
1594 necessary. At the beginning or end of a line, @key{RET} still does
1595 NEWLINE, so it can be used to split a table.
1596
1597 @tsubheading{Column and row editing}
1598 @kindex M-@key{left}
1599 @kindex M-@key{right}
1600 @item M-@key{left}
1601 @itemx M-@key{right}
1602 Move the current column left/right.
1603 @c
1604 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
1605 @item M-S-@key{left}
1606 Kill the current column.
1607 @c
1608 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
1609 @item M-S-@key{right}
1610 Insert a new column to the left of the cursor position.
1611 @c
1612 @kindex M-@key{up}
1613 @kindex M-@key{down}
1614 @item M-@key{up}
1615 @itemx M-@key{down}
1616 Move the current row up/down.
1617 @c
1618 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
1619 @item M-S-@key{up}
1620 Kill the current row or horizontal line.
1621 @c
1622 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
1623 @item M-S-@key{down}
1624 Insert a new row above the current row. With a prefix argument, the line is
1625 created below the current one.
1626 @c
1627 @kindex C-c -
1628 @item C-c -
1629 Insert a horizontal line below current row. With a prefix argument, the line
1630 is created above the current line.
1631 @c
1632 @kindex C-c @key{RET}
1633 @item C-c @key{RET}
1634 Insert a horizontal line below current row, and move the cursor into the row
1635 below that line.
1636 @c
1637 @kindex C-c ^
1638 @item C-c ^
1639 Sort the table lines in the region. The position of point indicates the
1640 column to be used for sorting, and the range of lines is the range
1641 between the nearest horizontal separator lines, or the entire table. If
1642 point is before the first column, you will be prompted for the sorting
1643 column. If there is an active region, the mark specifies the first line
1644 and the sorting column, while point should be in the last line to be
1645 included into the sorting. The command prompts for the sorting type
1646 (alphabetically, numerically, or by time). When called with a prefix
1647 argument, alphabetic sorting will be case-sensitive.
1648
1649 @tsubheading{Regions}
1650 @kindex C-c C-x M-w
1651 @item C-c C-x M-w
1652 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard. Point
1653 and mark determine edge fields of the rectangle. The process ignores
1654 horizontal separator lines.
1655 @c
1656 @kindex C-c C-x C-w
1657 @item C-c C-x C-w
1658 Copy a rectangular region from a table to a special clipboard, and
1659 blank all fields in the rectangle. So this is the ``cut'' operation.
1660 @c
1661 @kindex C-c C-x C-y
1662 @item C-c C-x C-y
1663 Paste a rectangular region into a table.
1664 The upper left corner ends up in the current field. All involved fields
1665 will be overwritten. If the rectangle does not fit into the present table,
1666 the table is enlarged as needed. The process ignores horizontal separator
1667 lines.
1668 @c
1669 @kindex M-@key{RET}
1670 @itemx M-@kbd{RET}
1671 Wrap several fields in a column like a paragraph. If there is an active
1672 region, and both point and mark are in the same column, the text in the
1673 column is wrapped to minimum width for the given number of lines. A numeric
1674 prefix argument may be used to change the number of desired lines. If there
1675 is no region, the current field is split at the cursor position and the text
1676 fragment to the right of the cursor is prepended to the field one line
1677 down. If there is no region, but you specify a prefix argument, the current
1678 field is made blank, and the content is appended to the field above.
1679
1680 @tsubheading{Calculations}
1681 @cindex formula, in tables
1682 @cindex calculations, in tables
1683 @cindex region, active
1684 @cindex active region
1685 @cindex Transient mark mode
1686 @kindex C-c +
1687 @item C-c +
1688 Sum the numbers in the current column, or in the rectangle defined by
1689 the active region. The result is shown in the echo area and can
1690 be inserted with @kbd{C-y}.
1691 @c
1692 @kindex S-@key{RET}
1693 @item S-@key{RET}
1694 When current field is empty, copy from first non-empty field above. When not
1695 empty, copy current field down to next row and move cursor along with it.
1696 Depending on the variable @code{org-table-copy-increment}, integer field
1697 values will be incremented during copy. Integers that are too large will not
1698 be incremented. Also, a @code{0} prefix argument temporarily disables the
1699 increment. This key is also used by CUA mode (@pxref{Cooperation}).
1700
1701 @tsubheading{Miscellaneous}
1702 @kindex C-c `
1703 @item C-c `
1704 Edit the current field in a separate window. This is useful for fields
1705 that are not fully visible (@pxref{Narrow columns}). When called with a
1706 @kbd{C-u} prefix, just make the full field visible, so that it can be
1707 edited in place.
1708 @c
1709 @item M-x org-table-import
1710 Import a file as a table. The table should be TAB- or whitespace
1711 separated. Useful, for example, to import a spreadsheet table or data
1712 from a database, because these programs generally can write
1713 TAB-separated text files. This command works by inserting the file into
1714 the buffer and then converting the region to a table. Any prefix
1715 argument is passed on to the converter, which uses it to determine the
1716 separator.
1717 @item C-c |
1718 Tables can also be imported by pasting tabular text into the Org
1719 buffer, selecting the pasted text with @kbd{C-x C-x} and then using the
1720 @kbd{C-c |} command (see above under @i{Creation and conversion}).
1721 @c
1722 @item M-x org-table-export
1723 Export the table, by default as a TAB-separated file. Useful for data
1724 exchange with, for example, spreadsheet or database programs. The format
1725 used to export the file can be configured in the variable
1726 @code{org-table-export-default-format}. You may also use properties
1727 @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FILE} and @code{TABLE_EXPORT_FORMAT} to specify the file
1728 name and the format for table export in a subtree. Org supports quite
1729 general formats for exported tables. The exporter format is the same as the
1730 format used by Orgtbl radio tables, see @ref{Translator functions} for a
1731 detailed description.
1732 @end table
1733
1734 If you don't like the automatic table editor because it gets in your
1735 way on lines which you would like to start with @samp{|}, you can turn
1736 it off with
1737
1738 @lisp
1739 (setq org-enable-table-editor nil)
1740 @end lisp
1741
1742 @noindent Then the only table command that still works is
1743 @kbd{C-c C-c} to do a manual re-align.
1744
1745 @node Narrow columns, Column groups, Built-in table editor, Tables
1746 @section Narrow columns
1747 @cindex narrow columns in tables
1748
1749 The width of columns is automatically determined by the table editor.
1750 Sometimes a single field or a few fields need to carry more text,
1751 leading to inconveniently wide columns. To limit@footnote{This feature
1752 does not work on XEmacs.} the width of a column, one field anywhere in
1753 the column may contain just the string @samp{<N>} where @samp{N} is an
1754 integer specifying the width of the column in characters. The next
1755 re-align will then set the width of this column to no more than this
1756 value.
1757
1758 @example
1759 @group
1760 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1761 | | | | | <6> |
1762 | 1 | one | | 1 | one |
1763 | 2 | two | ----\ | 2 | two |
1764 | 3 | This is a long chunk of text | ----/ | 3 | This=> |
1765 | 4 | four | | 4 | four |
1766 |---+------------------------------| |---+--------|
1767 @end group
1768 @end example
1769
1770 @noindent
1771 Fields that are wider become clipped and end in the string @samp{=>}.
1772 Note that the full text is still in the buffer, it is only invisible.
1773 To see the full text, hold the mouse over the field - a tool-tip window
1774 will show the full content. To edit such a field, use the command
1775 @kbd{C-c `} (that is @kbd{C-c} followed by the backquote). This will
1776 open a new window with the full field. Edit it and finish with @kbd{C-c
1777 C-c}.
1778
1779 When visiting a file containing a table with narrowed columns, the
1780 necessary character hiding has not yet happened, and the table needs to
1781 be aligned before it looks nice. Setting the option
1782 @code{org-startup-align-all-tables} will realign all tables in a file
1783 upon visiting, but also slow down startup. You can also set this option
1784 on a per-file basis with:
1785
1786 @example
1787 #+STARTUP: align
1788 #+STARTUP: noalign
1789 @end example
1790
1791 @node Column groups, Orgtbl mode, Narrow columns, Tables
1792 @section Column groups
1793 @cindex grouping columns in tables
1794
1795 When Org exports tables, it does so by default without vertical
1796 lines because that is visually more satisfying in general. Occasionally
1797 however, vertical lines can be useful to structure a table into groups
1798 of columns, much like horizontal lines can do for groups of rows. In
1799 order to specify column groups, you can use a special row where the
1800 first field contains only @samp{/}. The further fields can either
1801 contain @samp{<} to indicate that this column should start a group,
1802 @samp{>} to indicate the end of a column, or @samp{<>} to make a column
1803 a group of its own. Boundaries between column groups will upon export be
1804 marked with vertical lines. Here is an example:
1805
1806 @example
1807 | | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1808 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1809 | / | <> | < | | > | < | > |
1810 | # | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 | 1 |
1811 | # | 2 | 4 | 8 | 16 | 1.4142 | 1.1892 |
1812 | # | 3 | 9 | 27 | 81 | 1.7321 | 1.3161 |
1813 |---+----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1814 #+TBLFM: $3=$2^2::$4=$2^3::$5=$2^4::$6=sqrt($2)::$7=sqrt(sqrt(($2)))
1815 @end example
1816
1817 It is also sufficient to just insert the column group starters after
1818 every vertical line you'd like to have:
1819
1820 @example
1821 | N | N^2 | N^3 | N^4 | sqrt(n) | sqrt[4](N) |
1822 |----+-----+-----+-----+---------+------------|
1823 | / | < | | | < | |
1824 @end example
1825
1826 @node Orgtbl mode, The spreadsheet, Column groups, Tables
1827 @section The Orgtbl minor mode
1828 @cindex Orgtbl mode
1829 @cindex minor mode for tables
1830
1831 If you like the intuitive way the Org table editor works, you
1832 might also want to use it in other modes like Text mode or Mail mode.
1833 The minor mode Orgtbl mode makes this possible. You can always toggle
1834 the mode with @kbd{M-x orgtbl-mode}. To turn it on by default, for
1835 example in mail mode, use
1836
1837 @lisp
1838 (add-hook 'mail-mode-hook 'turn-on-orgtbl)
1839 @end lisp
1840
1841 Furthermore, with some special setup, it is possible to maintain tables
1842 in arbitrary syntax with Orgtbl mode. For example, it is possible to
1843 construct La@TeX{} tables with the underlying ease and power of
1844 Orgtbl mode, including spreadsheet capabilities. For details, see
1845 @ref{Tables in arbitrary syntax}.
1846
1847 @node The spreadsheet, Org Plot, Orgtbl mode, Tables
1848 @section The spreadsheet
1849 @cindex calculations, in tables
1850 @cindex spreadsheet capabilities
1851 @cindex @file{calc} package
1852
1853 The table editor makes use of the Emacs @file{calc} package to implement
1854 spreadsheet-like capabilities. It can also evaluate Emacs Lisp forms to
1855 derive fields from other fields. While fully featured, Org's
1856 implementation is not identical to other spreadsheets. For example,
1857 Org knows the concept of a @emph{column formula} that will be
1858 applied to all non-header fields in a column without having to copy the
1859 formula to each relevant field.
1860
1861 @menu
1862 * References:: How to refer to another field or range
1863 * Formula syntax for Calc:: Using Calc to compute stuff
1864 * Formula syntax for Lisp:: Writing formulas in Emacs Lisp
1865 * Field formulas:: Formulas valid for a single field
1866 * Column formulas:: Formulas valid for an entire column
1867 * Editing and debugging formulas:: Fixing formulas
1868 * Updating the table:: Recomputing all dependent fields
1869 * Advanced features:: Field names, parameters and automatic recalc
1870 @end menu
1871
1872 @node References, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet, The spreadsheet
1873 @subsection References
1874 @cindex references
1875
1876 To compute fields in the table from other fields, formulas must
1877 reference other fields or ranges. In Org, fields can be referenced
1878 by name, by absolute coordinates, and by relative coordinates. To find
1879 out what the coordinates of a field are, press @kbd{C-c ?} in that
1880 field, or press @kbd{C-c @}} to toggle the display of a grid.
1881
1882 @subsubheading Field references
1883 @cindex field references
1884 @cindex references, to fields
1885
1886 Formulas can reference the value of another field in two ways. Like in
1887 any other spreadsheet, you may reference fields with a letter/number
1888 combination like @code{B3}, meaning the 2nd field in the 3rd row.
1889 @c Such references are always fixed to that field, they don't change
1890 @c when you copy and paste a formula to a different field. So
1891 @c Org's @code{B3} behaves like @code{$B$3} in other spreadsheets.
1892
1893 @noindent
1894 Org also uses another, more general operator that looks like this:
1895 @example
1896 @@row$column
1897 @end example
1898
1899 @noindent
1900 Column references can be absolute like @samp{1}, @samp{2},...@samp{N},
1901 or relative to the current column like @samp{+1} or @samp{-2}.
1902
1903 The row specification only counts data lines and ignores horizontal
1904 separator lines (hlines). You can use absolute row numbers
1905 @samp{1}...@samp{N}, and row numbers relative to the current row like
1906 @samp{+3} or @samp{-1}. Or specify the row relative to one of the
1907 hlines: @samp{I} refers to the first hline@footnote{Note that only
1908 hlines are counted that @emph{separate} table lines. If the table
1909 starts with a hline above the header, it does not count.}, @samp{II} to
1910 the second etc. @samp{-I} refers to the first such line above the
1911 current line, @samp{+I} to the first such line below the current line.
1912 You can also write @samp{III+2} which is the second data line after the
1913 third hline in the table. Relative row numbers like @samp{-3} will not
1914 cross hlines if the current line is too close to the hline. Instead,
1915 the value directly at the hline is used.
1916
1917 @samp{0} refers to the current row and column. Also, if you omit
1918 either the column or the row part of the reference, the current
1919 row/column is implied.
1920
1921 Org's references with @emph{unsigned} numbers are fixed references
1922 in the sense that if you use the same reference in the formula for two
1923 different fields, the same field will be referenced each time.
1924 Org's references with @emph{signed} numbers are floating
1925 references because the same reference operator can reference different
1926 fields depending on the field being calculated by the formula.
1927
1928 As a special case references like @samp{$LR5} and @samp{$LR12} can be used to
1929 refer in a stable way to the 5th and 12th field in the last row of the
1930 table.
1931
1932 Here are a few examples:
1933
1934 @example
1935 @@2$3 @r{2nd row, 3rd column}
1936 C2 @r{same as previous}
1937 $5 @r{column 5 in the current row}
1938 E& @r{same as previous}
1939 @@2 @r{current column, row 2}
1940 @@-1$-3 @r{the field one row up, three columns to the left}
1941 @@-I$2 @r{field just under hline above current row, column 2}
1942 @end example
1943
1944 @subsubheading Range references
1945 @cindex range references
1946 @cindex references, to ranges
1947
1948 You may reference a rectangular range of fields by specifying two field
1949 references connected by two dots @samp{..}. If both fields are in the
1950 current row, you may simply use @samp{$2..$7}, but if at least one field
1951 is in a different row, you need to use the general @code{@@row$column}
1952 format at least for the first field (i.e the reference must start with
1953 @samp{@@} in order to be interpreted correctly). Examples:
1954
1955 @example
1956 $1..$3 @r{First three fields in the current row.}
1957 $P..$Q @r{Range, using column names (see under Advanced)}
1958 @@2$1..@@4$3 @r{6 fields between these two fields.}
1959 A2..C4 @r{Same as above.}
1960 @@-1$-2..@@-1 @r{3 numbers from the column to the left, 2 up to current row}
1961 @end example
1962
1963 @noindent Range references return a vector of values that can be fed
1964 into Calc vector functions. Empty fields in ranges are normally
1965 suppressed, so that the vector contains only the non-empty fields (but
1966 see the @samp{E} mode switch below). If there are no non-empty fields,
1967 @samp{[0]} is returned to avoid syntax errors in formulas.
1968
1969 @subsubheading Named references
1970 @cindex named references
1971 @cindex references, named
1972 @cindex name, of column or field
1973 @cindex constants, in calculations
1974
1975 @samp{$name} is interpreted as the name of a column, parameter or
1976 constant. Constants are defined globally through the variable
1977 @code{org-table-formula-constants}, and locally (for the file) through a
1978 line like
1979
1980 @example
1981 #+CONSTANTS: c=299792458. pi=3.14 eps=2.4e-6
1982 @end example
1983
1984 @noindent
1985 Also properties (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) can be used as
1986 constants in table formulas: For a property @samp{:Xyz:} use the name
1987 @samp{$PROP_Xyz}, and the property will be searched in the current
1988 outline entry and in the hierarchy above it. If you have the
1989 @file{constants.el} package, it will also be used to resolve constants,
1990 including natural constants like @samp{$h} for Planck's constant, and
1991 units like @samp{$km} for kilometers@footnote{@file{Constant.el} can
1992 supply the values of constants in two different unit systems, @code{SI}
1993 and @code{cgs}. Which one is used depends on the value of the variable
1994 @code{constants-unit-system}. You can use the @code{#+STARTUP} options
1995 @code{constSI} and @code{constcgs} to set this value for the current
1996 buffer.}. Column names and parameters can be specified in special table
1997 lines. These are described below, see @ref{Advanced features}. All
1998 names must start with a letter, and further consist of letters and
1999 numbers.
2000
2001 @subsubheading Remote references
2002 @cindex remote references
2003 @cindex references, remote
2004 @cindex references, to a different table
2005 @cindex name, of column or field
2006 @cindex constants, in calculations
2007
2008 You may also reference constants, fields and ranges from a different table,
2009 either in the current file or even in a different file. The syntax is
2010
2011 @example
2012 remote(NAME-OR-ID,REF)
2013 @end example
2014
2015 @noindent
2016 where NAME can be the name of a table in the current file as set by a
2017 @code{#+TBLNAME: NAME} line before the table. It can also be the ID of an
2018 entry, even in a different file, and the reference then refers to the first
2019 table in that entry. REF is an absolute field or range reference as
2020 described above, valid in the referenced table.
2021
2022 @node Formula syntax for Calc, Formula syntax for Lisp, References, The spreadsheet
2023 @subsection Formula syntax for Calc
2024 @cindex formula syntax, Calc
2025 @cindex syntax, of formulas
2026
2027 A formula can be any algebraic expression understood by the Emacs
2028 @file{Calc} package. @b{Note that @file{calc} has the
2029 non-standard convention that @samp{/} has lower precedence than
2030 @samp{*}, so that @samp{a/b*c} is interpreted as @samp{a/(b*c)}.} Before
2031 evaluation by @code{calc-eval} (@pxref{Calling Calc from
2032 Your Programs,calc-eval,Calling Calc from Your Lisp Programs,Calc,GNU
2033 Emacs Calc Manual}),
2034 @c FIXME: The link to the Calc manual in HTML does not work.
2035 variable substitution takes place according to the rules described above.
2036 @cindex vectors, in table calculations
2037 The range vectors can be directly fed into the Calc vector functions
2038 like @samp{vmean} and @samp{vsum}.
2039
2040 @cindex format specifier
2041 @cindex mode, for @file{calc}
2042 A formula can contain an optional mode string after a semicolon. This
2043 string consists of flags to influence Calc and other modes during
2044 execution. By default, Org uses the standard Calc modes (precision
2045 12, angular units degrees, fraction and symbolic modes off). The display
2046 format, however, has been changed to @code{(float 5)} to keep tables
2047 compact. The default settings can be configured using the variable
2048 @code{org-calc-default-modes}.
2049
2050 @example
2051 p20 @r{switch the internal precision to 20 digits}
2052 n3 s3 e2 f4 @r{normal, scientific, engineering, or fixed display format}
2053 D R @r{angle modes: degrees, radians}
2054 F S @r{fraction and symbolic modes}
2055 N @r{interpret all fields as numbers, use 0 for non-numbers}
2056 T @r{force text interpretation}
2057 E @r{keep empty fields in ranges}
2058 @end example
2059
2060 @noindent
2061 In addition, you may provide a @code{printf} format specifier to
2062 reformat the final result. A few examples:
2063
2064 @example
2065 $1+$2 @r{Sum of first and second field}
2066 $1+$2;%.2f @r{Same, format result to two decimals}
2067 exp($2)+exp($1) @r{Math functions can be used}
2068 $0;%.1f @r{Reformat current cell to 1 decimal}
2069 ($3-32)*5/9 @r{Degrees F -> C conversion}
2070 $c/$1/$cm @r{Hz -> cm conversion, using @file{constants.el}}
2071 tan($1);Dp3s1 @r{Compute in degrees, precision 3, display SCI 1}
2072 sin($1);Dp3%.1e @r{Same, but use printf specifier for display}
2073 vmean($2..$7) @r{Compute column range mean, using vector function}
2074 vmean($2..$7);EN @r{Same, but treat empty fields as 0}
2075 taylor($3,x=7,2) @r{taylor series of $3, at x=7, second degree}
2076 @end example
2077
2078 Calc also contains a complete set of logical operations. For example
2079
2080 @example
2081 if($1<20,teen,string("")) @r{``teen'' if age $1 less than 20, else empty}
2082 @end example
2083
2084 @node Formula syntax for Lisp, Field formulas, Formula syntax for Calc, The spreadsheet
2085 @subsection Emacs Lisp forms as formulas
2086 @cindex Lisp forms, as table formulas
2087
2088 It is also possible to write a formula in Emacs Lisp; this can be useful
2089 for string manipulation and control structures, if Calc's
2090 functionality is not enough. If a formula starts with a single quote
2091 followed by an opening parenthesis, then it is evaluated as a lisp form.
2092 The evaluation should return either a string or a number. Just as with
2093 @file{calc} formulas, you can specify modes and a printf format after a
2094 semicolon. With Emacs Lisp forms, you need to be conscious about the way
2095 field references are interpolated into the form. By default, a
2096 reference will be interpolated as a Lisp string (in double quotes)
2097 containing the field. If you provide the @samp{N} mode switch, all
2098 referenced elements will be numbers (non-number fields will be zero) and
2099 interpolated as Lisp numbers, without quotes. If you provide the
2100 @samp{L} flag, all fields will be interpolated literally, without quotes.
2101 I.e., if you want a reference to be interpreted as a string by the Lisp
2102 form, enclose the reference operator itself in double quotes, like
2103 @code{"$3"}. Ranges are inserted as space-separated fields, so you can
2104 embed them in list or vector syntax. A few examples, note how the
2105 @samp{N} mode is used when we do computations in lisp.
2106
2107 @example
2108 @r{Swap the first two characters of the content of column 1}
2109 '(concat (substring $1 1 2) (substring $1 0 1) (substring $1 2))
2110 @r{Add columns 1 and 2, equivalent to Calc's @code{$1+$2}}
2111 '(+ $1 $2);N
2112 @r{Compute the sum of columns 1-4, like Calc's @code{vsum($1..$4)}}
2113 '(apply '+ '($1..$4));N
2114 @end example
2115
2116 @node Field formulas, Column formulas, Formula syntax for Lisp, The spreadsheet
2117 @subsection Field formulas
2118 @cindex field formula
2119 @cindex formula, for individual table field
2120
2121 To assign a formula to a particular field, type it directly into the
2122 field, preceded by @samp{:=}, for example @samp{:=$1+$2}. When you
2123 press @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in
2124 the field, the formula will be stored as the formula for this field,
2125 evaluated, and the current field replaced with the result.
2126
2127 Formulas are stored in a special line starting with @samp{#+TBLFM:}
2128 directly below the table. If you typed the equation in the 4th field of
2129 the 3rd data line in the table, the formula will look like
2130 @samp{@@3$4=$1+$2}. When inserting/deleting/swapping column and rows
2131 with the appropriate commands, @i{absolute references} (but not relative
2132 ones) in stored formulas are modified in order to still reference the
2133 same field. Of cause this is not true if you edit the table structure
2134 with normal editing commands - then you must fix the equations yourself.
2135 The left hand side of a formula may also be a named field (@pxref{Advanced
2136 features}), or a last-row reference like @samp{$LR3}.
2137
2138 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2139 following command
2140
2141 @table @kbd
2142 @kindex C-u C-c =
2143 @item C-u C-c =
2144 Install a new formula for the current field. The command prompts for a
2145 formula, with default taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM:} line, applies
2146 it to the current field and stores it.
2147 @end table
2148
2149 @node Column formulas, Editing and debugging formulas, Field formulas, The spreadsheet
2150 @subsection Column formulas
2151 @cindex column formula
2152 @cindex formula, for table column
2153
2154 Often in a table, the same formula should be used for all fields in a
2155 particular column. Instead of having to copy the formula to all fields
2156 in that column, Org allows to assign a single formula to an entire
2157 column. If the table contains horizontal separator hlines, everything
2158 before the first such line is considered part of the table @emph{header}
2159 and will not be modified by column formulas.
2160
2161 To assign a formula to a column, type it directly into any field in the
2162 column, preceded by an equal sign, like @samp{=$1+$2}. When you press
2163 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the
2164 field, the formula will be stored as the formula for the current column,
2165 evaluated and the current field replaced with the result. If the field
2166 contains only @samp{=}, the previously stored formula for this column is
2167 used. For each column, Org will only remember the most recently
2168 used formula. In the @samp{TBLFM:} line, column formulas will look like
2169 @samp{$4=$1+$2}.
2170
2171 Instead of typing an equation into the field, you may also use the
2172 following command:
2173
2174 @table @kbd
2175 @kindex C-c =
2176 @item C-c =
2177 Install a new formula for the current column and replace current field with
2178 the result of the formula. The command prompts for a formula, with default
2179 taken from the @samp{#+TBLFM} line, applies it to the current field and
2180 stores it. With a numeric prefix argument(e.g. @kbd{C-5 C-c =}) the command
2181 will apply it to that many consecutive fields in the current column.
2182 @end table
2183
2184 @node Editing and debugging formulas, Updating the table, Column formulas, The spreadsheet
2185 @subsection Editing and debugging formulas
2186 @cindex formula editing
2187 @cindex editing, of table formulas
2188
2189 You can edit individual formulas in the minibuffer or directly in the
2190 field. Org can also prepare a special buffer with all active
2191 formulas of a table. When offering a formula for editing, Org
2192 converts references to the standard format (like @code{B3} or @code{D&})
2193 if possible. If you prefer to only work with the internal format (like
2194 @code{@@3$2} or @code{$4}), configure the variable
2195 @code{org-table-use-standard-references}.
2196
2197 @table @kbd
2198 @kindex C-c =
2199 @kindex C-u C-c =
2200 @item C-c =
2201 @itemx C-u C-c =
2202 Edit the formula associated with the current column/field in the
2203 minibuffer. See @ref{Column formulas} and @ref{Field formulas}.
2204 @kindex C-u C-u C-c =
2205 @item C-u C-u C-c =
2206 Re-insert the active formula (either a
2207 field formula, or a column formula) into the current field, so that you
2208 can edit it directly in the field. The advantage over editing in the
2209 minibuffer is that you can use the command @kbd{C-c ?}.
2210 @kindex C-c ?
2211 @item C-c ?
2212 While editing a formula in a table field, highlight the field(s)
2213 referenced by the reference at the cursor position in the formula.
2214 @kindex C-c @}
2215 @item C-c @}
2216 Toggle the display of row and column numbers for a table, using
2217 overlays. These are updated each time the table is aligned, you can
2218 force it with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
2219 @kindex C-c @{
2220 @item C-c @{
2221 Toggle the formula debugger on and off. See below.
2222 @kindex C-c '
2223 @item C-c '
2224 Edit all formulas for the current table in a special buffer, where the
2225 formulas will be displayed one per line. If the current field has an
2226 active formula, the cursor in the formula editor will mark it.
2227 While inside the special buffer, Org will automatically highlight
2228 any field or range reference at the cursor position. You may edit,
2229 remove and add formulas, and use the following commands:
2230 @table @kbd
2231 @kindex C-c C-c
2232 @kindex C-x C-s
2233 @item C-c C-c
2234 @itemx C-x C-s
2235 Exit the formula editor and store the modified formulas. With @kbd{C-u}
2236 prefix, also apply the new formulas to the entire table.
2237 @kindex C-c C-q
2238 @item C-c C-q
2239 Exit the formula editor without installing changes.
2240 @kindex C-c C-r
2241 @item C-c C-r
2242 Toggle all references in the formula editor between standard (like
2243 @code{B3}) and internal (like @code{@@3$2}).
2244 @kindex @key{TAB}
2245 @item @key{TAB}
2246 Pretty-print or indent lisp formula at point. When in a line containing
2247 a lisp formula, format the formula according to Emacs Lisp rules.
2248 Another @key{TAB} collapses the formula back again. In the open
2249 formula, @key{TAB} re-indents just like in Emacs lisp mode.
2250 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
2251 @item M-@key{TAB}
2252 Complete Lisp symbols, just like in Emacs lisp mode.
2253 @kindex S-@key{up}
2254 @kindex S-@key{down}
2255 @kindex S-@key{left}
2256 @kindex S-@key{right}
2257 @item S-@key{up}/@key{down}/@key{left}/@key{right}
2258 Shift the reference at point. For example, if the reference is
2259 @code{B3} and you press @kbd{S-@key{right}}, it will become @code{C3}.
2260 This also works for relative references, and for hline references.
2261 @kindex M-S-@key{up}
2262 @kindex M-S-@key{down}
2263 @item M-S-@key{up}/@key{down}
2264 Move the test line for column formulas in the Org buffer up and
2265 down.
2266 @kindex M-@key{up}
2267 @kindex M-@key{down}
2268 @item M-@key{up}/@key{down}
2269 Scroll the window displaying the table.
2270 @kindex C-c @}
2271 @item C-c @}
2272 Turn the coordinate grid in the table on and off.
2273 @end table
2274 @end table
2275
2276 Making a table field blank does not remove the formula associated with
2277 the field, because that is stored in a different line (the @samp{TBLFM}
2278 line) - during the next recalculation the field will be filled again.
2279 To remove a formula from a field, you have to give an empty reply when
2280 prompted for the formula, or to edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} line.
2281
2282 @kindex C-c C-c
2283 You may edit the @samp{#+TBLFM} directly and re-apply the changed
2284 equations with @kbd{C-c C-c} in that line, or with the normal
2285 recalculation commands in the table.
2286
2287 @subsubheading Debugging formulas
2288 @cindex formula debugging
2289 @cindex debugging, of table formulas
2290 When the evaluation of a formula leads to an error, the field content
2291 becomes the string @samp{#ERROR}. If you would like see what is going
2292 on during variable substitution and calculation in order to find a bug,
2293 turn on formula debugging in the @code{Tbl} menu and repeat the
2294 calculation, for example by pressing @kbd{C-u C-u C-c = @key{RET}} in a
2295 field. Detailed information will be displayed.
2296
2297 @node Updating the table, Advanced features, Editing and debugging formulas, The spreadsheet
2298 @subsection Updating the table
2299 @cindex recomputing table fields
2300 @cindex updating, table
2301
2302 Recalculation of a table is normally not automatic, but needs to be
2303 triggered by a command. See @ref{Advanced features} for a way to make
2304 recalculation at least semi-automatically.
2305
2306 In order to recalculate a line of a table or the entire table, use the
2307 following commands:
2308
2309 @table @kbd
2310 @kindex C-c *
2311 @item C-c *
2312 Recalculate the current row by first applying the stored column formulas
2313 from left to right, and all field formulas in the current row.
2314 @c
2315 @kindex C-u C-c *
2316 @item C-u C-c *
2317 @kindex C-u C-c C-c
2318 @itemx C-u C-c C-c
2319 Recompute the entire table, line by line. Any lines before the first
2320 hline are left alone, assuming that these are part of the table header.
2321 @c
2322 @kindex C-u C-u C-c *
2323 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-c
2324 @item C-u C-u C-c *
2325 @itemx C-u C-u C-c C-c
2326 Iterate the table by recomputing it until no further changes occur.
2327 This may be necessary if some computed fields use the value of other
2328 fields that are computed @i{later} in the calculation sequence.
2329 @end table
2330
2331 @node Advanced features, , Updating the table, The spreadsheet
2332 @subsection Advanced features
2333
2334 If you want the recalculation of fields to happen automatically, or if
2335 you want to be able to assign @i{names} to fields and columns, you need
2336 to reserve the first column of the table for special marking characters.
2337 @table @kbd
2338 @kindex C-#
2339 @item C-#
2340 Rotate the calculation mark in first column through the states @samp{},
2341 @samp{#}, @samp{*}, @samp{!}, @samp{$}. When there is an active region,
2342 change all marks in the region.
2343 @end table
2344
2345 Here is an example of a table that collects exam results of students and
2346 makes use of these features:
2347
2348 @example
2349 @group
2350 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2351 | | Student | Prob 1 | Prob 2 | Prob 3 | Total | Note |
2352 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2353 | ! | | P1 | P2 | P3 | Tot | |
2354 | # | Maximum | 10 | 15 | 25 | 50 | 10.0 |
2355 | ^ | | m1 | m2 | m3 | mt | |
2356 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2357 | # | Peter | 10 | 8 | 23 | 41 | 8.2 |
2358 | # | Sam | 2 | 4 | 3 | 9 | 1.8 |
2359 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2360 | | Average | | | | 29.7 | |
2361 | ^ | | | | | at | |
2362 | $ | max=50 | | | | | |
2363 |---+---------+--------+--------+--------+-------+------|
2364 #+TBLFM: $6=vsum($P1..$P3)::$7=10*$Tot/$max;%.1f::$at=vmean(@@-II..@@-I);%.1f
2365 @end group
2366 @end example
2367
2368 @noindent @b{Important}: Please note that for these special tables,
2369 recalculating the table with @kbd{C-u C-c *} will only affect rows that
2370 are marked @samp{#} or @samp{*}, and fields that have a formula assigned
2371 to the field itself. The column formulas are not applied in rows with
2372 empty first field.
2373
2374 @cindex marking characters, tables
2375 The marking characters have the following meaning:
2376 @table @samp
2377 @item !
2378 The fields in this line define names for the columns, so that you may
2379 refer to a column as @samp{$Tot} instead of @samp{$6}.
2380 @item ^
2381 This row defines names for the fields @emph{above} the row. With such
2382 a definition, any formula in the table may use @samp{$m1} to refer to
2383 the value @samp{10}. Also, if you assign a formula to a names field, it
2384 will be stored as @samp{$name=...}.
2385 @item _
2386 Similar to @samp{^}, but defines names for the fields in the row
2387 @emph{below}.
2388 @item $
2389 Fields in this row can define @emph{parameters} for formulas. For
2390 example, if a field in a @samp{$} row contains @samp{max=50}, then
2391 formulas in this table can refer to the value 50 using @samp{$max}.
2392 Parameters work exactly like constants, only that they can be defined on
2393 a per-table basis.
2394 @item #
2395 Fields in this row are automatically recalculated when pressing
2396 @key{TAB} or @key{RET} or @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} in this row. Also, this row
2397 is selected for a global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}. Unmarked
2398 lines will be left alone by this command.
2399 @item *
2400 Selects this line for global recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}, but
2401 not for automatic recalculation. Use this when automatic
2402 recalculation slows down editing too much.
2403 @item
2404 Unmarked lines are exempt from recalculation with @kbd{C-u C-c *}.
2405 All lines that should be recalculated should be marked with @samp{#}
2406 or @samp{*}.
2407 @item /
2408 Do not export this line. Useful for lines that contain the narrowing
2409 @samp{<N>} markers.
2410 @end table
2411
2412 Finally, just to whet your appetite on what can be done with the
2413 fantastic @file{calc} package, here is a table that computes the Taylor
2414 series of degree @code{n} at location @code{x} for a couple of
2415 functions.
2416
2417 @example
2418 @group
2419 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2420 | | Func | n | x | Result |
2421 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2422 | # | exp(x) | 1 | x | 1 + x |
2423 | # | exp(x) | 2 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 |
2424 | # | exp(x) | 3 | x | 1 + x + x^2 / 2 + x^3 / 6 |
2425 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=0 | x*(0.5 / 0) + x^2 (2 - 0.25 / 0) / 2 |
2426 | # | x^2+sqrt(x) | 2 | x=1 | 2 + 2.5 x - 2.5 + 0.875 (x - 1)^2 |
2427 | * | tan(x) | 3 | x | 0.0175 x + 1.77e-6 x^3 |
2428 |---+-------------+---+-----+--------------------------------------|
2429 #+TBLFM: $5=taylor($2,$4,$3);n3
2430 @end group
2431 @end example
2432
2433 @page
2434 @node Org Plot, , The spreadsheet, Tables
2435 @section Org Plot
2436 @cindex graph, in tables
2437 @cindex plot tables using gnuplot
2438
2439 Org Plot can produce 2D and 3D graphs of information stored in org tables
2440 using @file{Gnuplot} @uref{http://www.gnuplot.info/} and @file{gnuplot-mode}
2441 @uref{http://cars9.uchicago.edu/~ravel/software/gnuplot-mode.html}. To see
2442 this in action ensure that you have both Gnuplot and Gnuplot-mode installed
2443 on your system, then call @code{org-plot/gnuplot} on the following table.
2444
2445 @example
2446 @group
2447 #+PLOT: title:"Citas" ind:1 deps:(3) type:2d with:histograms set:"yrange [0:]"
2448 | Sede | Max cites | H-index |
2449 |-----------+-----------+---------|
2450 | Chile | 257.72 | 21.39 |
2451 | Leeds | 165.77 | 19.68 |
2452 | Sao Paolo | 71.00 | 11.50 |
2453 | Stockholm | 134.19 | 14.33 |
2454 | Morelia | 257.56 | 17.67 |
2455 @end group
2456 @end example
2457
2458 Notice that Org Plot is smart enough to apply the tables headers as labels.
2459 Further control over the labels, type, content, and appearance of plots can
2460 be exercised through the @code{#+Plot:} lines preceding a table. See below
2461 for a complete list of Org plot options. For more information and examples
2462 see the org-plot tutorial at
2463 @uref{http://legito.org/worg/org-tutorials/org-plot.php}.
2464
2465 @subsubheading Plot Options
2466
2467 @table @code
2468 @item set
2469 Specify any @file{gnuplot} option to be set when graphing.
2470
2471 @item title
2472 Specify the title of the plot.
2473
2474 @item ind
2475 Specify which column of the table to use as the @code{x} axis.
2476
2477 @item deps
2478 Specify the columns to graph as a lisp style list, surrounded by parenthesis
2479 and separated by spaces for example @code{dep:(3 4)} to graph the third and
2480 fourth columns (defaults to graphing all other columns aside from the ind
2481 column).
2482
2483 @item type
2484 Specify whether the plot will be @code{2d}, @code{3d}, or @code{grid}.
2485
2486 @item with
2487 Specify a @code{with} option to be inserted for every col being plotted
2488 (e.g. @code{lines}, @code{points}, @code{boxes}, @code{impulses}, etc...).
2489 Defaults to 'lines'.
2490
2491 @item file
2492 If you want to plot to a file specify the @code{"path/to/desired/output-file"}.
2493
2494 @item labels
2495 List of labels to be used for the deps (defaults to column headers if they
2496 exist).
2497
2498 @item line
2499 Specify an entire line to be inserted in the gnuplot script.
2500
2501 @item map
2502 When plotting @code{3d} or @code{grid} types, set this to @code{t} to graph a
2503 flat mapping rather than a @code{3d} slope.
2504
2505 @item timefmt
2506 Specify format of org-mode timestamps as they will be parsed by gnuplot.
2507 Defaults to '%Y-%m-%d-%H:%M:%S'.
2508
2509 @item script
2510 If you want total control you can specify a script file (place the file name
2511 between double quotes) which will be used to plot. Before plotting, every
2512 instance of @code{$datafile} in the specified script will be replaced with
2513 the path to the generated data file. Note even if you set this option you
2514 may still want to specify the plot type, as that can impact the content of
2515 the data file.
2516 @end table
2517
2518 @node Hyperlinks, TODO Items, Tables, Top
2519 @chapter Hyperlinks
2520 @cindex hyperlinks
2521
2522 Like HTML, Org provides links inside a file, external links to
2523 other files, Usenet articles, emails, and much more.
2524
2525 @menu
2526 * Link format:: How links in Org are formatted
2527 * Internal links:: Links to other places in the current file
2528 * External links:: URL-like links to the world
2529 * Handling links:: Creating, inserting and following
2530 * Using links outside Org:: Linking from my C source code?
2531 * Link abbreviations:: Shortcuts for writing complex links
2532 * Search options:: Linking to a specific location
2533 * Custom searches:: When the default search is not enough
2534 @end menu
2535
2536 @node Link format, Internal links, Hyperlinks, Hyperlinks
2537 @section Link format
2538 @cindex link format
2539 @cindex format, of links
2540
2541 Org will recognize plain URL-like links and activate them as
2542 clickable links. The general link format, however, looks like this:
2543
2544 @example
2545 [[link][description]] @r{or alternatively} [[link]]
2546 @end example
2547
2548 Once a link in the buffer is complete (all brackets present), Org
2549 will change the display so that @samp{description} is displayed instead
2550 of @samp{[[link][description]]} and @samp{link} is displayed instead of
2551 @samp{[[link]]}. Links will be highlighted in the face @code{org-link},
2552 which by default is an underlined face. You can directly edit the
2553 visible part of a link. Note that this can be either the @samp{link}
2554 part (if there is no description) or the @samp{description} part. To
2555 edit also the invisible @samp{link} part, use @kbd{C-c C-l} with the
2556 cursor on the link.
2557
2558 If you place the cursor at the beginning or just behind the end of the
2559 displayed text and press @key{BACKSPACE}, you will remove the
2560 (invisible) bracket at that location. This makes the link incomplete
2561 and the internals are again displayed as plain text. Inserting the
2562 missing bracket hides the link internals again. To show the
2563 internal structure of all links, use the menu entry
2564 @code{Org->Hyperlinks->Literal links}.
2565
2566 @node Internal links, External links, Link format, Hyperlinks
2567 @section Internal links
2568 @cindex internal links
2569 @cindex links, internal
2570 @cindex targets, for links
2571
2572 If the link does not look like a URL, it is considered to be internal in
2573 the current file. Links such as @samp{[[My Target]]} or @samp{[[My
2574 Target][Find my target]]} lead to a text search in the current file.
2575 The link can be followed with @kbd{C-c C-o} when the cursor is on the
2576 link, or with a mouse click (@pxref{Handling links}). The preferred
2577 match for such a link is a dedicated target: the same string in double
2578 angular brackets. Targets may be located anywhere; sometimes it is
2579 convenient to put them into a comment line. For example
2580
2581 @example
2582 # <<My Target>>
2583 @end example
2584
2585 @noindent In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such targets will become
2586 named anchors for direct access through @samp{http} links@footnote{Note that
2587 text before the first headline is usually not exported, so the first such
2588 target should be after the first headline, or in the line directly before the
2589 first headline.}.
2590
2591 If no dedicated target exists, Org will search for the words in the
2592 link. In the above example the search would be for @samp{my target}.
2593 Links starting with a star like @samp{*My Target} restrict the search to
2594 headlines. When searching, Org mode will first try an exact match, but
2595 then move on to more and more lenient searches. For example, the link
2596 @samp{[[*My Targets]]} will find any of the following:
2597
2598 @example
2599 ** My targets
2600 ** TODO my targets are bright
2601 ** my 20 targets are
2602 @end example
2603
2604 To insert a link targeting a headline, in-buffer completion can be used.
2605 Just type a star followed by a few optional letters into the buffer and
2606 press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}}. All headlines in the current buffer will be
2607 offered as completions. @xref{Handling links}, for more commands
2608 creating links.
2609
2610 Following a link pushes a mark onto Org's own mark ring. You can
2611 return to the previous position with @kbd{C-c &}. Using this command
2612 several times in direct succession goes back to positions recorded
2613 earlier.
2614
2615 @menu
2616 * Radio targets:: Make targets trigger links in plain text
2617 @end menu
2618
2619 @node Radio targets, , Internal links, Internal links
2620 @subsection Radio targets
2621 @cindex radio targets
2622 @cindex targets, radio
2623 @cindex links, radio targets
2624
2625 Org can automatically turn any occurrences of certain target names
2626 in normal text into a link. So without explicitly creating a link, the
2627 text connects to the target radioing its position. Radio targets are
2628 enclosed by triple angular brackets. For example, a target @samp{<<<My
2629 Target>>>} causes each occurrence of @samp{my target} in normal text to
2630 become activated as a link. The Org file is scanned automatically
2631 for radio targets only when the file is first loaded into Emacs. To
2632 update the target list during editing, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
2633 cursor on or at a target.
2634
2635 @node External links, Handling links, Internal links, Hyperlinks
2636 @section External links
2637 @cindex links, external
2638 @cindex external links
2639 @cindex links, external
2640 @cindex Gnus links
2641 @cindex BBDB links
2642 @cindex IRC links
2643 @cindex URL links
2644 @cindex file links
2645 @cindex VM links
2646 @cindex RMAIL links
2647 @cindex WANDERLUST links
2648 @cindex MH-E links
2649 @cindex USENET links
2650 @cindex SHELL links
2651 @cindex Info links
2652 @cindex elisp links
2653
2654 Org supports links to files, websites, Usenet and email messages,
2655 BBDB database entries and links to both IRC conversations and their
2656 logs. External links are URL-like locators. They start with a short
2657 identifying string followed by a colon. There can be no space after
2658 the colon. The following list shows examples for each link type.
2659
2660 @example
2661 http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik @r{on the web}
2662 file:/home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{file, absolute path}
2663 /home/dominik/images/jupiter.jpg @r{same as above}
2664 file:papers/last.pdf @r{file, relative path}
2665 ./papers/last.pdf @r{same as above}
2666 file:projects.org @r{another org file}
2667 file:projects.org::some words @r{text search in org file}
2668 file:projects.org::*task title @r{heading search in org file}
2669 id:B7423F4D-2E8A-471B-8810-C40F074717E9 @r{Link to heading by ID}
2670 news:comp.emacs @r{Usenet link}
2671 mailto:adent@@galaxy.net @r{Mail link}
2672 vm:folder @r{VM folder link}
2673 vm:folder#id @r{VM message link}
2674 vm://myself@@some.where.org/folder#id @r{VM on remote machine}
2675 wl:folder @r{WANDERLUST folder link}
2676 wl:folder#id @r{WANDERLUST message link}
2677 mhe:folder @r{MH-E folder link}
2678 mhe:folder#id @r{MH-E message link}
2679 rmail:folder @r{RMAIL folder link}
2680 rmail:folder#id @r{RMAIL message link}
2681 gnus:group @r{Gnus group link}
2682 gnus:group#id @r{Gnus article link}
2683 bbdb:R.*Stallman @r{BBDB link (with regexp)}
2684 irc:/irc.com/#emacs/bob @r{IRC link}
2685 shell:ls *.org @r{A shell command}
2686 elisp:org-agenda @r{Interactive elisp command}
2687 elisp:(find-file-other-frame "Elisp.org") @r{Elisp form to evaluate}
2688 @end example
2689
2690 A link should be enclosed in double brackets and may contain a
2691 descriptive text to be displayed instead of the URL (@pxref{Link
2692 format}), for example:
2693
2694 @example
2695 [[http://www.gnu.org/software/emacs/][GNU Emacs]]
2696 @end example
2697
2698 @noindent
2699 If the description is a file name or URL that points to an image, HTML
2700 export (@pxref{HTML export}) will inline the image as a clickable
2701 button. If there is no description at all and the link points to an
2702 image,
2703 that image will be inlined into the exported HTML file.
2704
2705 @cindex angular brackets, around links
2706 @cindex plain text external links
2707 Org also finds external links in the normal text and activates them
2708 as links. If spaces must be part of the link (for example in
2709 @samp{bbdb:Richard Stallman}), or if you need to remove ambiguities
2710 about the end of the link, enclose them in angular brackets.
2711
2712 @node Handling links, Using links outside Org, External links, Hyperlinks
2713 @section Handling links
2714 @cindex links, handling
2715
2716 Org provides methods to create a link in the correct syntax, to
2717 insert it into an Org file, and to follow the link.
2718
2719 @table @kbd
2720 @kindex C-c l
2721 @cindex storing links
2722 @item C-c l
2723 Store a link to the current location. This is a @emph{global} command (you
2724 must create the key binding yourself) which can be used in any buffer to
2725 create a link. The link will be stored for later insertion into an Org
2726 buffer (see below).
2727
2728 For Org files, if there is a @samp{<<target>>} at the cursor, the link points
2729 to the target. Otherwise it points to the current headline, either by text
2730 (unsafe), or, if @file{org-id.el} is loaded and @code{org-link-to-org-use-id}
2731 is set, by ID property.
2732
2733 For VM, Rmail, Wanderlust, MH-E, Gnus and BBDB buffers, the link will
2734 indicate the current article/entry. For W3 and W3M buffers, the link goes to
2735 the current URL. For IRC links, if you set the variable
2736 @code{org-irc-link-to-logs} to non-nil then @kbd{C-c l} will store a
2737 @samp{file:/} style link to the relevant point in the logs for the current
2738 conversation. Otherwise an @samp{irc:/} style link to the user/channel/server
2739 under the point will be stored.
2740
2741 For any other files, the link will point to the file, with a search string
2742 (@pxref{Search options}) pointing to the contents of the current line. If
2743 there is an active region, the selected words will form the basis of the
2744 search string. If the automatically created link is not working correctly or
2745 accurately enough, you can write custom functions to select the search string
2746 and to do the search for particular file types - see @ref{Custom searches}.
2747 The key binding @kbd{C-c l} is only a suggestion - see @ref{Installation}.
2748 @c
2749 @kindex C-c C-l
2750 @cindex link completion
2751 @cindex completion, of links
2752 @cindex inserting links
2753 @item C-c C-l
2754 Insert a link. This prompts for a link to be inserted into the buffer. You
2755 can just type a link, using text for an internal link, or one of the link
2756 type prefixes mentioned in the examples above. All links stored during the
2757 current session are part of the history for this prompt, so you can access
2758 them with @key{up} and @key{down} (or @kbd{M-p/n}). Completion, on the other
2759 hand, will help you to insert valid link prefixes like @samp{http:} or
2760 @samp{ftp:}, including the prefixes defined through link abbreviations
2761 (@pxref{Link abbreviations}). The link will be inserted into the
2762 buffer@footnote{After insertion of a stored link, the link will be removed
2763 from the list of stored links. To keep it in the list later use, use a
2764 triple @kbd{C-u} prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-l}, or configure the option
2765 @code{org-keep-stored-link-after-insertion}.}, along with a descriptive text.
2766 If some text was selected when this command is called, the selected text
2767 becomes the default description.@* Note that you don't have to use this
2768 command to insert a link. Links in Org are plain text, and you can type
2769 or paste them straight into the buffer. By using this command, the links are
2770 automatically enclosed in double brackets, and you will be asked for the
2771 optional descriptive text.
2772 @c
2773 @c If the link is a @samp{file:} link and
2774 @c the linked file is located in the same directory as the current file or
2775 @c a subdirectory of it, the path of the file will be inserted relative to
2776 @c the current directory.
2777 @c
2778 @kindex C-u C-c C-l
2779 @cindex file name completion
2780 @cindex completion, of file names
2781 @item C-u C-c C-l
2782 When @kbd{C-c C-l} is called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, a link to
2783 a file will be inserted and you may use file name completion to select
2784 the name of the file. The path to the file is inserted relative to the
2785 directory of the current org file, if the linked file is in the current
2786 directory or in a sub-directory of it, or if the path is written relative
2787 to the current directory using @samp{../}. Otherwise an absolute path
2788 is used, if possible with @samp{~/} for your home directory. You can
2789 force an absolute path with two @kbd{C-u} prefixes.
2790 @c
2791 @item C-c C-l @r{(with cursor on existing link)}
2792 When the cursor is on an existing link, @kbd{C-c C-l} allows you to edit the
2793 link and description parts of the link.
2794 @c
2795 @cindex following links
2796 @kindex C-c C-o
2797 @item C-c C-o
2798 Open link at point. This will launch a web browser for URLs (using
2799 @command{browse-url-at-point}), run VM/MH-E/Wanderlust/Rmail/Gnus/BBDB for
2800 the corresponding links, and execute the command in a shell link. When the
2801 cursor is on an internal link, this commands runs the corresponding search.
2802 When the cursor is on a TAG list in a headline, it creates the corresponding
2803 TAGS view. If the cursor is on a time stamp, it compiles the agenda for that
2804 date. Furthermore, it will visit text and remote files in @samp{file:} links
2805 with Emacs and select a suitable application for local non-text files.
2806 Classification of files is based on file extension only. See option
2807 @code{org-file-apps}. If you want to override the default application and
2808 visit the file with Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u} prefix. If you want to avoid
2809 opening in Emacs, use a @kbd{C-u C-u} prefix.
2810 @c
2811 @kindex mouse-2
2812 @kindex mouse-1
2813 @item mouse-2
2814 @itemx mouse-1
2815 On links, @kbd{mouse-2} will open the link just as @kbd{C-c C-o}
2816 would. Under Emacs 22, also @kbd{mouse-1} will follow a link.
2817 @c
2818 @kindex mouse-3
2819 @item mouse-3
2820 Like @kbd{mouse-2}, but force file links to be opened with Emacs, and
2821 internal links to be displayed in another window@footnote{See the
2822 variable @code{org-display-internal-link-with-indirect-buffer}}.
2823 @c
2824 @cindex mark ring
2825 @kindex C-c %
2826 @item C-c %
2827 Push the current position onto the mark ring, to be able to return
2828 easily. Commands following an internal link do this automatically.
2829 @c
2830 @cindex links, returning to
2831 @kindex C-c &
2832 @item C-c &
2833 Jump back to a recorded position. A position is recorded by the
2834 commands following internal links, and by @kbd{C-c %}. Using this
2835 command several times in direct succession moves through a ring of
2836 previously recorded positions.
2837 @c
2838 @kindex C-c C-x C-n
2839 @kindex C-c C-x C-p
2840 @cindex links, finding next/previous
2841 @item C-c C-x C-n
2842 @itemx C-c C-x C-p
2843 Move forward/backward to the next link in the buffer. At the limit of
2844 the buffer, the search fails once, and then wraps around. The key
2845 bindings for this are really too long, you might want to bind this also
2846 to @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p}
2847 @lisp
2848 (add-hook 'org-load-hook
2849 (lambda ()
2850 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-n" 'org-next-link)
2851 (define-key 'org-mode-map "\C-p" 'org-previous-link)))
2852 @end lisp
2853 @end table
2854
2855 @node Using links outside Org, Link abbreviations, Handling links, Hyperlinks
2856 @section Using links outside Org
2857
2858 You can insert and follow links that have Org syntax not only in
2859 Org, but in any Emacs buffer. For this, you should create two
2860 global commands, like this (please select suitable global keys
2861 yourself):
2862
2863 @lisp
2864 (global-set-key "\C-c L" 'org-insert-link-global)
2865 (global-set-key "\C-c o" 'org-open-at-point-global)
2866 @end lisp
2867
2868 @node Link abbreviations, Search options, Using links outside Org, Hyperlinks
2869 @section Link abbreviations
2870 @cindex link abbreviations
2871 @cindex abbreviation, links
2872
2873 Long URLs can be cumbersome to type, and often many similar links are
2874 needed in a document. For this you can use link abbreviations. An
2875 abbreviated link looks like this
2876
2877 @example
2878 [[linkword:tag][description]]
2879 @end example
2880
2881 @noindent
2882 where the tag is optional. Such abbreviations are resolved according to
2883 the information in the variable @code{org-link-abbrev-alist} that
2884 relates the linkwords to replacement text. Here is an example:
2885
2886 @lisp
2887 @group
2888 (setq org-link-abbrev-alist
2889 '(("bugzilla" . "http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=")
2890 ("google" . "http://www.google.com/search?q=")
2891 ("ads" . "http://adsabs.harvard.edu/cgi-bin/
2892 nph-abs_connect?author=%s&db_key=AST")))
2893 @end group
2894 @end lisp
2895
2896 If the replacement text contains the string @samp{%s}, it will be
2897 replaced with the tag. Otherwise the tag will be appended to the string
2898 in order to create the link. You may also specify a function that will
2899 be called with the tag as the only argument to create the link.
2900
2901 With the above setting, you could link to a specific bug with
2902 @code{[[bugzilla:129]]}, search the web for @samp{OrgMode} with
2903 @code{[[google:OrgMode]]} and find out what the Org author is
2904 doing besides Emacs hacking with @code{[[ads:Dominik,C]]}.
2905
2906 If you need special abbreviations just for a single Org buffer, you
2907 can define them in the file with
2908
2909 @example
2910 #+LINK: bugzilla http://10.1.2.9/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=
2911 #+LINK: google http://www.google.com/search?q=%s
2912 @end example
2913
2914 @noindent
2915 In-buffer completion @pxref{Completion} can be used after @samp{[} to
2916 complete link abbreviations.
2917
2918 @node Search options, Custom searches, Link abbreviations, Hyperlinks
2919 @section Search options in file links
2920 @cindex search option in file links
2921 @cindex file links, searching
2922
2923 File links can contain additional information to make Emacs jump to a
2924 particular location in the file when following a link. This can be a
2925 line number or a search option after a double@footnote{For backward
2926 compatibility, line numbers can also follow a single colon.} colon. For
2927 example, when the command @kbd{C-c l} creates a link (@pxref{Handling
2928 links}) to a file, it encodes the words in the current line as a search
2929 string that can be used to find this line back later when following the
2930 link with @kbd{C-c C-o}.
2931
2932 Here is the syntax of the different ways to attach a search to a file
2933 link, together with an explanation:
2934
2935 @example
2936 [[file:~/code/main.c::255]]
2937 [[file:~/xx.org::My Target]]
2938 [[file:~/xx.org::*My Target]]
2939 [[file:~/xx.org::/regexp/]]
2940 @end example
2941
2942 @table @code
2943 @item 255
2944 Jump to line 255.
2945 @item My Target
2946 Search for a link target @samp{<<My Target>>}, or do a text search for
2947 @samp{my target}, similar to the search in internal links, see
2948 @ref{Internal links}. In HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), such a file
2949 link will become an HTML reference to the corresponding named anchor in
2950 the linked file.
2951 @item *My Target
2952 In an Org file, restrict search to headlines.
2953 @item /regexp/
2954 Do a regular expression search for @code{regexp}. This uses the Emacs
2955 command @code{occur} to list all matches in a separate window. If the
2956 target file is in Org mode, @code{org-occur} is used to create a
2957 sparse tree with the matches.
2958 @c If the target file is a directory,
2959 @c @code{grep} will be used to search all files in the directory.
2960 @end table
2961
2962 As a degenerate case, a file link with an empty file name can be used
2963 to search the current file. For example, @code{[[file:::find me]]} does
2964 a search for @samp{find me} in the current file, just as
2965 @samp{[[find me]]} would.
2966
2967 @node Custom searches, , Search options, Hyperlinks
2968 @section Custom Searches
2969 @cindex custom search strings
2970 @cindex search strings, custom
2971
2972 The default mechanism for creating search strings and for doing the
2973 actual search related to a file link may not work correctly in all
2974 cases. For example, BibTeX database files have many entries like
2975 @samp{year="1993"} which would not result in good search strings,
2976 because the only unique identification for a BibTeX entry is the
2977 citation key.
2978
2979 If you come across such a problem, you can write custom functions to set
2980 the right search string for a particular file type, and to do the search
2981 for the string in the file. Using @code{add-hook}, these functions need
2982 to be added to the hook variables
2983 @code{org-create-file-search-functions} and
2984 @code{org-execute-file-search-functions}. See the docstring for these
2985 variables for more information. Org actually uses this mechanism
2986 for Bib@TeX{} database files, and you can use the corresponding code as
2987 an implementation example. See the file @file{org-bibtex.el}.
2988
2989 @node TODO Items, Tags, Hyperlinks, Top
2990 @chapter TODO Items
2991 @cindex TODO items
2992
2993 Org mode does not maintain TODO lists as separate documents@footnote{Of
2994 course, you can make a document that contains only long lists of TODO items,
2995 but this is not required.}. Instead, TODO items are an integral part of the
2996 notes file, because TODO items usually come up while taking notes! With Org
2997 mode, simply mark any entry in a tree as being a TODO item. In this way,
2998 information is not duplicated, and the entire context from which the TODO
2999 item emerged is always present.
3000
3001 Of course, this technique for managing TODO items scatters them
3002 throughout your notes file. Org mode compensates for this by providing
3003 methods to give you an overview of all the things that you have to do.
3004
3005 @menu
3006 * TODO basics:: Marking and displaying TODO entries
3007 * TODO extensions:: Workflow and assignments
3008 * Progress logging:: Dates and notes for progress
3009 * Priorities:: Some things are more important than others
3010 * Breaking down tasks:: Splitting a task into manageable pieces
3011 * Checkboxes:: Tick-off lists
3012 @end menu
3013
3014 @node TODO basics, TODO extensions, TODO Items, TODO Items
3015 @section Basic TODO functionality
3016
3017 Any headline becomes a TODO item when it starts with the word
3018 @samp{TODO}, for example:
3019
3020 @example
3021 *** TODO Write letter to Sam Fortune
3022 @end example
3023
3024 @noindent
3025 The most important commands to work with TODO entries are:
3026
3027 @table @kbd
3028 @kindex C-c C-t
3029 @cindex cycling, of TODO states
3030 @item C-c C-t
3031 Rotate the TODO state of the current item among
3032
3033 @example
3034 ,-> (unmarked) -> TODO -> DONE --.
3035 '--------------------------------'
3036 @end example
3037
3038 The same rotation can also be done ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3039 agenda buffers with the @kbd{t} command key (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3040
3041 @kindex C-u C-c C-t
3042 @item C-u C-c C-t
3043 Select a specific keyword using completion or (if it has been set up)
3044 the fast selection interface. For the latter, you need to assign keys
3045 to TODO states, see @ref{Per-file keywords} and @ref{Setting tags} for
3046 more information.
3047
3048 @kindex S-@key{right}
3049 @kindex S-@key{left}
3050 @item S-@key{right}
3051 @itemx S-@key{left}
3052 Select the following/preceding TODO state, similar to cycling. Useful
3053 mostly if more than two TODO states are possible (@pxref{TODO
3054 extensions}). See also @ref{Conflicts} for a discussion of the interaction
3055 with @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3056 @kindex C-c C-v
3057 @kindex C-c / t
3058 @cindex sparse tree, for TODO
3059 @item C-c C-v
3060 @itemx C-c / t
3061 View TODO items in a @emph{sparse tree} (@pxref{Sparse trees}). Folds
3062 the entire buffer, but shows all TODO items and the headings hierarchy
3063 above them. With a prefix argument, search for a specific TODO. You will be
3064 prompted for the keyword, and you can also give a list of keywords like
3065 @code{KWD1|KWD2|...}. With numeric prefix argument N, show the tree for the
3066 Nth keyword in the variable @code{org-todo-keywords}. With two prefix
3067 arguments, find all TODO and DONE entries.
3068 @kindex C-c a t
3069 @item C-c a t
3070 Show the global TODO list. Collects the TODO items from all agenda
3071 files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The new buffer will
3072 be in @code{agenda-mode}, which provides commands to examine and
3073 manipulate the TODO entries from the new buffer (@pxref{Agenda
3074 commands}). @xref{Global TODO list}, for more information.
3075 @kindex S-M-@key{RET}
3076 @item S-M-@key{RET}
3077 Insert a new TODO entry below the current one.
3078 @end table
3079
3080 @noindent
3081 Changing a TODO state can also trigger tag changes. See the docstring of the
3082 option @code{org-todo-state-tags-triggers} for details.
3083
3084 @node TODO extensions, Progress logging, TODO basics, TODO Items
3085 @section Extended use of TODO keywords
3086 @cindex extended TODO keywords
3087
3088 By default, marked TODO entries have one of only two states: TODO and
3089 DONE. Org mode allows you to classify TODO items in more complex ways
3090 with @emph{TODO keywords} (stored in @code{org-todo-keywords}). With
3091 special setup, the TODO keyword system can work differently in different
3092 files.
3093
3094 Note that @i{tags} are another way to classify headlines in general and
3095 TODO items in particular (@pxref{Tags}).
3096
3097 @menu
3098 * Workflow states:: From TODO to DONE in steps
3099 * TODO types:: I do this, Fred does the rest
3100 * Multiple sets in one file:: Mixing it all, and still finding your way
3101 * Fast access to TODO states:: Single letter selection of a state
3102 * Per-file keywords:: Different files, different requirements
3103 * Faces for TODO keywords:: Highlighting states
3104 * TODO dependencies:: When one tasks needs to wait for others
3105 @end menu
3106
3107 @node Workflow states, TODO types, TODO extensions, TODO extensions
3108 @subsection TODO keywords as workflow states
3109 @cindex TODO workflow
3110 @cindex workflow states as TODO keywords
3111
3112 You can use TODO keywords to indicate different @emph{sequential} states
3113 in the process of working on an item, for example@footnote{Changing
3114 this variable only becomes effective after restarting Org mode in a
3115 buffer.}:
3116
3117 @lisp
3118 (setq org-todo-keywords
3119 '((sequence "TODO" "FEEDBACK" "VERIFY" "|" "DONE" "DELEGATED")))
3120 @end lisp
3121
3122 The vertical bar separates the TODO keywords (states that @emph{need
3123 action}) from the DONE states (which need @emph{no further action}). If
3124 you don't provide the separator bar, the last state is used as the DONE
3125 state.
3126 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
3127 With this setup, the command @kbd{C-c C-t} will cycle an entry from TODO
3128 to FEEDBACK, then to VERIFY, and finally to DONE and DELEGATED. You may
3129 also use a numeric prefix argument to quickly select a specific state. For
3130 example @kbd{C-3 C-c C-t} will change the state immediately to VERIFY.
3131 Or you can use @kbd{S-left} to go backward through the sequence. If you
3132 define many keywords, you can use in-buffer completion
3133 (@pxref{Completion}) or even a special one-key selection scheme
3134 (@pxref{Fast access to TODO states}) to insert these words into the
3135 buffer. Changing a TODO state can be logged with a timestamp, see
3136 @ref{Tracking TODO state changes} for more information.
3137
3138 @node TODO types, Multiple sets in one file, Workflow states, TODO extensions
3139 @subsection TODO keywords as types
3140 @cindex TODO types
3141 @cindex names as TODO keywords
3142 @cindex types as TODO keywords
3143
3144 The second possibility is to use TODO keywords to indicate different
3145 @emph{types} of action items. For example, you might want to indicate
3146 that items are for ``work'' or ``home''. Or, when you work with several
3147 people on a single project, you might want to assign action items
3148 directly to persons, by using their names as TODO keywords. This would
3149 be set up like this:
3150
3151 @lisp
3152 (setq org-todo-keywords '((type "Fred" "Sara" "Lucy" "|" "DONE")))
3153 @end lisp
3154
3155 In this case, different keywords do not indicate a sequence, but rather
3156 different types. So the normal work flow would be to assign a task to a
3157 person, and later to mark it DONE. Org mode supports this style by adapting
3158 the workings of the command @kbd{C-c C-t}@footnote{This is also true for the
3159 @kbd{t} command in the timeline and agenda buffers.}. When used several
3160 times in succession, it will still cycle through all names, in order to first
3161 select the right type for a task. But when you return to the item after some
3162 time and execute @kbd{C-c C-t} again, it will switch from any name directly
3163 to DONE. Use prefix arguments or completion to quickly select a specific
3164 name. You can also review the items of a specific TODO type in a sparse tree
3165 by using a numeric prefix to @kbd{C-c C-v}. For example, to see all things
3166 Lucy has to do, you would use @kbd{C-3 C-c C-v}. To collect Lucy's items
3167 from all agenda files into a single buffer, you would use the numeric prefix
3168 argument as well when creating the global TODO list: @kbd{C-3 C-c t}.
3169
3170 @node Multiple sets in one file, Fast access to TODO states, TODO types, TODO extensions
3171 @subsection Multiple keyword sets in one file
3172 @cindex TODO keyword sets
3173
3174 Sometimes you may want to use different sets of TODO keywords in
3175 parallel. For example, you may want to have the basic
3176 @code{TODO}/@code{DONE}, but also a workflow for bug fixing, and a
3177 separate state indicating that an item has been canceled (so it is not
3178 DONE, but also does not require action). Your setup would then look
3179 like this:
3180
3181 @lisp
3182 (setq org-todo-keywords
3183 '((sequence "TODO" "|" "DONE")
3184 (sequence "REPORT" "BUG" "KNOWNCAUSE" "|" "FIXED")
3185 (sequence "|" "CANCELED")))
3186 @end lisp
3187
3188 The keywords should all be different, this helps Org mode to keep track
3189 of which subsequence should be used for a given entry. In this setup,
3190 @kbd{C-c C-t} only operates within a subsequence, so it switches from
3191 @code{DONE} to (nothing) to @code{TODO}, and from @code{FIXED} to
3192 (nothing) to @code{REPORT}. Therefore you need a mechanism to initially
3193 select the correct sequence. Besides the obvious ways like typing a
3194 keyword or using completion, you may also apply the following commands:
3195
3196 @table @kbd
3197 @kindex C-S-@key{right}
3198 @kindex C-S-@key{left}
3199 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-t
3200 @item C-u C-u C-c C-t
3201 @itemx C-S-@key{right}
3202 @itemx C-S-@key{left}
3203 These keys jump from one TODO subset to the next. In the above example,
3204 @kbd{C-u C-u C-c C-t} or @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} would jump from @code{TODO} or
3205 @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT}, and any of the words in the second row to
3206 @code{CANCELED}. Note that the @kbd{C-S-} key binding conflict with
3207 @code{shift-selection-mode} (@pxref{Conflicts}).
3208 @kindex S-@key{right}
3209 @kindex S-@key{left}
3210 @item S-@key{right}
3211 @itemx S-@key{left}
3212 @kbd{S-@key{<left>}} and @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} and walk through @emph{all}
3213 keywords from all sets, so for example @kbd{S-@key{<right>}} would switch
3214 from @code{DONE} to @code{REPORT} in the example above. See also
3215 @ref{Conflicts} for a discussion of the interaction with
3216 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3217 @end table
3218
3219 @node Fast access to TODO states, Per-file keywords, Multiple sets in one file, TODO extensions
3220 @subsection Fast access to TODO states
3221
3222 If you would like to quickly change an entry to an arbitrary TODO state
3223 instead of cycling through the states, you can set up keys for
3224 single-letter access to the states. This is done by adding the section
3225 key after each keyword, in parenthesis. For example:
3226
3227 @lisp
3228 (setq org-todo-keywords
3229 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "|" "DONE(d)")
3230 (sequence "REPORT(r)" "BUG(b)" "KNOWNCAUSE(k)" "|" "FIXED(f)")
3231 (sequence "|" "CANCELED(c)")))
3232 @end lisp
3233
3234 If you then press @code{C-u C-c C-t} followed by the selection key, the
3235 entry will be switched to this state. @key{SPC} can be used to remove
3236 any TODO keyword from an entry. Should you like this way of selecting
3237 TODO states a lot, you might want to set the variable
3238 @code{org-use-fast-todo-selection} to @code{t} and make this behavior
3239 the default. Check also the variable
3240 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-include-todo}, it allows to change the TODO
3241 state through the tags interface (@pxref{Setting tags}), in case you
3242 like to mingle the two concepts.
3243
3244 @node Per-file keywords, Faces for TODO keywords, Fast access to TODO states, TODO extensions
3245 @subsection Setting up keywords for individual files
3246 @cindex keyword options
3247 @cindex per-file keywords
3248
3249 It can be very useful to use different aspects of the TODO mechanism in
3250 different files. For file-local settings, you need to add special lines
3251 to the file which set the keywords and interpretation for that file
3252 only. For example, to set one of the two examples discussed above, you
3253 need one of the following lines, starting in column zero anywhere in the
3254 file:
3255
3256 @example
3257 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO FEEDBACK VERIFY | DONE CANCELED
3258 @end example
3259 or
3260 @example
3261 #+TYP_TODO: Fred Sara Lucy Mike | DONE
3262 @end example
3263
3264 A setup for using several sets in parallel would be:
3265
3266 @example
3267 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO | DONE
3268 #+SEQ_TODO: REPORT BUG KNOWNCAUSE | FIXED
3269 #+SEQ_TODO: | CANCELED
3270 @end example
3271
3272 @cindex completion, of option keywords
3273 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3274 @noindent To make sure you are using the correct keyword, type
3275 @samp{#+} into the buffer and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion.
3276
3277 @cindex DONE, final TODO keyword
3278 Remember that the keywords after the vertical bar (or the last keyword
3279 if no bar is there) must always mean that the item is DONE (although you
3280 may use a different word). After changing one of these lines, use
3281 @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to make the changes
3282 known to Org mode@footnote{Org mode parses these lines only when
3283 Org mode is activated after visiting a file. @kbd{C-c C-c} with the
3284 cursor in a line starting with @samp{#+} is simply restarting Org mode
3285 for the current buffer.}.
3286
3287 @node Faces for TODO keywords, TODO dependencies, Per-file keywords, TODO extensions
3288 @subsection Faces for TODO keywords
3289 @cindex faces, for TODO keywords
3290
3291 Org mode highlights TODO keywords with special faces: @code{org-todo}
3292 for keywords indicating that an item still has to be acted upon, and
3293 @code{org-done} for keywords indicating that an item is finished. If
3294 you are using more than 2 different states, you might want to use
3295 special faces for some of them. This can be done using the variable
3296 @code{org-todo-keyword-faces}. For example:
3297
3298 @lisp
3299 @group
3300 (setq org-todo-keyword-faces
3301 '(("TODO" . org-warning)
3302 ("DEFERRED" . shadow)
3303 ("CANCELED" . (:foreground "blue" :weight bold))))
3304 @end group
3305 @end lisp
3306
3307 While using a list with face properties as shown for CANCELED
3308 @emph{should} work, this does not aways seem to be the case. If
3309 necessary, define a special face and use that.
3310
3311 @node TODO dependencies, , Faces for TODO keywords, TODO extensions
3312 @subsection TODO dependencies
3313
3314 The structure of Org files (hierarchy and lists) makes it easy to define TODO
3315 dependencies. Usually, a parent TODO task should not be marked DONE until
3316 all subtasks (defined as children tasks) are marked as DONE. And sometimes
3317 there is a logical sequence to a number of (sub)tasks, so that one task
3318 cannot be acted upon before all siblings above it are done. If you customize
3319 the variable @code{org-enforce-todo-dependencies}, Org will block entries
3320 from changing state while they have children that are not DONE. Furthermore,
3321 if an entry has a property @code{ORDERED}, each of its children will be
3322 blocked until all earlier siblings are marked DONE. Here is an example:
3323
3324 @example
3325 * TODO Blocked until (two) is done
3326 ** DONE one
3327 ** TODO two
3328
3329 * Parent
3330 :PROPERTIES:
3331 :ORDERED: t
3332 :END:
3333 ** TODO a
3334 ** TODO b, needs to wait for (a)
3335 ** TODO c, needs to wait for (a) and (b)
3336 @end example
3337
3338 If you set the variable @code{org-agenda-dim-blocked-tasks}, TODO entries
3339 that cannot be closed because of such dependencies will be shown in a dimmed
3340 font or even made invisible in agenda views (@pxref{Agenda Views}).
3341
3342 If you need more complex dependency structures, for example dependencies
3343 between entries in different trees or files, check out the contributed
3344 module @file{org-depend.el}.
3345
3346 @page
3347 @node Progress logging, Priorities, TODO extensions, TODO Items
3348 @section Progress logging
3349 @cindex progress logging
3350 @cindex logging, of progress
3351
3352 Org mode can automatically record a time stamp and possibly a note when
3353 you mark a TODO item as DONE, or even each time you change the state of
3354 a TODO item. This system is highly configurable, settings can be on a
3355 per-keyword basis and can be localized to a file or even a subtree. For
3356 information on how to clock working time for a task, see @ref{Clocking
3357 work time}.
3358
3359 @menu
3360 * Closing items:: When was this entry marked DONE?
3361 * Tracking TODO state changes:: When did the status change?
3362 @end menu
3363
3364 @node Closing items, Tracking TODO state changes, Progress logging, Progress logging
3365 @subsection Closing items
3366
3367 The most basic logging is to keep track of @emph{when} a certain TODO
3368 item was finished. This is achieved with@footnote{The corresponding
3369 in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: logdone}}.
3370
3371 @lisp
3372 (setq org-log-done 'time)
3373 @end lisp
3374
3375 @noindent
3376 Then each time you turn an entry from a TODO (not-done) state into any
3377 of the DONE states, a line @samp{CLOSED: [timestamp]} will be inserted
3378 just after the headline. If you turn the entry back into a TODO item
3379 through further state cycling, that line will be removed again. If you
3380 want to record a note along with the timestamp, use@footnote{The
3381 corresponding in-buffer setting is: @code{#+STARTUP: lognotedone}}
3382
3383 @lisp
3384 (setq org-log-done 'note)
3385 @end lisp
3386
3387 @noindent
3388 You will then be prompted for a note, and that note will be stored below
3389 the entry with a @samp{Closing Note} heading.
3390
3391 In the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in the agenda
3392 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), you can then use the @kbd{l} key to
3393 display the TODO items with a @samp{CLOSED} timestamp on each day,
3394 giving you an overview of what has been done.
3395
3396 @node Tracking TODO state changes, , Closing items, Progress logging
3397 @subsection Tracking TODO state changes
3398
3399 When TODO keywords are used as workflow states (@pxref{Workflow
3400 states}), you might want to keep track of when a state change occurred
3401 and maybe take a note about this change. Since it is normally too much
3402 to record a note for every state, Org mode expects configuration on a
3403 per-keyword basis for this. This is achieved by adding special markers
3404 @samp{!} (for a time stamp) and @samp{@@} (for a note) in parenthesis
3405 after each keyword. For example, with the setting
3406
3407 @lisp
3408 (setq org-todo-keywords
3409 '((sequence "TODO(t)" "WAIT(w@@/!)" "|" "DONE(d!)" "CANCELED(c@@)")))
3410 @end lisp
3411
3412 @noindent
3413 you not only define global TODO keywords and fast access keys, but also
3414 request that a time is recorded when the entry is turned into
3415 DONE@footnote{It is possible that Org mode will record two time stamps
3416 when you are using both @code{org-log-done} and state change logging.
3417 However, it will never prompt for two notes - if you have configured
3418 both, the state change recording note will take precedence and cancel
3419 the @samp{Closing Note}.}, and that a note is recorded when switching to
3420 WAIT or CANCELED. The setting for WAIT is even more special: The
3421 @samp{!} after the slash means that in addition to the note taken when
3422 entering the state, a time stamp should be recorded when @i{leaving} the
3423 WAIT state, if and only if the @i{target} state does not configure
3424 logging for entering it. So it has no effect when switching from WAIT
3425 to DONE, because DONE is configured to record a timestamp only. But
3426 when switching from WAIT back to TODO, the @samp{/!} in the WAIT
3427 setting now triggers a timestamp even though TODO has no logging
3428 configured.
3429
3430 You can use the exact same syntax for setting logging preferences local
3431 to a buffer:
3432 @example
3433 #+SEQ_TODO: TODO(t) WAIT(w@@/!) | DONE(d!) CANCELED(c@@)
3434 @end example
3435
3436 In order to define logging settings that are local to a subtree or a
3437 single item, define a LOGGING property in this entry. Any non-empty
3438 LOGGING property resets all logging settings to nil. You may then turn
3439 on logging for this specific tree using STARTUP keywords like
3440 @code{lognotedone} or @code{logrepeat}, as well as adding state specific
3441 settings like @code{TODO(!)}. For example
3442
3443 @example
3444 * TODO Log each state with only a time
3445 :PROPERTIES:
3446 :LOGGING: TODO(!) WAIT(!) DONE(!) CANCELED(!)
3447 :END:
3448 * TODO Only log when switching to WAIT, and when repeating
3449 :PROPERTIES:
3450 :LOGGING: WAIT(@@) logrepeat
3451 :END:
3452 * TODO No logging at all
3453 :PROPERTIES:
3454 :LOGGING: nil
3455 :END:
3456 @end example
3457
3458 @node Priorities, Breaking down tasks, Progress logging, TODO Items
3459 @section Priorities
3460 @cindex priorities
3461
3462 If you use Org mode extensively, you may end up enough TODO items that
3463 it starts to make sense to prioritize them. Prioritizing can be done by
3464 placing a @emph{priority cookie} into the headline of a TODO item, like
3465 this
3466
3467 @example
3468 *** TODO [#A] Write letter to Sam Fortune
3469 @end example
3470
3471 @noindent
3472 By default, Org mode supports three priorities: @samp{A}, @samp{B}, and
3473 @samp{C}. @samp{A} is the highest priority. An entry without a cookie
3474 is treated as priority @samp{B}. Priorities make a difference only in
3475 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}); outside the agenda, they have
3476 no inherent meaning to Org mode.
3477
3478 Priorities can be attached to any outline tree entries; they do not need
3479 to be TODO items.
3480
3481 @table @kbd
3482 @kindex @kbd{C-c ,}
3483 @item @kbd{C-c ,}
3484 Set the priority of the current headline. The command prompts for a
3485 priority character @samp{A}, @samp{B} or @samp{C}. When you press
3486 @key{SPC} instead, the priority cookie is removed from the headline.
3487 The priorities can also be changed ``remotely'' from the timeline and
3488 agenda buffer with the @kbd{,} command (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
3489 @c
3490 @kindex S-@key{up}
3491 @kindex S-@key{down}
3492 @item S-@key{up}
3493 @itemx S-@key{down}
3494 Increase/decrease priority of current headline@footnote{See also the option
3495 @code{org-priority-start-cycle-with-default'}.}. Note that these keys are
3496 also used to modify time stamps (@pxref{Creating timestamps}). See also
3497 @ref{Conflicts} for a discussion of the interaction with
3498 @code{shift-selection-mode}.
3499 @end table
3500
3501 You can change the range of allowed priorities by setting the variables
3502 @code{org-highest-priority}, @code{org-lowest-priority}, and
3503 @code{org-default-priority}. For an individual buffer, you may set
3504 these values (highest, lowest, default) like this (please make sure that
3505 the highest priority is earlier in the alphabet than the lowest
3506 priority):
3507
3508 @example
3509 #+PRIORITIES: A C B
3510 @end example
3511
3512 @node Breaking down tasks, Checkboxes, Priorities, TODO Items
3513 @section Breaking tasks down into subtasks
3514 @cindex tasks, breaking down
3515
3516 It is often advisable to break down large tasks into smaller, manageable
3517 subtasks. You can do this by creating an outline tree below a TODO item,
3518 with detailed subtasks on the tree@footnote{To keep subtasks out of the
3519 global TODO list, see the @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels}.}. To keep
3520 the overview over the fraction of subtasks that are already completed, insert
3521 either @samp{[/]} or @samp{[%]} anywhere in the headline. These cookies will
3522 be updates each time the todo status of a child changes. For example:
3523
3524 @example
3525 * Organize Party [33%]
3526 ** TODO Call people [1/2]
3527 *** TODO Peter
3528 *** DONE Sarah
3529 ** TODO Buy food
3530 ** DONE Talk to neighbor
3531 @end example
3532
3533 If you would like a TODO entry to automatically change to DONE when all
3534 children are done, you can use the following setup:
3535
3536 @example
3537 (defun org-summary-todo (n-done n-not-done)
3538 "Switch entry to DONE when all subentries are done, to TODO otherwise."
3539 (let (org-log-done org-log-states) ; turn off logging
3540 (org-todo (if (= n-not-done 0) "DONE" "TODO"))))
3541
3542 (add-hook 'org-after-todo-statistics-hook 'org-summary-todo)
3543 @end example
3544
3545
3546 Another possibility is the use of checkboxes to identify (a hierarchy of) a
3547 large number of subtasks (@pxref{Checkboxes}).
3548
3549
3550 @node Checkboxes, , Breaking down tasks, TODO Items
3551 @section Checkboxes
3552 @cindex checkboxes
3553
3554 Every item in a plain list (@pxref{Plain lists}) can be made into a
3555 checkbox by starting it with the string @samp{[ ]}. This feature is
3556 similar to TODO items (@pxref{TODO Items}), but is more lightweight.
3557 Checkboxes are not included into the global TODO list, so they are often
3558 great to split a task into a number of simple steps. Or you can use
3559 them in a shopping list. To toggle a checkbox, use @kbd{C-c C-c}, or
3560 use the mouse (thanks to Piotr Zielinski's @file{org-mouse.el}).
3561
3562 Here is an example of a checkbox list.
3563
3564 @example
3565 * TODO Organize party [2/4]
3566 - [-] call people [1/3]
3567 - [ ] Peter
3568 - [X] Sarah
3569 - [ ] Sam
3570 - [X] order food
3571 - [ ] think about what music to play
3572 - [X] talk to the neighbors
3573 @end example
3574
3575 Checkboxes work hierarchically, so if a checkbox item has children that
3576 are checkboxes, toggling one of the children checkboxes will make the
3577 parent checkbox reflect if none, some, or all of the children are
3578 checked.
3579
3580 @cindex statistics, for checkboxes
3581 @cindex checkbox statistics
3582 The @samp{[2/4]} and @samp{[1/3]} in the first and second line are
3583 cookies indicating how many checkboxes present in this entry have been
3584 checked off, and the total number of checkboxes are present. This can
3585 give you an idea on how many checkboxes remain, even without opening a
3586 folded entry. The cookies can be placed into a headline or into (the
3587 first line of) a plain list item. Each cookie covers all checkboxes
3588 structurally below the headline/item on which the cookie appear. You
3589 have to insert the cookie yourself by typing either @samp{[/]} or
3590 @samp{[%]}. With @samp{[/]} you get an @samp{n out of m} result, as in
3591 the examples above. With @samp{[%]} you get information about the
3592 percentage of checkboxes checked (in the above example, this would be
3593 @samp{[50%]} and @samp{[33%]}, respectively).
3594
3595 @noindent The following commands work with checkboxes:
3596
3597 @table @kbd
3598 @kindex C-c C-c
3599 @item C-c C-c
3600 Toggle checkbox at point. With a prefix argument, set it to @samp{[-]},
3601 which is considered to be an intermediate state.
3602 @kindex C-c C-x C-b
3603 @item C-c C-x C-b
3604 Toggle checkbox status or (with prefix arg) checkbox presence at point.
3605 @itemize @minus
3606 @item
3607 If there is an active region, toggle the first checkbox in the region
3608 and set all remaining boxes to the same status as the first. With a prefix
3609 arg, add or remove the checkbox for all items in the region.
3610 @item
3611 If the cursor is in a headline, toggle checkboxes in the region between
3612 this headline and the next (so @emph{not} the entire subtree).
3613 @item
3614 If there is no active region, just toggle the checkbox at point.
3615 @end itemize
3616 @kindex M-S-@key{RET}
3617 @item M-S-@key{RET}
3618 Insert a new item with a checkbox.
3619 This works only if the cursor is already in a plain list item
3620 (@pxref{Plain lists}).
3621 @kindex C-c #
3622 @item C-c #
3623 Update the checkbox statistics in the current outline entry. When
3624 called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, update the entire file. Checkbox
3625 statistic cookies are updated automatically if you toggle checkboxes
3626 with @kbd{C-c C-c} and make new ones with @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}}. If you
3627 delete boxes or add/change them by hand, use this command to get things
3628 back into sync. Or simply toggle any checkbox twice with @kbd{C-c C-c}.
3629 @end table
3630
3631 @node Tags, Properties and Columns, TODO Items, Top
3632 @chapter Tags
3633 @cindex tags
3634 @cindex headline tagging
3635 @cindex matching, tags
3636 @cindex sparse tree, tag based
3637
3638 An excellent way to implement labels and contexts for cross-correlating
3639 information is to assign @i{tags} to headlines. Org mode has extensive
3640 support for tags.
3641
3642 Every headline can contain a list of tags; they occur at the end of the
3643 headline. Tags are normal words containing letters, numbers, @samp{_}, and
3644 @samp{@@}. Tags must be preceded and followed by a single colon, e.g.,
3645 @samp{:work:}. Several tags can be specified, as in @samp{:work:urgent:}.
3646 Tags will by default get a bold face with the same color as the headline.
3647 You may specify special faces for specific tags using the variable
3648 @code{org-tag-faces}, much in the same way as you can do for TODO keywords
3649 (@pxref{Faces for TODO keywords}).
3650
3651 @menu
3652 * Tag inheritance:: Tags use the tree structure of the outline
3653 * Setting tags:: How to assign tags to a headline
3654 * Tag searches:: Searching for combinations of tags
3655 @end menu
3656
3657 @node Tag inheritance, Setting tags, Tags, Tags
3658 @section Tag inheritance
3659 @cindex tag inheritance
3660 @cindex inheritance, of tags
3661 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into tags match
3662
3663 @i{Tags} make use of the hierarchical structure of outline trees. If a
3664 heading has a certain tag, all subheadings will inherit the tag as
3665 well. For example, in the list
3666
3667 @example
3668 * Meeting with the French group :work:
3669 ** Summary by Frank :boss:notes:
3670 *** TODO Prepare slides for him :action:
3671 @end example
3672
3673 @noindent
3674 the final heading will have the tags @samp{:work:}, @samp{:boss:},
3675 @samp{:notes:}, and @samp{:action:} even though the final heading is not
3676 explicitly marked with those tags. You can also set tags that all entries in
3677 a file should inherit as if these tags would be defined in a hypothetical
3678 level zero that surrounds the entire file.
3679
3680 @example
3681 #+FILETAGS: :Peter:Boss:Secret:
3682 @end example
3683
3684 @noindent
3685 To limit tag inheritance to specific tags, or to turn it off entirely, use
3686 the variables @code{org-use-tag-inheritance} and
3687 @code{org-tags-exclude-from-inheritance}.
3688
3689 When a headline matches during a tags search while tag inheritance is turned
3690 on, all the sublevels in the same tree will (for a simple match form) match
3691 as well@footnote{This is only true if the search does not involve more
3692 complex tests including properties (@pxref{Property searches}).}. The list
3693 of matches may then become very long. If you only want to see the first tags
3694 match in a subtree, configure the variable
3695 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels} (not recommended).
3696
3697 @node Setting tags, Tag searches, Tag inheritance, Tags
3698 @section Setting tags
3699 @cindex setting tags
3700 @cindex tags, setting
3701
3702 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
3703 Tags can simply be typed into the buffer at the end of a headline.
3704 After a colon, @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} offers completion on tags. There is
3705 also a special command for inserting tags:
3706
3707 @table @kbd
3708 @kindex C-c C-q
3709 @item C-c C-q
3710 @cindex completion, of tags
3711 Enter new tags for the current headline. Org mode will either offer
3712 completion or a special single-key interface for setting tags, see
3713 below. After pressing @key{RET}, the tags will be inserted and aligned
3714 to @code{org-tags-column}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all
3715 tags in the current buffer will be aligned to that column, just to make
3716 things look nice. TAGS are automatically realigned after promotion,
3717 demotion, and TODO state changes (@pxref{TODO basics}).
3718 @kindex C-c C-c
3719 @item C-c C-c
3720 When the cursor is in a headline, this does the same as @kbd{C-c C-q}.
3721 @end table
3722
3723 Org will support tag insertion based on a @emph{list of tags}. By
3724 default this list is constructed dynamically, containing all tags
3725 currently used in the buffer. You may also globally specify a hard list
3726 of tags with the variable @code{org-tag-alist}. Finally you can set
3727 the default tags for a given file with lines like
3728
3729 @example
3730 #+TAGS: @@work @@home @@tennisclub
3731 #+TAGS: laptop car pc sailboat
3732 @end example
3733
3734 If you have globally defined your preferred set of tags using the
3735 variable @code{org-tag-alist}, but would like to use a dynamic tag list
3736 in a specific file, add an empty TAGS option line to that file:
3737
3738 @example
3739 #+TAGS:
3740 @end example
3741
3742 By default Org mode uses the standard minibuffer completion facilities for
3743 entering tags. However, it also implements another, quicker, tag selection
3744 method called @emph{fast tag selection}. This allows you to select and
3745 deselect tags with just a single key press. For this to work well you should
3746 assign unique letters to most of your commonly used tags. You can do this
3747 globally by configuring the variable @code{org-tag-alist} in your
3748 @file{.emacs} file. For example, you may find the need to tag many items in
3749 different files with @samp{:@@home:}. In this case you can set something
3750 like:
3751
3752 @lisp
3753 (setq org-tag-alist '(("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h) ("laptop" . ?l)))
3754 @end lisp
3755
3756 @noindent If the tag is only relevant to the file you are working on then you
3757 can, instead, set the TAGS option line as:
3758
3759 @example
3760 #+TAGS: @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) laptop(l) pc(p)
3761 @end example
3762
3763 @noindent
3764 You can also group together tags that are mutually exclusive. By using
3765 braces, as in:
3766
3767 @example
3768 #+TAGS: @{ @@work(w) @@home(h) @@tennisclub(t) @} laptop(l) pc(p)
3769 @end example
3770
3771 @noindent you indicate that at most one of @samp{@@work}, @samp{@@home},
3772 and @samp{@@tennisclub} should be selected. Multiple such groups are allowed.
3773
3774 @noindent Don't forget to press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor in one of
3775 these lines to activate any changes.
3776
3777 @noindent
3778 To set these mutually exclusive groups in the variable @code{org-mode-alist}
3779 you must use the dummy tags @code{:startgroup} and @code{:endgroup} instead
3780 of the braces. The previous example would be set globally by the following
3781 configuration:
3782
3783 @lisp
3784 (setq org-tag-alist '((:startgroup . nil)
3785 ("@@work" . ?w) ("@@home" . ?h)
3786 ("@@tennisclub" . ?t)
3787 (:endgroup . nil)
3788 ("laptop" . ?l) ("pc" . ?p)))
3789 @end lisp
3790
3791 If at least one tag has a selection key then pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} will
3792 automatically present you with a special interface, listing inherited tags,
3793 the tags of the current headline, and a list of all valid tags with
3794 corresponding keys@footnote{Keys will automatically be assigned to tags which
3795 have no configured keys.}. In this interface, you can use the following
3796 keys:
3797
3798 @table @kbd
3799 @item a-z...
3800 Pressing keys assigned to tags will add or remove them from the list of
3801 tags in the current line. Selecting a tag in a group of mutually
3802 exclusive tags will turn off any other tags from that group.
3803 @kindex @key{TAB}
3804 @item @key{TAB}
3805 Enter a tag in the minibuffer, even if the tag is not in the predefined
3806 list. You will be able to complete on all tags present in the buffer.
3807 @kindex @key{SPC}
3808 @item @key{SPC}
3809 Clear all tags for this line.
3810 @kindex @key{RET}
3811 @item @key{RET}
3812 Accept the modified set.
3813 @item C-g
3814 Abort without installing changes.
3815 @item q
3816 If @kbd{q} is not assigned to a tag, it aborts like @kbd{C-g}.
3817 @item !
3818 Turn off groups of mutually exclusive tags. Use this to (as an
3819 exception) assign several tags from such a group.
3820 @item C-c
3821 Toggle auto-exit after the next change (see below).
3822 If you are using expert mode, the first @kbd{C-c} will display the
3823 selection window.
3824 @end table
3825
3826 @noindent
3827 This method lets you assign tags to a headline with very few keys. With
3828 the above setup, you could clear the current tags and set @samp{@@home},
3829 @samp{laptop} and @samp{pc} tags with just the following keys: @kbd{C-c
3830 C-c @key{SPC} h l p @key{RET}}. Switching from @samp{@@home} to
3831 @samp{@@work} would be done with @kbd{C-c C-c w @key{RET}} or
3832 alternatively with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c w}. Adding the non-predefined tag
3833 @samp{Sarah} could be done with @kbd{C-c C-c @key{TAB} S a r a h
3834 @key{RET} @key{RET}}.
3835
3836 If you find that most of the time, you need only a single key press to
3837 modify your list of tags, set the variable
3838 @code{org-fast-tag-selection-single-key}. Then you no longer have to
3839 press @key{RET} to exit fast tag selection - it will immediately exit
3840 after the first change. If you then occasionally need more keys, press
3841 @kbd{C-c} to turn off auto-exit for the current tag selection process
3842 (in effect: start selection with @kbd{C-c C-c C-c} instead of @kbd{C-c
3843 C-c}). If you set the variable to the value @code{expert}, the special
3844 window is not even shown for single-key tag selection, it comes up only
3845 when you press an extra @kbd{C-c}.
3846
3847 @node Tag searches, , Setting tags, Tags
3848 @section Tag searches
3849 @cindex tag searches
3850 @cindex searching for tags
3851
3852 Once a system of tags has been set up, it can be used to collect related
3853 information into special lists.
3854
3855 @table @kbd
3856 @kindex C-c \
3857 @kindex C-c / T
3858 @item C-c \
3859 @itemx C-c / T
3860 Create a sparse tree with all headlines matching a tags search. With a
3861 @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, ignore headlines that are not a TODO line.
3862 @kindex C-c a m
3863 @item C-c a m
3864 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files.
3865 @xref{Matching tags and properties}.
3866 @kindex C-c a M
3867 @item C-c a M
3868 Create a global list of tag matches from all agenda files, but check
3869 only TODO items and force checking subitems (see variable
3870 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}).
3871 @end table
3872
3873 @cindex Boolean logic, for tag searches
3874 A @i{tags} search string can use Boolean operators @samp{&} for AND and
3875 @samp{|} for OR. @samp{&} binds more strongly than @samp{|}.
3876 Parenthesis are currently not implemented. A tag may also be preceded
3877 by @samp{-}, to select against it, and @samp{+} is syntactic sugar for
3878 positive selection. The AND operator @samp{&} is optional when @samp{+}
3879 or @samp{-} is present. Examples:
3880
3881 @table @samp
3882 @item +work-boss
3883 Select headlines tagged @samp{:work:}, but discard those also tagged
3884 @samp{:boss:}.
3885 @item work|laptop
3886 Selects lines tagged @samp{:work:} or @samp{:laptop:}.
3887 @item work|laptop&night
3888 Like before, but require the @samp{:laptop:} lines to be tagged also
3889 @samp{:night:}.
3890 @end table
3891
3892 @cindex TODO keyword matching, with tags search
3893 You may also test for TODO keywords (@pxref{TODO extensions}) and properties
3894 (@pxref{Properties and Columns}) at the same time as matching tags. For a
3895 guide on how to match properties, see @ref{Property searches}. To match a
3896 specific TODO keyword, include an expression like @samp{+TODO="NEXT"} as one
3897 of the terms in a tags search.
3898
3899 There is also the possibility to end the tags part of the match (which may
3900 include several terms connected with @samp{|}) with a @samp{/} and then
3901 specify a Boolean expression just for TODO keywords. The syntax is then
3902 similar to the tag matches, but should be applied with consideration: For
3903 example, a positive selection on several TODO keywords can not meaningfully
3904 be combined with boolean AND. However, @emph{negative selection} combined
3905 with AND can be meaningful. To make sure that only lines are checked that
3906 actually have any TODO keyword (resulting in a speed-up), use @kbd{C-c a M},
3907 or equivalently start the TODO part after the slash with @samp{!}. Examples:
3908
3909 @table @samp
3910 @item work+TODO="WAITING"
3911 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines with the specific TODO
3912 keyword @samp{WAITING}.
3913 @item work+TODO="WAITING"|home+TODO="WAITING"
3914 Waiting tasks both at work and at home.
3915 @item work/WAITING
3916 Same as the first example.
3917 @item work/!-WAITING-NEXT
3918 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are neither @samp{WAITING}
3919 nor @samp{NEXT}
3920 @item work/!+WAITING|+NEXT
3921 Select @samp{:work:}-tagged TODO lines that are either @samp{WAITING} or
3922 @samp{NEXT}.
3923 @end table
3924
3925 @cindex regular expressions, with tags search
3926 Any element of the tag/todo match can be a regular expression - in this
3927 case it must be enclosed in curly braces. For example,
3928 @samp{work+@{^boss.*@}} matches headlines that contain the tag
3929 @samp{:work:} and any tag @i{starting} with @samp{boss}. You may also use a
3930 regular expression in @samp{TODO=@{^W@}} which would match TODO keywords
3931 starting with the letter @samp{W}.
3932
3933 @cindex level, require for tags/property match
3934 @cindex category, require for tags/property match
3935 You can also require a headline to be of a certain level or category, by
3936 writing instead of any TAG an expression like @samp{LEVEL=3} or
3937 @samp{CATEGORY="work"}, respectively. For example, a search
3938 @samp{+LEVEL=3+boss/-DONE} lists all level three headlines that have the
3939 tag @samp{boss} and are @emph{not} marked with the TODO keyword DONE.
3940
3941 Accessing TODO, LEVEL, and CATEGORY during a search is fast. Accessing any
3942 other properties will slow down the search.
3943
3944 @node Properties and Columns, Dates and Times, Tags, Top
3945 @chapter Properties and Columns
3946 @cindex properties
3947
3948 Properties are a set of key-value pairs associated with an entry. There
3949 are two main applications for properties in Org mode. First, properties
3950 are like tags, but with a value. Second, you can use properties to
3951 implement (very basic) database capabilities in an Org buffer. For
3952 an example of the first application, imagine maintaining a file where
3953 you document bugs and plan releases of a piece of software. Instead of
3954 using tags like @code{:release_1:}, @code{:release_2:}, one can use a
3955 property, say @code{:Release:}, that in different subtrees has different
3956 values, such as @code{1.0} or @code{2.0}. For an example of the second
3957 application of properties, imagine keeping track of your music CDs,
3958 where properties could be things such as the album artist, date of
3959 release, number of tracks, and so on.
3960
3961 Properties can be conveniently edited and viewed in column view
3962 (@pxref{Column view}).
3963
3964 @menu
3965 * Property syntax:: How properties are spelled out
3966 * Special properties:: Access to other Org mode features
3967 * Property searches:: Matching property values
3968 * Property inheritance:: Passing values down the tree
3969 * Column view:: Tabular viewing and editing
3970 * Property API:: Properties for Lisp programmers
3971 @end menu
3972
3973 @node Property syntax, Special properties, Properties and Columns, Properties and Columns
3974 @section Property syntax
3975 @cindex property syntax
3976 @cindex drawer, for properties
3977
3978 Properties are key-value pairs. They need to be inserted into a special
3979 drawer (@pxref{Drawers}) with the name @code{PROPERTIES}. Each property
3980 is specified on a single line, with the key (surrounded by colons)
3981 first, and the value after it. Here is an example:
3982
3983 @example
3984 * CD collection
3985 ** Classic
3986 *** Goldberg Variations
3987 :PROPERTIES:
3988 :Title: Goldberg Variations
3989 :Composer: J.S. Bach
3990 :Artist: Glen Gould
3991 :Publisher: Deutsche Grammphon
3992 :NDisks: 1
3993 :END:
3994 @end example
3995
3996 You may define the allowed values for a particular property @samp{:Xyz:}
3997 by setting a property @samp{:Xyz_ALL:}. This special property is
3998 @emph{inherited}, so if you set it in a level 1 entry, it will apply to
3999 the entire tree. When allowed values are defined, setting the
4000 corresponding property becomes easier and is less prone to typing
4001 errors. For the example with the CD collection, we can predefine
4002 publishers and the number of disks in a box like this:
4003
4004 @example
4005 * CD collection
4006 :PROPERTIES:
4007 :NDisks_ALL: 1 2 3 4
4008 :Publisher_ALL: "Deutsche Grammophon" Philips EMI
4009 :END:
4010 @end example
4011
4012 If you want to set properties that can be inherited by any entry in a
4013 file, use a line like
4014
4015 @example
4016 #+PROPERTY: NDisks_ALL 1 2 3 4
4017 @end example
4018
4019 Property values set with the global variable
4020 @code{org-global-properties} can be inherited by all entries in all
4021 Org files.
4022
4023 @noindent
4024 The following commands help to work with properties:
4025
4026 @table @kbd
4027 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
4028 @item M-@key{TAB}
4029 After an initial colon in a line, complete property keys. All keys used
4030 in the current file will be offered as possible completions.
4031 @kindex C-c C-x p
4032 @item C-c C-x p
4033 Set a property. This prompts for a property name and a value. If
4034 necessary, the property drawer is created as well.
4035 @item M-x org-insert-property-drawer
4036 Insert a property drawer into the current entry. The drawer will be
4037 inserted early in the entry, but after the lines with planning
4038 information like deadlines.
4039 @kindex C-c C-c
4040 @item C-c C-c
4041 With the cursor in a property drawer, this executes property commands.
4042 @item C-c C-c s
4043 Set a property in the current entry. Both the property and the value
4044 can be inserted using completion.
4045 @kindex S-@key{right}
4046 @kindex S-@key{left}
4047 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4048 Switch property at point to the next/previous allowed value.
4049 @item C-c C-c d
4050 Remove a property from the current entry.
4051 @item C-c C-c D
4052 Globally remove a property, from all entries in the current file.
4053 @item C-c C-c c
4054 Compute the property at point, using the operator and scope from the
4055 nearest column format definition.
4056 @end table
4057
4058 @node Special properties, Property searches, Property syntax, Properties and Columns
4059 @section Special properties
4060 @cindex properties, special
4061
4062 Special properties provide alternative access method to Org mode
4063 features discussed in the previous chapters, like the TODO state or the
4064 priority of an entry. This interface exists so that you can include
4065 these states into columns view (@pxref{Column view}), or to use them in
4066 queries. The following property names are special and should not be
4067 used as keys in the properties drawer:
4068
4069 @example
4070 TODO @r{The TODO keyword of the entry.}
4071 TAGS @r{The tags defined directly in the headline.}
4072 ALLTAGS @r{All tags, including inherited ones.}
4073 PRIORITY @r{The priority of the entry, a string with a single letter.}
4074 DEADLINE @r{The deadline time string, without the angular brackets.}
4075 SCHEDULED @r{The scheduling time stamp, without the angular brackets.}
4076 TIMESTAMP @r{The first keyword-less time stamp in the entry.}
4077 TIMESTAMP_IA @r{The first inactive time stamp in the entry.}
4078 CLOCKSUM @r{The sum of CLOCK intervals in the subtree. @code{org-clock-sum}}
4079 @r{must be run first to compute the values.}
4080 @end example
4081
4082 @node Property searches, Property inheritance, Special properties, Properties and Columns
4083 @section Property searches
4084 @cindex properties, searching
4085 @cindex searching, of properties
4086
4087 To create sparse trees and special lists with selection based on properties,
4088 the same commands are used as for tag searches (@pxref{Tag searches}), and
4089 the same logic applies. For example, here is a search string:
4090
4091 @example
4092 +work-boss+PRIORITY="A"+Coffee="unlimited"+Effort<2 \
4093 +With=@{Sarah\|Denny@}+SCHEDULED>="<2008-10-11>"
4094 @end example
4095
4096 @noindent
4097 The type of comparison will depend on how the comparison value is written:
4098 @itemize @minus
4099 @item
4100 If the comparison value is a plain number, a numerical comparison is done,
4101 and the allowed operators are @samp{<}, @samp{=}, @samp{>}, @samp{<=},
4102 @samp{>=}, and @samp{<>}.
4103 @item
4104 If the comparison value is enclosed in double
4105 quotes, a string comparison is done, and the same operators are allowed.
4106 @item
4107 If the comparison value is enclosed in double quotes @emph{and} angular
4108 brackets (like @samp{DEADLINE<="<2008-12-24 18:30>"}), both values are
4109 assumed to be date/time specifications in the standard Org way, and the
4110 comparison will be done accordingly. Special values that will be recognized
4111 are @code{"<now>"} for now (including time), and @code{"<today>"}, and
4112 @code{"<tomorrow>"} for these days at 0:00 hours, i.e. without a time
4113 specification. Also strings like @code{"<+5d>"} or @code{"<-2m>"} with units
4114 @code{d}, @code{w}, @code{m}, and @code{y} for day, week, month, and year,
4115 respectively, can be used.
4116 @item
4117 If the comparison value is enclosed
4118 in curly braces, a regexp match is performed, with @samp{=} meaning that the
4119 regexp matches the property value, and @samp{<>} meaning that it does not
4120 match.
4121 @end itemize
4122
4123 So the search string in the example finds entries tagged @samp{:work:} but
4124 not @samp{:boss:}, which also have a priority value @samp{A}, a
4125 @samp{:Coffee:} property with the value @samp{unlimited}, an @samp{Effort}
4126 property that is numerically smaller than 2, a @samp{:With:} property that is
4127 matched by the regular expression @samp{Sarah\|Denny}, and that are scheduled
4128 on or after October 11, 2008.
4129
4130 You can configure Org mode to use property inheritance during a search, but
4131 beware that this can slow down searches considerably. See @ref{Property
4132 inheritance} for details.
4133
4134 There is also a special command for creating sparse trees based on a
4135 single property:
4136
4137 @table @kbd
4138 @kindex C-c / p
4139 @item C-c / p
4140 Create a sparse tree based on the value of a property. This first
4141 prompts for the name of a property, and then for a value. A sparse tree
4142 is created with all entries that define this property with the given
4143 value. If you enclose the value into curly braces, it is interpreted as
4144 a regular expression and matched against the property values.
4145 @end table
4146
4147 @node Property inheritance, Column view, Property searches, Properties and Columns
4148 @section Property Inheritance
4149 @cindex properties, inheritance
4150 @cindex inheritance, of properties
4151
4152 The outline structure of Org mode documents lends itself for an
4153 inheritance model of properties: If the parent in a tree has a certain
4154 property, the children can inherit this property. Org mode does not
4155 turn this on by default, because it can slow down property searches
4156 significantly and is often not needed. However, if you find inheritance
4157 useful, you can turn it on by setting the variable
4158 @code{org-use-property-inheritance}. It may be set to @code{t}, to make
4159 all properties inherited from the parent, to a list of properties
4160 that should be inherited, or to a regular expression that matches
4161 inherited properties.
4162
4163 Org mode has a few properties for which inheritance is hard-coded, at
4164 least for the special applications for which they are used:
4165
4166 @table @code
4167 @item COLUMNS
4168 The @code{:COLUMNS:} property defines the format of column view
4169 (@pxref{Column view}). It is inherited in the sense that the level
4170 where a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is defined is used as the starting
4171 point for a column view table, independently of the location in the
4172 subtree from where columns view is turned on.
4173 @item CATEGORY
4174 For agenda view, a category set through a @code{:CATEGORY:} property
4175 applies to the entire subtree.
4176 @item ARCHIVE
4177 For archiving, the @code{:ARCHIVE:} property may define the archive
4178 location for the entire subtree (@pxref{Moving subtrees}).
4179 @item LOGGING
4180 The LOGGING property may define logging settings for an entry or a
4181 subtree (@pxref{Tracking TODO state changes}).
4182 @end table
4183
4184 @node Column view, Property API, Property inheritance, Properties and Columns
4185 @section Column view
4186
4187 A great way to view and edit properties in an outline tree is
4188 @emph{column view}. In column view, each outline item is turned into a
4189 table row. Columns in this table provide access to properties of the
4190 entries. Org mode implements columns by overlaying a tabular structure
4191 over the headline of each item. While the headlines have been turned
4192 into a table row, you can still change the visibility of the outline
4193 tree. For example, you get a compact table by switching to CONTENTS
4194 view (@kbd{S-@key{TAB} S-@key{TAB}}, or simply @kbd{c} while column view
4195 is active), but you can still open, read, and edit the entry below each
4196 headline. Or, you can switch to column view after executing a sparse
4197 tree command and in this way get a table only for the selected items.
4198 Column view also works in agenda buffers (@pxref{Agenda Views}) where
4199 queries have collected selected items, possibly from a number of files.
4200
4201 @menu
4202 * Defining columns:: The COLUMNS format property
4203 * Using column view:: How to create and use column view
4204 * Capturing column view:: A dynamic block for column view
4205 @end menu
4206
4207 @node Defining columns, Using column view, Column view, Column view
4208 @subsection Defining columns
4209 @cindex column view, for properties
4210 @cindex properties, column view
4211
4212 Setting up a column view first requires defining the columns. This is
4213 done by defining a column format line.
4214
4215 @menu
4216 * Scope of column definitions:: Where defined, where valid?
4217 * Column attributes:: Appearance and content of a column
4218 @end menu
4219
4220 @node Scope of column definitions, Column attributes, Defining columns, Defining columns
4221 @subsubsection Scope of column definitions
4222
4223 To define a column format for an entire file, use a line like
4224
4225 @example
4226 #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4227 @end example
4228
4229 To specify a format that only applies to a specific tree, add a
4230 @code{:COLUMNS:} property to the top node of that tree, for example:
4231
4232 @example
4233 ** Top node for columns view
4234 :PROPERTIES:
4235 :COLUMNS: %25ITEM %TAGS %PRIORITY %TODO
4236 :END:
4237 @end example
4238
4239 If a @code{:COLUMNS:} property is present in an entry, it defines columns
4240 for the entry itself, and for the entire subtree below it. Since the
4241 column definition is part of the hierarchical structure of the document,
4242 you can define columns on level 1 that are general enough for all
4243 sublevels, and more specific columns further down, when you edit a
4244 deeper part of the tree.
4245
4246 @node Column attributes, , Scope of column definitions, Defining columns
4247 @subsubsection Column attributes
4248 A column definition sets the attributes of a column. The general
4249 definition looks like this:
4250
4251 @example
4252 %[width]property[(title)][@{summary-type@}]
4253 @end example
4254
4255 @noindent
4256 Except for the percent sign and the property name, all items are
4257 optional. The individual parts have the following meaning:
4258
4259 @example
4260 width @r{An integer specifying the width of the column in characters.}
4261 @r{If omitted, the width will be determined automatically.}
4262 property @r{The property that should be edited in this column.}
4263 (title) @r{The header text for the column. If omitted, the}
4264 @r{property name is used.}
4265 @{summary-type@} @r{The summary type. If specified, the column values for}
4266 @r{parent nodes are computed from the children.}
4267 @r{Supported summary types are:}
4268 @{+@} @r{Sum numbers in this column.}
4269 @{+;%.1f@} @r{Like @samp{+}, but format result with @samp{%.1f}.}
4270 @{$@} @r{Currency, short for @samp{+;%.2f}.}
4271 @{:@} @r{Sum times, HH:MM:SS, plain numbers are hours.}
4272 @{X@} @r{Checkbox status, [X] if all children are [X].}
4273 @{X/@} @r{Checkbox status, [n/m].}
4274 @{X%@} @r{Checkbox status, [n%].}
4275 @end example
4276
4277 @noindent
4278 Here is an example for a complete columns definition, along with allowed
4279 values.
4280
4281 @example
4282 :COLUMNS: %20ITEM %9Approved(Approved?)@{X@} %Owner %11Status \@footnote{Please note that the COLUMNS definition must be on a single line - it is wrapped here only because of formatting constraints.}
4283 %10Time_Estimate@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
4284 :Owner_ALL: Tammy Mark Karl Lisa Don
4285 :Status_ALL: "In progress" "Not started yet" "Finished" ""
4286 :Approved_ALL: "[ ]" "[X]"
4287 @end example
4288
4289 The first column, @samp{%25ITEM}, means the first 25 characters of the
4290 item itself, i.e. of the headline. You probably always should start the
4291 column definition with the @samp{ITEM} specifier. The other specifiers
4292 create columns @samp{Owner} with a list of names as allowed values, for
4293 @samp{Status} with four different possible values, and for a checkbox
4294 field @samp{Approved}. When no width is given after the @samp{%}
4295 character, the column will be exactly as wide as it needs to be in order
4296 to fully display all values. The @samp{Approved} column does have a
4297 modified title (@samp{Approved?}, with a question mark). Summaries will
4298 be created for the @samp{Time_Estimate} column by adding time duration
4299 expressions like HH:MM, and for the @samp{Approved} column, by providing
4300 an @samp{[X]} status if all children have been checked. The
4301 @samp{CLOCKSUM} column is special, it lists the sum of CLOCK intervals
4302 in the subtree.
4303
4304 @node Using column view, Capturing column view, Defining columns, Column view
4305 @subsection Using column view
4306
4307 @table @kbd
4308 @tsubheading{Turning column view on and off}
4309 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
4310 @item C-c C-x C-c
4311 Create the column view for the local environment. This command searches
4312 the hierarchy, up from point, for a @code{:COLUMNS:} property that defines
4313 a format. When one is found, the column view table is established for
4314 the entire tree, starting from the entry that contains the @code{:COLUMNS:}
4315 property. If none is found, the format is taken from the @code{#+COLUMNS}
4316 line or from the variable @code{org-columns-default-format}, and column
4317 view is established for the current entry and its subtree.
4318 @kindex r
4319 @item r
4320 Recreate the column view, to include recent changes made in the buffer.
4321 @kindex g
4322 @item g
4323 Same as @kbd{r}.
4324 @kindex q
4325 @item q
4326 Exit column view.
4327 @tsubheading{Editing values}
4328 @item @key{left} @key{right} @key{up} @key{down}
4329 Move through the column view from field to field.
4330 @kindex S-@key{left}
4331 @kindex S-@key{right}
4332 @item S-@key{left}/@key{right}
4333 Switch to the next/previous allowed value of the field. For this, you
4334 have to have specified allowed values for a property.
4335 @item 1..9,0
4336 Directly select the nth allowed value, @kbd{0} selects the 10th value.
4337 @kindex n
4338 @kindex p
4339 @itemx n / p
4340 Same as @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}
4341 @kindex e
4342 @item e
4343 Edit the property at point. For the special properties, this will
4344 invoke the same interface that you normally use to change that
4345 property. For example, when editing a TAGS property, the tag completion
4346 or fast selection interface will pop up.
4347 @kindex C-c C-c
4348 @item C-c C-c
4349 When there is a checkbox at point, toggle it.
4350 @kindex v
4351 @item v
4352 View the full value of this property. This is useful if the width of
4353 the column is smaller than that of the value.
4354 @kindex a
4355 @item a
4356 Edit the list of allowed values for this property. If the list is found
4357 in the hierarchy, the modified values is stored there. If no list is
4358 found, the new value is stored in the first entry that is part of the
4359 current column view.
4360 @tsubheading{Modifying the table structure}
4361 @kindex <
4362 @kindex >
4363 @item < / >
4364 Make the column narrower/wider by one character.
4365 @kindex S-M-@key{right}
4366 @item S-M-@key{right}
4367 Insert a new column, to the left of the current column.
4368 @kindex S-M-@key{left}
4369 @item S-M-@key{left}
4370 Delete the current column.
4371 @end table
4372
4373 @node Capturing column view, , Using column view, Column view
4374 @subsection Capturing column view
4375
4376 Since column view is just an overlay over a buffer, it cannot be
4377 exported or printed directly. If you want to capture a column view, use
4378 this @code{columnview} dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). The frame
4379 of this block looks like this:
4380
4381 @cindex #+BEGIN: columnview
4382 @example
4383 * The column view
4384 #+BEGIN: columnview :hlines 1 :id "label"
4385
4386 #+END:
4387 @end example
4388
4389 @noindent This dynamic block has the following parameters:
4390
4391 @table @code
4392 @item :id
4393 This is most important parameter. Column view is a feature that is
4394 often localized to a certain (sub)tree, and the capture block might be
4395 in a different location in the file. To identify the tree whose view to
4396 capture, you can use 3 values:
4397 @example
4398 local @r{use the tree in which the capture block is located}
4399 global @r{make a global view, including all headings in the file}
4400 "file:path-to-file"
4401 @r{run column view at the top of this file}
4402 "ID" @r{call column view in the tree that has an @code{:ID:}}
4403 @r{property with the value @i{label}. You can use}
4404 @r{@kbd{M-x org-id-copy} to create a globally unique ID for}
4405 @r{the current entry and copy it to the kill-ring.}
4406 @end example
4407 @item :hlines
4408 When @code{t}, insert a hline after every line. When a number N, insert
4409 a hline before each headline with level @code{<= N}.
4410 @item :vlines
4411 When set to @code{t}, enforce column groups to get vertical lines.
4412 @item :maxlevel
4413 When set to a number, don't capture entries below this level.
4414 @item :skip-empty-rows
4415 When set to @code{t}, skip row where the only non-empty specifier of the
4416 column view is @code{ITEM}.
4417
4418 @end table
4419
4420 @noindent
4421 The following commands insert or update the dynamic block:
4422
4423 @table @kbd
4424 @kindex C-c C-x i
4425 @item C-c C-x i
4426 Insert a dynamic block capturing a column view. You will be prompted
4427 for the scope or id of the view.
4428 @kindex C-c C-c
4429 @item C-c C-c
4430 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
4431 @itemx C-c C-x C-u
4432 Update dynamical block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
4433 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
4434 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
4435 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
4436 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
4437 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
4438 @end table
4439
4440 You can add formulas to the column view table and you may add plotting
4441 instructions in front of the table - these will survive an update of the
4442 block. If there is a @code{#+TBLFM:} after the table, the table will
4443 actually be recalculated automatically after an update.
4444
4445 @node Property API, , Column view, Properties and Columns
4446 @section The Property API
4447 @cindex properties, API
4448 @cindex API, for properties
4449
4450 There is a full API for accessing and changing properties. This API can
4451 be used by Emacs Lisp programs to work with properties and to implement
4452 features based on them. For more information see @ref{Using the
4453 property API}.
4454
4455 @node Dates and Times, Capture, Properties and Columns, Top
4456 @chapter Dates and Times
4457 @cindex dates
4458 @cindex times
4459 @cindex time stamps
4460 @cindex date stamps
4461
4462 To assist project planning, TODO items can be labeled with a date and/or
4463 a time. The specially formatted string carrying the date and time
4464 information is called a @emph{timestamp} in Org mode. This may be a
4465 little confusing because timestamp is often used as indicating when
4466 something was created or last changed. However, in Org mode this term
4467 is used in a much wider sense.
4468
4469 @menu
4470 * Timestamps:: Assigning a time to a tree entry
4471 * Creating timestamps:: Commands which insert timestamps
4472 * Deadlines and scheduling:: Planning your work
4473 * Clocking work time:: Tracking how long you spend on a task
4474 * Effort estimates:: Planning work effort in advance
4475 * Relative timer:: Notes with a running timer
4476 @end menu
4477
4478
4479 @node Timestamps, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times, Dates and Times
4480 @section Timestamps, deadlines and scheduling
4481 @cindex time stamps
4482 @cindex ranges, time
4483 @cindex date stamps
4484 @cindex deadlines
4485 @cindex scheduling
4486
4487 A time stamp is a specification of a date (possibly with time or a range
4488 of times) in a special format, either @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue>} or
4489 @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue 09:39>} or @samp{<2003-09-16 Tue
4490 12:00-12:30>}@footnote{This is the standard ISO date/time format. To
4491 use an alternative format, see @ref{Custom time format}.}. A time stamp
4492 can appear anywhere in the headline or body of an Org tree entry. Its
4493 presence causes entries to be shown on specific dates in the agenda
4494 (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}). We distinguish:
4495
4496 @table @var
4497 @item Plain time stamp; Event; Appointment
4498 @cindex timestamp
4499 A simple time stamp just assigns a date/time to an item. This is just
4500 like writing down an appointment or event in a paper agenda. In the
4501 timeline and agenda displays, the headline of an entry associated with a
4502 plain time stamp will be shown exactly on that date.
4503
4504 @example
4505 * Meet Peter at the movies <2006-11-01 Wed 19:15>
4506 * Discussion on climate change <2006-11-02 Thu 20:00-22:00>
4507 @end example
4508
4509 @item Time stamp with repeater interval
4510 @cindex timestamp, with repeater interval
4511 A time stamp may contain a @emph{repeater interval}, indicating that it
4512 applies not only on the given date, but again and again after a certain
4513 interval of N days (d), weeks (w), months(m), or years(y). The
4514 following will show up in the agenda every Wednesday:
4515
4516 @example
4517 * Pick up Sam at school <2007-05-16 Wed 12:30 +1w>
4518 @end example
4519
4520 @item Diary-style sexp entries
4521 For more complex date specifications, Org mode supports using the
4522 special sexp diary entries implemented in the Emacs calendar/diary
4523 package. For example
4524
4525 @example
4526 * The nerd meeting on every 2nd Thursday of the month
4527 <%%(diary-float t 4 2)>
4528 @end example
4529
4530 @item Time/Date range
4531 @cindex timerange
4532 @cindex date range
4533 Two time stamps connected by @samp{--} denote a range. The headline
4534 will be shown on the first and last day of the range, and on any dates
4535 that are displayed and fall in the range. Here is an example:
4536
4537 @example
4538 ** Meeting in Amsterdam
4539 <2004-08-23 Mon>--<2004-08-26 Thu>
4540 @end example
4541
4542 @item Inactive time stamp
4543 @cindex timestamp, inactive
4544 @cindex inactive timestamp
4545 Just like a plain time stamp, but with square brackets instead of
4546 angular ones. These time stamps are inactive in the sense that they do
4547 @emph{not} trigger an entry to show up in the agenda.
4548
4549 @example
4550 * Gillian comes late for the fifth time [2006-11-01 Wed]
4551 @end example
4552
4553 @end table
4554
4555 @node Creating timestamps, Deadlines and scheduling, Timestamps, Dates and Times
4556 @section Creating timestamps
4557 @cindex creating timestamps
4558 @cindex timestamps, creating
4559
4560 For Org mode to recognize time stamps, they need to be in the specific
4561 format. All commands listed below produce time stamps in the correct
4562 format.
4563
4564 @table @kbd
4565 @kindex C-c .
4566 @item C-c .
4567 Prompt for a date and insert a corresponding time stamp. When the cursor is
4568 at an existing time stamp in the buffer, the command is used to modify this
4569 timestamp instead of inserting a new one. When this command is used twice in
4570 succession, a time range is inserted.
4571 @c
4572 @kindex C-u C-c .
4573 @item C-u C-c .
4574 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but use the alternative format which contains date
4575 and time. The default time can be rounded to multiples of 5 minutes,
4576 see the option @code{org-time-stamp-rounding-minutes}.
4577 @c
4578 @kindex C-c !
4579 @item C-c !
4580 Like @kbd{C-c .}, but insert an inactive time stamp that will not cause
4581 an agenda entry.
4582 @c
4583 @kindex C-c <
4584 @item C-c <
4585 Insert a time stamp corresponding to the cursor date in the Calendar.
4586 @c
4587 @kindex C-c >
4588 @item C-c >
4589 Access the Emacs calendar for the current date. If there is a
4590 timestamp in the current line, go to the corresponding date
4591 instead.
4592 @c
4593 @kindex C-c C-o
4594 @item C-c C-o
4595 Access the agenda for the date given by the time stamp or -range at
4596 point (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
4597 @c
4598 @kindex S-@key{left}
4599 @kindex S-@key{right}
4600 @item S-@key{left}
4601 @itemx S-@key{right}
4602 Change date at cursor by one day. These key bindings conflict with
4603 CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4604 @c
4605 @kindex S-@key{up}
4606 @kindex S-@key{down}
4607 @item S-@key{up}
4608 @itemx S-@key{down}
4609 Change the item under the cursor in a timestamp. The cursor can be on a
4610 year, month, day, hour or minute. Note that if the cursor is in a
4611 headline and not at a time stamp, these same keys modify the priority of
4612 an item. (@pxref{Priorities}). The key bindings also conflict with
4613 CUA mode (@pxref{Conflicts}).
4614 @c
4615 @kindex C-c C-y
4616 @cindex evaluate time range
4617 @item C-c C-y
4618 Evaluate a time range by computing the difference between start and end.
4619 With a prefix argument, insert result after the time range (in a table: into
4620 the following column).
4621 @end table
4622
4623
4624 @menu
4625 * The date/time prompt:: How Org mode helps you entering date and time
4626 * Custom time format:: Making dates look different
4627 @end menu
4628
4629 @node The date/time prompt, Custom time format, Creating timestamps, Creating timestamps
4630 @subsection The date/time prompt
4631 @cindex date, reading in minibuffer
4632 @cindex time, reading in minibuffer
4633
4634 When Org mode prompts for a date/time, the default is shown as an ISO
4635 date, and the prompt therefore seems to ask for an ISO date. But it
4636 will in fact accept any string containing some date and/or time
4637 information, and it is really smart about interpreting your input. You
4638 can, for example, use @kbd{C-y} to paste a (possibly multi-line) string
4639 copied from an email message. Org mode will find whatever information
4640 is in there and derive anything you have not specified from the
4641 @emph{default date and time}. The default is usually the current date
4642 and time, but when modifying an existing time stamp, or when entering
4643 the second stamp of a range, it is taken from the stamp in the buffer.
4644 When filling in information, Org mode assumes that most of the time you
4645 will want to enter a date in the future: If you omit the month/year and
4646 the given day/month is @i{before} today, it will assume that you mean a
4647 future date@footnote{See the variable
4648 @code{org-read-date-prefer-future}.}.
4649
4650 For example, let's assume that today is @b{June 13, 2006}. Here is how
4651 various inputs will be interpreted, the items filled in by Org mode are
4652 in @b{bold}.
4653
4654 @example
4655 3-2-5 --> 2003-02-05
4656 14 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-14
4657 12 --> @b{2006}-@b{07}-12
4658 Fri --> nearest Friday (defaultdate or later)
4659 sep 15 --> @b{2006}-09-15
4660 feb 15 --> @b{2007}-02-15
4661 sep 12 9 --> 2009-09-12
4662 12:45 --> @b{2006}-@b{06}-@b{13} 12:45
4663 22 sept 0:34 --> @b{2006}-09-22 0:34
4664 w4 --> ISO week for of the current year @b{2006}
4665 2012 w4 fri --> Friday of ISO week 4 in 2012
4666 2012-w04-5 --> Same as above
4667 @end example
4668
4669 Furthermore you can specify a relative date by giving, as the
4670 @emph{first} thing in the input: a plus/minus sign, a number and a
4671 letter [dwmy] to indicate change in days weeks, months, years. With a
4672 single plus or minus, the date is always relative to today. With a
4673 double plus or minus, it is relative to the default date. If instead of
4674 a single letter, you use the abbreviation of day name, the date will be
4675 the nth such day. E.g.
4676
4677 @example
4678 +0 --> today
4679 . --> today
4680 +4d --> four days from today
4681 +4 --> same as above
4682 +2w --> two weeks from today
4683 ++5 --> five days from default date
4684 +2tue --> second tuesday from now.
4685 @end example
4686
4687 The function understands English month and weekday abbreviations. If
4688 you want to use unabbreviated names and/or other languages, configure
4689 the variables @code{parse-time-months} and @code{parse-time-weekdays}.
4690
4691 @cindex calendar, for selecting date
4692 Parallel to the minibuffer prompt, a calendar is popped up@footnote{If
4693 you don't need/want the calendar, configure the variable
4694 @code{org-popup-calendar-for-date-prompt}.}. When you exit the date
4695 prompt, either by clicking on a date in the calendar, or by pressing
4696 @key{RET}, the date selected in the calendar will be combined with the
4697 information entered at the prompt. You can control the calendar fully
4698 from the minibuffer:
4699
4700 @kindex <
4701 @kindex >
4702 @kindex mouse-1
4703 @kindex S-@key{right}
4704 @kindex S-@key{left}
4705 @kindex S-@key{down}
4706 @kindex S-@key{up}
4707 @kindex M-S-@key{right}
4708 @kindex M-S-@key{left}
4709 @kindex @key{RET}
4710 @example
4711 > / < @r{Scroll calendar forward/backward by one month.}
4712 mouse-1 @r{Select date by clicking on it.}
4713 S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One day forward/backward.}
4714 S-@key{down}/@key{up} @r{One week forward/backward.}
4715 M-S-@key{right}/@key{left} @r{One month forward/backward.}
4716 @key{RET} @r{Choose date in calendar.}
4717 @end example
4718
4719 The actions of the date/time prompt may seem complex, but I assure you they
4720 will grow on you, and you will start getting annoyed by pretty much any other
4721 way of entering a date/time out there. To help you understand what is going
4722 on, the current interpretation of your input will be displayed live in the
4723 minibuffer@footnote{If you find this distracting, turn the display of with
4724 @code{org-read-date-display-live}.}.
4725
4726 @node Custom time format, , The date/time prompt, Creating timestamps
4727 @subsection Custom time format
4728 @cindex custom date/time format
4729 @cindex time format, custom
4730 @cindex date format, custom
4731
4732 Org mode uses the standard ISO notation for dates and times as it is
4733 defined in ISO 8601. If you cannot get used to this and require another
4734 representation of date and time to keep you happy, you can get it by
4735 customizing the variables @code{org-display-custom-times} and
4736 @code{org-time-stamp-custom-formats}.
4737
4738 @table @kbd
4739 @kindex C-c C-x C-t
4740 @item C-c C-x C-t
4741 Toggle the display of custom formats for dates and times.
4742 @end table
4743
4744 @noindent
4745 Org mode needs the default format for scanning, so the custom date/time
4746 format does not @emph{replace} the default format - instead it is put
4747 @emph{over} the default format using text properties. This has the
4748 following consequences:
4749 @itemize @bullet
4750 @item
4751 You cannot place the cursor onto a time stamp anymore, only before or
4752 after.
4753 @item
4754 The @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} keys can no longer be used to adjust
4755 each component of a time stamp. If the cursor is at the beginning of
4756 the stamp, @kbd{S-@key{up}/@key{down}} will change the stamp by one day,
4757 just like @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}}. At the end of the stamp, the
4758 time will be changed by one minute.
4759 @item
4760 If the time stamp contains a range of clock times or a repeater, these
4761 will not be overlayed, but remain in the buffer as they were.
4762 @item
4763 When you delete a time stamp character-by-character, it will only
4764 disappear from the buffer after @emph{all} (invisible) characters
4765 belonging to the ISO timestamp have been removed.
4766 @item
4767 If the custom time stamp format is longer than the default and you are
4768 using dates in tables, table alignment will be messed up. If the custom
4769 format is shorter, things do work as expected.
4770 @end itemize
4771
4772
4773 @node Deadlines and scheduling, Clocking work time, Creating timestamps, Dates and Times
4774 @section Deadlines and scheduling
4775
4776 A time stamp may be preceded by special keywords to facilitate planning:
4777
4778 @table @var
4779 @item DEADLINE
4780 @cindex DEADLINE keyword
4781
4782 Meaning: the task (most likely a TODO item, though not necessarily) is supposed
4783 to be finished on that date.
4784
4785 On the deadline date, the task will be listed in the agenda. In
4786 addition, the agenda for @emph{today} will carry a warning about the
4787 approaching or missed deadline, starting
4788 @code{org-deadline-warning-days} before the due date, and continuing
4789 until the entry is marked DONE. An example:
4790
4791 @example
4792 *** TODO write article about the Earth for the Guide
4793 The editor in charge is [[bbdb:Ford Prefect]]
4794 DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun>
4795 @end example
4796
4797 You can specify a different lead time for warnings for a specific
4798 deadlines using the following syntax. Here is an example with a warning
4799 period of 5 days @code{DEADLINE: <2004-02-29 Sun -5d>}.
4800
4801 @item SCHEDULED
4802 @cindex SCHEDULED keyword
4803
4804 Meaning: you are planning to start working on that task on the given
4805 date.
4806
4807 The headline will be listed under the given date@footnote{It will still
4808 be listed on that date after it has been marked DONE. If you don't like
4809 this, set the variable @code{org-agenda-skip-scheduled-if-done}.}. In
4810 addition, a reminder that the scheduled date has passed will be present
4811 in the compilation for @emph{today}, until the entry is marked DONE.
4812 I.e., the task will automatically be forwarded until completed.
4813
4814 @example
4815 *** TODO Call Trillian for a date on New Years Eve.
4816 SCHEDULED: <2004-12-25 Sat>
4817 @end example
4818
4819 @noindent
4820 @b{Important:} Scheduling an item in Org mode should @i{not} be
4821 understood in the same way that we understand @i{scheduling a meeting}.
4822 Setting a date for a meeting is just a simple appointment, you should
4823 mark this entry with a simple plain time stamp, to get this item shown
4824 on the date where it applies. This is a frequent mis-understanding from
4825 Org-users. In Org mode, @i{scheduling} means setting a date when you
4826 want to start working on an action item.
4827 @end table
4828
4829 You may use time stamps with repeaters in scheduling and deadline
4830 entries. Org mode will issue early and late warnings based on the
4831 assumption that the time stamp represents the @i{nearest instance} of
4832 the repeater. However, the use of diary sexp entries like
4833 @c
4834 @code{<%%(diary-float t 42)>}
4835 @c
4836 in scheduling and deadline timestamps is limited. Org mode does not
4837 know enough about the internals of each sexp function to issue early and
4838 late warnings. However, it will show the item on each day where the
4839 sexp entry matches.
4840
4841 @menu
4842 * Inserting deadline/schedule:: Planning items
4843 * Repeated tasks:: Items that show up again and again
4844 @end menu
4845
4846 @node Inserting deadline/schedule, Repeated tasks, Deadlines and scheduling, Deadlines and scheduling
4847 @subsection Inserting deadlines or schedules
4848
4849 The following commands allow to quickly insert a deadline or to schedule
4850 an item:
4851
4852 @table @kbd
4853 @c
4854 @kindex C-c C-d
4855 @item C-c C-d
4856 Insert @samp{DEADLINE} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
4857 happen in the line directly following the headline. When called with a
4858 prefix arg, an existing deadline will be removed from the entry.
4859 @c FIXME Any CLOSED timestamp will be removed.????????
4860 @c
4861 @kindex C-c / d
4862 @cindex sparse tree, for deadlines
4863 @item C-c / d
4864 Create a sparse tree with all deadlines that are either past-due, or
4865 which will become due within @code{org-deadline-warning-days}.
4866 With @kbd{C-u} prefix, show all deadlines in the file. With a numeric
4867 prefix, check that many days. For example, @kbd{C-1 C-c / d} shows
4868 all deadlines due tomorrow.
4869 @c
4870 @kindex C-c C-s
4871 @item C-c C-s
4872 Insert @samp{SCHEDULED} keyword along with a stamp. The insertion will
4873 happen in the line directly following the headline. Any CLOSED
4874 timestamp will be removed. When called with a prefix argument, remove
4875 the scheduling date from the entry.
4876 @c
4877 @kindex C-c C-x C-k
4878 @kindex k a
4879 @kindex k s
4880 @item C-c C-x C-k
4881 Mark the current entry for agenda action. After you have marked the entry
4882 like this, you can open the agenda or the calendar to find an appropriate
4883 date. With the cursor on the selected date, press @kbd{k s} or @kbd{k d} to
4884 schedule the marked item.
4885 @end table
4886
4887 @node Repeated tasks, , Inserting deadline/schedule, Deadlines and scheduling
4888 @subsection Repeated tasks
4889
4890 Some tasks need to be repeated again and again. Org mode helps to
4891 organize such tasks using a so-called repeater in a DEADLINE, SCHEDULED,
4892 or plain time stamp. In the following example
4893 @example
4894 ** TODO Pay the rent
4895 DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m>
4896 @end example
4897 the @code{+1m} is a repeater; the intended interpretation is that the
4898 task has a deadline on <2005-10-01> and repeats itself every (one) month
4899 starting from that time. If you need both a repeater and a special
4900 warning period in a deadline entry, the repeater comes first and the
4901 warning period last: @code{DEADLINE: <2005-10-01 Sat +1m -3d>}.
4902
4903 Deadlines and scheduled items produce entries in the agenda when they
4904 are over-due, so it is important to be able to mark such an entry as
4905 completed once you have done so. When you mark a DEADLINE or a SCHEDULE
4906 with the TODO keyword DONE, it will no longer produce entries in the
4907 agenda. The problem with this is, however, that then also the
4908 @emph{next} instance of the repeated entry will not be active. Org mode
4909 deals with this in the following way: When you try to mark such an entry
4910 DONE (using @kbd{C-c C-t}), it will shift the base date of the repeating
4911 time stamp by the repeater interval, and immediately set the entry state
4912 back to TODO. In the example above, setting the state to DONE would
4913 actually switch the date like this:
4914
4915 @example
4916 ** TODO Pay the rent
4917 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue +1m>
4918 @end example
4919
4920 A timestamp@footnote{You can change this using the option
4921 @code{org-log-repeat}, or the @code{#+STARTUP} options @code{logrepeat},
4922 @code{lognoterepeat}, and @code{nologrepeat}. With @code{lognoterepeat}, you
4923 will also be prompted for a note.} will be added under the deadline, to keep
4924 a record that you actually acted on the previous instance of this deadline.
4925
4926 As a consequence of shifting the base date, this entry will no longer be
4927 visible in the agenda when checking past dates, but all future instances
4928 will be visible.
4929
4930 With the @samp{+1m} cookie, the date shift will always be exactly one
4931 month. So if you have not payed the rent for three months, marking this
4932 entry DONE will still keep it as an overdue deadline. Depending on the
4933 task, this may not be the best way to handle it. For example, if you
4934 forgot to call you father for 3 weeks, it does not make sense to call
4935 him 3 times in a single day to make up for it. Finally, there are tasks
4936 like changing batteries which should always repeat a certain time
4937 @i{after} the last time you did it. For these tasks, Org mode has
4938 special repeaters markers with @samp{++} and @samp{.+}. For example:
4939
4940 @example
4941 ** TODO Call Father
4942 DEADLINE: <2008-02-10 Sun ++1w>
4943 Marking this DONE will shift the date by at least one week,
4944 but also by as many weeks as it takes to get this date into
4945 the future. However, it stays on a Sunday, even if you called
4946 and marked it done on Saturday.
4947 ** TODO Check the batteries in the smoke detectors
4948 DEADLINE: <2005-11-01 Tue .+1m>
4949 Marking this DONE will shift the date to one month after
4950 today.
4951 @end example
4952
4953 You may have both scheduling and deadline information for a specific
4954 task - just make sure that the repeater intervals on both are the same.
4955
4956 @node Clocking work time, Effort estimates, Deadlines and scheduling, Dates and Times
4957 @section Clocking work time
4958
4959 Org mode allows you to clock the time you spent on specific tasks in a
4960 project. When you start working on an item, you can start the clock.
4961 When you stop working on that task, or when you mark the task done, the
4962 clock is stopped and the corresponding time interval is recorded. It
4963 also computes the total time spent on each subtree of a project.
4964
4965 @table @kbd
4966 @kindex C-c C-x C-i
4967 @item C-c C-x C-i
4968 Start the clock on the current item (clock-in). This inserts the CLOCK
4969 keyword together with a timestamp. If this is not the first clocking of
4970 this item, the multiple CLOCK lines will be wrapped into a
4971 @code{:CLOCK:} drawer (see also the variable
4972 @code{org-clock-into-drawer}). When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument,
4973 select the task from a list of recently clocked tasks. With two @kbd{C-u
4974 C-u} prefixes, clock into the task at point and mark it as the default task.
4975 The default task will always be available when selecting a clocking task,
4976 with letter @kbd{d}.
4977 @kindex C-c C-x C-o
4978 @item C-c C-x C-o
4979 Stop the clock (clock-out). This inserts another timestamp at the same
4980 location where the clock was last started. It also directly computes
4981 the resulting time in inserts it after the time range as @samp{=>
4982 HH:MM}. See the variable @code{org-log-note-clock-out} for the
4983 possibility to record an additional note together with the clock-out
4984 time stamp@footnote{The corresponding in-buffer setting is:
4985 @code{#+STARTUP: lognoteclock-out}}.
4986 @kindex C-c C-y
4987 @item C-c C-y
4988 Recompute the time interval after changing one of the time stamps. This
4989 is only necessary if you edit the time stamps directly. If you change
4990 them with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, the update is automatic.
4991 @kindex C-c C-t
4992 @item C-c C-t
4993 Changing the TODO state of an item to DONE automatically stops the clock
4994 if it is running in this same item.
4995 @kindex C-c C-x C-x
4996 @item C-c C-x C-x
4997 Cancel the current clock. This is useful if a clock was started by
4998 mistake, or if you ended up working on something else.
4999 @kindex C-c C-x C-j
5000 @item C-c C-x C-j
5001 Jump to the entry that contains the currently running clock. With a
5002 @kbd{C-u} prefix arg, select the target task from a list of recently clocked
5003 tasks.
5004 @kindex C-c C-x C-d
5005 @item C-c C-x C-d
5006 Display time summaries for each subtree in the current buffer. This
5007 puts overlays at the end of each headline, showing the total time
5008 recorded under that heading, including the time of any subheadings. You
5009 can use visibility cycling to study the tree, but the overlays disappear
5010 when you change the buffer (see variable
5011 @code{org-remove-highlights-with-change}) or press @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5012 @kindex C-c C-x C-r
5013 @item C-c C-x C-r
5014 Insert a dynamic block (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}) containing a clock
5015 report as an Org mode table into the current file. When the cursor is
5016 at an existing clock table, just update it. When called with a prefix
5017 argument, jump to the first clock report in the current document and
5018 update it.
5019 @cindex #+BEGIN: clocktable
5020 @example
5021 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :emphasize nil :scope file
5022 #+END: clocktable
5023 @end example
5024 @noindent
5025 If such a block already exists at point, its content is replaced by the
5026 new table. The @samp{BEGIN} line can specify options:
5027 @example
5028 :maxlevel @r{Maximum level depth to which times are listed in the table.}
5029 :emphasize @r{When @code{t}, emphasize level one and level two items}
5030 :scope @r{The scope to consider. This can be any of the following:}
5031 nil @r{the current buffer or narrowed region}
5032 file @r{the full current buffer}
5033 subtree @r{the subtree where the clocktable is located}
5034 treeN @r{the surrounding level N tree, for example @code{tree3}}
5035 tree @r{the surrounding level 1 tree}
5036 agenda @r{all agenda files}
5037 ("file"..) @r{scan these files}
5038 file-with-archives @r{current file and its archives}
5039 agenda-with-archives @r{all agenda files, including archives}
5040 :block @r{The time block to consider. This block is specified either}
5041 @r{absolute, or relative to the current time and may be any of}
5042 @r{these formats:}
5043 2007-12-31 @r{New year eve 2007}
5044 2007-12 @r{December 2007}
5045 2007-W50 @r{ISO-week 50 in 2007}
5046 2007 @r{the year 2007}
5047 today, yesterday, today-N @r{a relative day}
5048 thisweek, lastweek, thisweek-N @r{a relative week}
5049 thismonth, lastmonth, thismonth-N @r{a relative month}
5050 thisyear, lastyear, thisyear-N @r{a relative year}
5051 @r{Use @kbd{S-@key{left}/@key{right}} keys to shift the time interval.}
5052 :tstart @r{A time string specifying when to start considering times}
5053 :tend @r{A time string specifying when to stop considering times}
5054 :step @r{@code{week} or @code{day}, to split the table into chunks.}
5055 @r{To use this, @code{:block} or @code{:tstart}, @code{:tend} are needed.}
5056 :link @r{Link the item headlines in the table to their origins}
5057 :formula @r{Content of a @code{#+TBLFM} line to be added and evaluated.}
5058 @r{As a special case, @samp{:formula %} adds column with % time.}
5059 @r{If you do not specify a formula here, any existing formula}
5060 @r{below the clock table will survive updates and be evaluated.}
5061 @end example
5062 So to get a clock summary of the current level 1 tree, for the current
5063 day, you could write
5064 @example
5065 #+BEGIN: clocktable :maxlevel 2 :block today :scope tree1 :link t
5066 #+END: clocktable
5067 @end example
5068 and to use a specific time range you could write@footnote{Note that all
5069 parameters must be specified in a single line - the line is broken here
5070 only to fit it onto the manual.}
5071 @example
5072 #+BEGIN: clocktable :tstart "<2006-08-10 Thu 10:00>"
5073 :tend "<2006-08-10 Thu 12:00>"
5074 #+END: clocktable
5075 @end example
5076 A summary of the current subtree with % times would be
5077 @example
5078 #+BEGIN: clocktable :scope subtree :link t :formula %
5079 #+END: clocktable
5080 @end example
5081 @kindex C-c C-c
5082 @item C-c C-c
5083 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
5084 @itemx C-c C-x C-u
5085 Update dynamical block at point. The cursor needs to be in the
5086 @code{#+BEGIN} line of the dynamic block.
5087 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
5088 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
5089 Update all dynamic blocks (@pxref{Dynamic blocks}). This is useful if
5090 you have several clock table blocks in a buffer.
5091 @kindex S-@key{left}
5092 @kindex S-@key{right}
5093 @item S-@key{left}
5094 @itemx S-@key{right}
5095 Shift the current @code{:block} interval and update the table. The cursor
5096 needs to be in the @code{#+BEGIN: clocktable} line for this command. If
5097 @code{:block} is @code{today}, it will be shifted to @code{today-1} etc.
5098 @end table
5099
5100 The @kbd{l} key may be used in the timeline (@pxref{Timeline}) and in
5101 the agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}) to show which tasks have been
5102 worked on or closed during a day.
5103
5104 @node Effort estimates, Relative timer, Clocking work time, Dates and Times
5105 @section Effort estimates
5106 @cindex effort estimates
5107
5108 If you want to plan your work in a very detailed way, or if you need to
5109 produce offers with quotations of the estimated work effort, you may want to
5110 assign effort estimates to entries. If you are also clocking your work, you
5111 may later want to compare the planned effort with the actual working time, a
5112 great way to improve planning estimates. Effort estimates are stored in a
5113 special property @samp{Effort}@footnote{You may change the property being
5114 used with the variable @code{org-effort-property}.}. Clearly the best way to
5115 work with effort estimates is through column view (@pxref{Column view}). You
5116 should start by setting up discrete values for effort estimates, and a
5117 @code{COLUMNS} format that displays these values together with clock sums (if
5118 you want to clock your time). For a specific buffer you can use
5119
5120 @example
5121 #+PROPERTY: Effort_ALL 0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00 5:00 6:00 7:00 8:00
5122 #+COLUMNS: %40ITEM(Task) %17Effort(Estimated Effort)@{:@} %CLOCKSUM
5123 @end example
5124
5125 @noindent
5126 or, even better, you can set up these values globally by customizing the
5127 variables @code{org-global-properties} and @code{org-columns-default-format}.
5128 In particular if you want to use this setup also in the agenda, a global
5129 setup may be advised.
5130
5131 The way to assign estimates to individual items is then to switch to column
5132 mode, and to use @kbd{S-@key{right}} and @kbd{S-@key{left}} to change the
5133 value. The values you enter will immediately be summed up in the hierarchy.
5134 In the column next to it, any clocked time will be displayed.
5135
5136 If you switch to column view in the daily/weekly agenda, the effort column
5137 will summarize the estimated work effort for each day@footnote{Please note
5138 the pitfalls of summing hierarchical data in a flat list (@pxref{Agenda
5139 column view}).}, and you can use this to find space in your schedule. To get
5140 an overview of the entire part of the day that is committed, you can set the
5141 option @code{org-agenda-columns-add-appointments-to-effort-sum}. The
5142 appointments on a day that take place over a specified time interval will
5143 then also be added to the load estimate of the day.
5144
5145 Effort estimates can be used in secondary agenda filtering that is triggered
5146 with the @kbd{/} key in the agenda (@pxref{Agenda commands}). If you have
5147 these estimates defined consistently, two or three key presses will narrow
5148 down the list to stuff that fits into an available time slot.
5149
5150 @node Relative timer, , Effort estimates, Dates and Times
5151 @section Taking notes with a relative timer
5152 @cindex relative timer
5153
5154 When taking notes during, for example, a meeting or a video viewing, it can
5155 be useful to have access to times relative to a starting time. Org provides
5156 such a relative timer and make it easy to create timed notes.
5157
5158 @table @kbd
5159 @kindex C-c C-x .
5160 @item C-c C-x .
5161 Insert a relative time into the buffer. The first time you use this, the
5162 timer will be started. When called with a prefix argument, the timer is
5163 restarted.
5164 @kindex C-c C-x -
5165 @item C-c C-x -
5166 Insert a description list item with the current relative time. With a prefix
5167 argument, first reset the timer to 0.
5168 @kindex M-@key{RET}
5169 @item M-@key{RET}
5170 Once the timer list is started, you can also use @kbd{M-@key{RET}} to insert
5171 new timer items.
5172 @kindex C-c C-x ,
5173 @item C-c C-x ,
5174 Pause the timer, or continue it if it is already paused. With prefix
5175 argument, stop it entirely.
5176 @kindex C-u C-c C-x ,
5177 @item C-u C-c C-x ,
5178 Stop the timer. After this, you can only start a new timer, not continue the
5179 old one. This command also removes the timer from the mode line.
5180 @kindex C-c C-x 0
5181 @item C-c C-x 0
5182 Reset the timer without inserting anything into the buffer. By default, the
5183 timer is reset to 0. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, reset the timer to
5184 specific starting offset. The user is prompted for the offset, with a
5185 default taken from a timer string at point, if any, So this can be used to
5186 restart taking notes after a break in the process. When called with a double
5187 prefix argument @kbd{C-c C-u}, change all timer strings in the active region
5188 by a certain amount. This can be used to fix timer strings if the timer was
5189 not started at exactly the right moment.
5190 @end table
5191
5192 @node Capture, Agenda Views, Dates and Times, Top
5193 @chapter Capture
5194 @cindex capture
5195
5196 An important part of any organization system is the ability to quickly
5197 capture new ideas and tasks, and to associate reference material with them.
5198 Org uses the @file{remember} package to create tasks, and stores files
5199 related to a task (@i{attachments}) in a special directory.
5200
5201 @menu
5202 * Remember:: Capture new tasks/ideas with little interruption
5203 * Attachments:: Add files to tasks.
5204 @end menu
5205
5206 @node Remember, Attachments, Capture, Capture
5207 @section Remember
5208 @cindex @file{remember.el}
5209
5210 The @i{Remember} package by John Wiegley lets you store quick notes with
5211 little interruption of your work flow. See
5212 @uref{http://www.emacswiki.org/cgi-bin/wiki/RememberMode} for more
5213 information. It is an excellent way to add new notes and tasks to
5214 Org files. Org significantly expands the possibilities of
5215 @i{remember}: You may define templates for different note types, and
5216 associate target files and headlines with specific templates. It also
5217 allows you to select the location where a note should be stored
5218 interactively, on the fly.
5219
5220 @menu
5221 * Setting up Remember:: Some code for .emacs to get things going
5222 * Remember templates:: Define the outline of different note types
5223 * Storing notes:: Directly get the note to where it belongs
5224 * Refiling notes:: Moving a note or task to a project
5225 @end menu
5226
5227 @node Setting up Remember, Remember templates, Remember, Remember
5228 @subsection Setting up Remember
5229
5230 The following customization will tell @i{remember} to use org files as
5231 target, and to create annotations compatible with Org links.
5232
5233 @example
5234 (org-remember-insinuate)
5235 (setq org-directory "~/path/to/my/orgfiles/")
5236 (setq org-default-notes-file (concat org-directory "/notes.org"))
5237 (define-key global-map "\C-cr" 'org-remember)
5238 @end example
5239
5240 The last line binds the command @code{org-remember} to a global
5241 key@footnote{Please select your own key, @kbd{C-c r} is only a
5242 suggestion.}. @code{org-remember} basically just calls @code{remember},
5243 but it makes a few things easier: If there is an active region, it will
5244 automatically copy the region into the remember buffer. It also allows
5245 to jump to the buffer and location where remember notes are being
5246 stored: Just call @code{org-remember} with a prefix argument. If you
5247 use two prefix arguments, Org jumps to the location where the last
5248 remember note was stored.
5249
5250 The remember buffer will actually use @code{org-mode} as its major mode, so
5251 that all editing features of Org-mode are available. In addition to this, a
5252 minor mode @code{org-remember-mode} is turned on, for the single purpose that
5253 you can use its keymap @code{org-remember-mode-map} to overwrite some of
5254 Org-mode's key bindings.
5255
5256 You can also call @code{org-remember} in a special way from the agenda,
5257 using the @kbd{k r} key combination. With this access, any time stamps
5258 inserted by the selected remember template (see below) will default to
5259 the cursor date in the agenda, rather than to the current date.
5260
5261 @node Remember templates, Storing notes, Setting up Remember, Remember
5262 @subsection Remember templates
5263 @cindex templates, for remember
5264
5265 In combination with Org, you can use templates to generate
5266 different types of @i{remember} notes. For example, if you would like
5267 to use one template to create general TODO entries, another one for
5268 journal entries, and a third one for collecting random ideas, you could
5269 use:
5270
5271 @example
5272 (setq org-remember-templates
5273 '(("Todo" ?t "* TODO %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/TODO.org" "Tasks")
5274 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org")
5275 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5276 @end example
5277
5278 @noindent In these entries, the first string is just a name, and the
5279 character specifies how to select the template. It is useful if the
5280 character is also the first letter of the name. The next string specifies
5281 the template. Two more (optional) strings give the file in which, and the
5282 headline under which the new note should be stored. The file (if not present
5283 or @code{nil}) defaults to @code{org-default-notes-file}, the heading to
5284 @code{org-remember-default-headline}. If the file name is not an absolute
5285 path, it will be interpreted relative to @code{org-directory}. The heading
5286 can also be the symbols @code{top} or @code{bottom} to send note as level 1
5287 entries to the beginning or end of the file, respectively.
5288
5289 An optional sixth element specifies the contexts in which the user can select
5290 the template. This element can be a list of major modes or a function.
5291 @code{org-remember} will first check whether the function returns @code{t} or
5292 if we are in any of the listed major mode, and exclude templates for which
5293 this condition is not fulfilled. Templates that do not specify this element
5294 at all, or that use @code{nil} or @code{t} as a value will always be
5295 selectable.
5296
5297 So for example:
5298
5299 @example
5300 (setq org-remember-templates
5301 '(("Bug" ?b "* BUG %?\n %i\n %a" "~/org/BUGS.org" "Bugs" (emacs-lisp-mode))
5302 ("Journal" ?j "* %U %?\n\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "X" my-check)
5303 ("Idea" ?i "* %^@{Title@}\n %i\n %a" "~/org/JOURNAL.org" "New Ideas")))
5304 @end example
5305
5306 The first template will only be available when invoking @code{org-remember}
5307 from an buffer in @code{emacs-lisp-mode}. The second template will only be
5308 available when the function @code{my-check} returns @code{t}. The third
5309 template will be proposed in any context.
5310
5311 When you call @kbd{M-x org-remember} (or @kbd{M-x remember}) to remember
5312 something, Org will prompt for a key to select the template (if you have
5313 more than one template) and then prepare the buffer like
5314 @example
5315 * TODO
5316 [[file:link to where you called remember]]
5317 @end example
5318
5319 @noindent
5320 During expansion of the template, special @kbd{%}-escapes allow dynamic
5321 insertion of content:
5322 @example
5323 %^@{prompt@} @r{prompt the user for a string and replace this sequence with it.}
5324 @r{You may specify a default value and a completion table with}
5325 @r{%^@{prompt|default|completion2|completion3...@}}
5326 @r{The arrow keys access a prompt-specific history.}
5327 %a @r{annotation, normally the link created with @code{org-store-link}}
5328 %A @r{like @code{%a}, but prompt for the description part}
5329 %i @r{initial content, the region when remember is called with C-u.}
5330 @r{The entire text will be indented like @code{%i} itself.}
5331 %t @r{time stamp, date only}
5332 %T @r{time stamp with date and time}
5333 %u, %U @r{like the above, but inactive time stamps}
5334 %^t @r{like @code{%t}, but prompt for date. Similarly @code{%^T}, @code{%^u}, @code{%^U}}
5335 @r{You may define a prompt like @code{%^@{Birthday@}t}}
5336 %n @r{user name (taken from @code{user-full-name})}
5337 %c @r{Current kill ring head.}
5338 %x @r{Content of the X clipboard.}
5339 %^C @r{Interactive selection of which kill or clip to use.}
5340 %^L @r{Like @code{%^C}, but insert as link.}
5341 %^g @r{prompt for tags, with completion on tags in target file.}
5342 %k @r{title of currently clocked task}
5343 %K @r{link to currently clocked task}
5344 %^G @r{prompt for tags, with completion all tags in all agenda files.}
5345 %^@{prop@}p @r{Prompt the user for a value for property @code{prop}}
5346 %:keyword @r{specific information for certain link types, see below}
5347 %[pathname] @r{insert the contents of the file given by @code{pathname}}
5348 %(sexp) @r{evaluate elisp @code{(sexp)} and replace with the result}
5349 %! @r{immediately store note after completing the template}
5350 @r{(skipping the @kbd{C-c C-c} that normally triggers storing)}
5351 %& @r{jump to target location immediately after storing note}
5352 @end example
5353
5354 @noindent
5355 For specific link types, the following keywords will be
5356 defined@footnote{If you define your own link types (@pxref{Adding
5357 hyperlink types}), any property you store with
5358 @code{org-store-link-props} can be accessed in remember templates in a
5359 similar way.}:
5360
5361 @example
5362 Link type | Available keywords
5363 -------------------+----------------------------------------------
5364 bbdb | %:name %:company
5365 bbdb | %::server %:port %:nick
5366 vm, wl, mh, rmail | %:type %:subject %:message-id
5367 | %:from %:fromname %:fromaddress
5368 | %:to %:toname %:toaddress
5369 | %:fromto @r{(either "to NAME" or "from NAME")@footnote{This will always be the other, not the user. See the variable @code{org-from-is-user-regexp}.}}
5370 gnus | %:group, @r{for messages also all email fields}
5371 w3, w3m | %:url
5372 info | %:file %:node
5373 calendar | %:date"
5374 @end example
5375
5376 @noindent
5377 To place the cursor after template expansion use:
5378
5379 @example
5380 %? @r{After completing the template, position cursor here.}
5381 @end example
5382
5383 @noindent
5384 If you change your mind about which template to use, call
5385 @code{org-remember} in the remember buffer. You may then select a new
5386 template that will be filled with the previous context information.
5387
5388 @node Storing notes, Refiling notes, Remember templates, Remember
5389 @subsection Storing notes
5390
5391 When you are finished preparing a note with @i{remember}, you have to press
5392 @kbd{C-c C-c} to file the note away. If you have started the clock in the
5393 remember buffer, you will first be asked if you want to clock out
5394 now@footnote{To avoid this query, configure the variable
5395 @code{org-remember-clock-out-on-exit}.}. If you answer @kbd{n}, the clock
5396 will continue to run after the note was filed away.
5397
5398 The handler will then store the note in the file and under the headline
5399 specified in the template, or it will use the default file and headlines.
5400 The window configuration will be restored, sending you back to the working
5401 context before the call to @code{remember}. To re-use the location found
5402 during the last call to @code{remember}, exit the remember buffer with
5403 @kbd{C-0 C-c C-c}, i.e. specify a zero prefix argument to @kbd{C-c C-c}.
5404 Another special case is @kbd{C-2 C-c C-c} which files the note as a child of
5405 the currently clocked item.
5406
5407 If you want to store the note directly to a different place, use
5408 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-c} instead to exit remember@footnote{Configure the
5409 variable @code{org-remember-store-without-prompt} to make this behavior
5410 the default.}. The handler will then first prompt for a target file -
5411 if you press @key{RET}, the value specified for the template is used.
5412 Then the command offers the headings tree of the selected file, with the
5413 cursor position at the default headline (if you had specified one in the
5414 template). You can either immediately press @key{RET} to get the note
5415 placed there. Or you can use the following keys to find a different
5416 location:
5417 @example
5418 @key{TAB} @r{Cycle visibility.}
5419 @key{down} / @key{up} @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5420 n / p @r{Next/previous visible headline.}
5421 f / b @r{Next/previous headline same level.}
5422 u @r{One level up.}
5423 @c 0-9 @r{Digit argument.}
5424 @end example
5425 @noindent
5426 Pressing @key{RET} or @key{left} or @key{right}
5427 then leads to the following result.
5428
5429 @multitable @columnfractions 0.2 0.15 0.65
5430 @item @b{Cursor position} @tab @b{Key} @tab @b{Note gets inserted}
5431 @item on headline @tab @key{RET} @tab as sublevel of the heading at cursor, first or last
5432 @item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
5433 @item @tab @key{left}/@key{right} @tab as same level, before/after current heading
5434 @item buffer-start @tab @key{RET} @tab as level 2 heading at end of file or level 1 at beginning
5435 @item @tab @tab depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}.
5436 @item not on headline @tab @key{RET}
5437 @tab at cursor position, level taken from context.
5438 @end multitable
5439
5440 Before inserting the text into a tree, the function ensures that the text has
5441 a headline, i.e. a first line that starts with a @samp{*}. If not, a
5442 headline is constructed from the current date. If you have indented the text
5443 of the note below the headline, the indentation will be adapted if inserting
5444 the note into the tree requires demotion from level 1.
5445
5446 @node Refiling notes, , Storing notes, Remember
5447 @subsection Refiling notes
5448 @cindex refiling notes
5449
5450 Remember is usually used to quickly capture notes and tasks into one or
5451 a few capture lists. When reviewing the captured data, you may want to
5452 refile some of the entries into a different list, for example into a
5453 project. Cutting, finding the right location and then pasting the note
5454 is cumbersome. To simplify this process, you can use the following
5455 special command:
5456
5457 @table @kbd
5458 @kindex C-c C-w
5459 @item C-c C-w
5460 Refile the entry or region at point. This command offers possible locations
5461 for refiling the entry and lets you select one with completion. The item (or
5462 all items in the region) is filed below the target heading as a subitem.
5463 Depending on @code{org-reverse-note-order}, it will be either the first or
5464 last subitem.@*
5465 By default, all level 1 headlines in the current buffer are considered to be
5466 targets, but you can have more complex definitions across a number of files.
5467 See the variable @code{org-refile-targets} for details. If you would like to
5468 select a location via a file-path-like completion along the outline path, see
5469 the variables @code{org-refile-use-outline-path} and
5470 @code{org-outline-path-complete-in-steps}.
5471 @kindex C-u C-c C-w
5472 @item C-u C-c C-w
5473 Use the refile interface to jump to a heading.
5474 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-w
5475 @item C-u C-u C-c C-w
5476 Jump to the location where @code{org-refile} last moved a tree to.
5477 @end table
5478
5479 @node Attachments, , Remember, Capture
5480 @section Attachments
5481 @cindex attachments
5482
5483 It is often useful to associate reference material with an outline node/task.
5484 Small chunks of plain text can simply be stored in the subtree of a project.
5485 Hyperlinks (@pxref{Hyperlinks}) can be used to establish associations with
5486 files that live elsewhere on your computer or in the cloud, like emails or
5487 source code files belonging to a project. Another method is @i{attachments},
5488 which are files located in a directory belonging to an outline node. Org
5489 uses directories named by the unique ID of each entry. These directories are
5490 located in the @file{data} directory which lives in the same directory where
5491 your org-file lives@footnote{If you move entries or Org-files from one
5492 directory to the next, you may want to configure @code{org-attach-directory}
5493 to contain an absolute path.}. If you initialize this directory with
5494 @code{git-init}, Org will automatically commit changes when it sees them.
5495 The attachment system has been contributed to Org by John Wiegley.
5496
5497 In cases where this seems better, you can also attach a directory of your
5498 choice to an entry. You can also make children inherit the attachment
5499 directory from a parent, so that an entire subtree uses the same attached
5500 directory.
5501
5502 @noindent The following commands deal with attachments.
5503
5504 @table @kbd
5505
5506 @kindex C-c C-a
5507 @item C-c C-a
5508 The dispatcher for commands related to the attachment system. After these
5509 keys, a list of commands is displayed and you need to press an additional key
5510 to select a command:
5511
5512 @table @kbd
5513 @kindex C-c C-a a
5514 @item a
5515 Select a file and move it into the task's attachment directory. The file
5516 will be copied, moved, or linked, depending on @code{org-attach-method}.
5517 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
5518
5519 @kindex C-c C-a c
5520 @kindex C-c C-a m
5521 @kindex C-c C-a l
5522 @item c/m/l
5523 Attach a file using the copy/move/link method.
5524 Note that hard links are not supported on all systems.
5525
5526 @kindex C-c C-a n
5527 @item n
5528 Create a new attachment as an Emacs buffer.
5529
5530 @kindex C-c C-a z
5531 @item z
5532 Synchronize the current task with its attachment directory, in case you added
5533 attachments yourself.
5534
5535 @kindex C-c C-a o
5536 @item o
5537 Open current task's attachment. If there are more than one, prompt for a
5538 file name first. Opening will follow the rules set by @code{org-file-apps}.
5539 For more details, see the information on following hyperlinks
5540 (@pxref{Handling links}).
5541
5542 @kindex C-c C-a O
5543 @item O
5544 Also open the attachment, but force opening the file in Emacs.
5545
5546 @kindex C-c C-a f
5547 @item f
5548 Open the current task's attachment directory.
5549
5550 @kindex C-c C-a F
5551 @item F
5552 Also open the directory, but force using @code{dired} in Emacs.
5553
5554 @kindex C-c C-a d
5555 @item d
5556 Select and delete a single attachment.
5557
5558 @kindex C-c C-a D
5559 @item D
5560 Delete all of a task's attachments. A safer way is to open the directory in
5561 dired and delete from there.
5562
5563 @kindex C-c C-a s
5564 @item C-c C-a s
5565 Set a specific directory as the entry's attachment directory. This works by
5566 putting the directory path into the @code{ATTACH_DIR} property.
5567
5568 @kindex C-c C-a i
5569 @item C-c C-a i
5570 Set the @code{ATTACH_DIR_INHERIT} property, so that children will use the
5571 same directory for attachments as the parent.
5572 @end table
5573 @end table
5574
5575 @node Agenda Views, Embedded LaTeX, Capture, Top
5576 @chapter Agenda Views
5577 @cindex agenda views
5578
5579 Due to the way Org works, TODO items, time-stamped items, and
5580 tagged headlines can be scattered throughout a file or even a number of
5581 files. To get an overview of open action items, or of events that are
5582 important for a particular date, this information must be collected,
5583 sorted and displayed in an organized way.
5584
5585 Org can select items based on various criteria, and display them
5586 in a separate buffer. Seven different view types are provided:
5587
5588 @itemize @bullet
5589 @item
5590 an @emph{agenda} that is like a calendar and shows information
5591 for specific dates,
5592 @item
5593 a @emph{TODO list} that covers all unfinished
5594 action items,
5595 @item
5596 a @emph{match view}, showings headlines based on the tags, properties and
5597 TODO state associated with them,
5598 @item
5599 a @emph{timeline view} that shows all events in a single Org file,
5600 in time-sorted view,
5601 @item
5602 a @emph{keyword search view} that shows all entries from multiple files
5603 that contain specified keywords.
5604 @item
5605 a @emph{stuck projects view} showing projects that currently don't move
5606 along, and
5607 @item
5608 @emph{custom views} that are special tag/keyword searches and
5609 combinations of different views.
5610 @end itemize
5611
5612 @noindent
5613 The extracted information is displayed in a special @emph{agenda
5614 buffer}. This buffer is read-only, but provides commands to visit the
5615 corresponding locations in the original Org files, and even to
5616 edit these files remotely.
5617
5618 Two variables control how the agenda buffer is displayed and whether the
5619 window configuration is restored when the agenda exits:
5620 @code{org-agenda-window-setup} and
5621 @code{org-agenda-restore-windows-after-quit}.
5622
5623 @menu
5624 * Agenda files:: Files being searched for agenda information
5625 * Agenda dispatcher:: Keyboard access to agenda views
5626 * Built-in agenda views:: What is available out of the box?
5627 * Presentation and sorting:: How agenda items are prepared for display
5628 * Agenda commands:: Remote editing of Org trees
5629 * Custom agenda views:: Defining special searches and views
5630 * Agenda column view:: Using column view for collected entries
5631 @end menu
5632
5633 @node Agenda files, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views, Agenda Views
5634 @section Agenda files
5635 @cindex agenda files
5636 @cindex files for agenda
5637
5638 The information to be shown is normally collected from all @emph{agenda
5639 files}, the files listed in the variable
5640 @code{org-agenda-files}@footnote{If the value of that variable is not a
5641 list, but a single file name, then the list of agenda files will be
5642 maintained in that external file.}. If a directory is part of this list,
5643 all files with the extension @file{.org} in this directory will be part
5644 of the list.
5645
5646 Thus even if you only work with a single Org file, this file should
5647 be put into that list@footnote{When using the dispatcher, pressing
5648 @kbd{<} before selecting a command will actually limit the command to
5649 the current file, and ignore @code{org-agenda-files} until the next
5650 dispatcher command.}. You can customize @code{org-agenda-files}, but
5651 the easiest way to maintain it is through the following commands
5652
5653 @cindex files, adding to agenda list
5654 @table @kbd
5655 @kindex C-c [
5656 @item C-c [
5657 Add current file to the list of agenda files. The file is added to
5658 the front of the list. If it was already in the list, it is moved to
5659 the front. With a prefix argument, file is added/moved to the end.
5660 @kindex C-c ]
5661 @item C-c ]
5662 Remove current file from the list of agenda files.
5663 @kindex C-,
5664 @kindex C-'
5665 @item C-,
5666 @itemx C-'
5667 Cycle through agenda file list, visiting one file after the other.
5668 @kindex M-x org-iswitchb
5669 @item M-x org-iswitchb
5670 Command to use an @code{iswitchb}-like interface to switch to and between Org
5671 buffers.
5672 @end table
5673
5674 @noindent
5675 The Org menu contains the current list of files and can be used
5676 to visit any of them.
5677
5678 If you would like to focus the agenda temporarily onto a file not in
5679 this list, or onto just one file in the list or even only a subtree in a
5680 file, this can be done in different ways. For a single agenda command,
5681 you may press @kbd{<} once or several times in the dispatcher
5682 (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}). To restrict the agenda scope for an
5683 extended period, use the following commands:
5684
5685 @table @kbd
5686 @kindex C-c C-x <
5687 @item C-c C-x <
5688 Permanently restrict the agenda to the current subtree. When with a
5689 prefix argument, or with the cursor before the first headline in a file,
5690 the agenda scope is set to the entire file. This restriction remains in
5691 effect until removed with @kbd{C-c C-x >}, or by typing either @kbd{<}
5692 or @kbd{>} in the agenda dispatcher. If there is a window displaying an
5693 agenda view, the new restriction takes effect immediately.
5694 @kindex C-c C-x >
5695 @item C-c C-x >
5696 Remove the permanent restriction created by @kbd{C-c C-x <}.
5697 @end table
5698
5699 @noindent
5700 When working with @file{Speedbar}, you can use the following commands in
5701 the Speedbar frame:
5702 @table @kbd
5703 @kindex <
5704 @item < @r{in the speedbar frame}
5705 Permanently restrict the agenda to the item at the cursor in the
5706 Speedbar frame, either an Org file or a subtree in such a file.
5707 If there is a window displaying an agenda view, the new restriction takes
5708 effect immediately.
5709 @kindex >
5710 @item > @r{in the speedbar frame}
5711 Lift the restriction again.
5712 @end table
5713
5714 @node Agenda dispatcher, Built-in agenda views, Agenda files, Agenda Views
5715 @section The agenda dispatcher
5716 @cindex agenda dispatcher
5717 @cindex dispatching agenda commands
5718 The views are created through a dispatcher that should be bound to a
5719 global key, for example @kbd{C-c a} (@pxref{Installation}). In the
5720 following we will assume that @kbd{C-c a} is indeed how the dispatcher
5721 is accessed and list keyboard access to commands accordingly. After
5722 pressing @kbd{C-c a}, an additional letter is required to execute a
5723 command. The dispatcher offers the following default commands:
5724 @table @kbd
5725 @item a
5726 Create the calendar-like agenda (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}).
5727 @item t @r{/} T
5728 Create a list of all TODO items (@pxref{Global TODO list}).
5729 @item m @r{/} M
5730 Create a list of headlines matching a TAGS expression (@pxref{Matching
5731 tags and properties}).
5732 @item L
5733 Create the timeline view for the current buffer (@pxref{Timeline}).
5734 @item s
5735 Create a list of entries selected by a boolean expression of keywords
5736 and/or regular expressions that must or must not occur in the entry.
5737 @item /
5738 Search for a regular expression in all agenda files and additionally in
5739 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-multi-occur-extra-files}. This
5740 uses the Emacs command @code{multi-occur}. A prefix argument can be
5741 used to specify the number of context lines for each match, default is
5742 1.
5743 @item # @r{/} !
5744 Create a list of stuck projects (@pxref{Stuck projects}).
5745 @item <
5746 Restrict an agenda command to the current buffer@footnote{For backward
5747 compatibility, you can also press @kbd{1} to restrict to the current
5748 buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{<}, you still need to press the character
5749 selecting the command.
5750 @item < <
5751 If there is an active region, restrict the following agenda command to
5752 the region. Otherwise, restrict it to the current subtree@footnote{For
5753 backward compatibility, you can also press @kbd{0} to restrict to the
5754 current buffer.}. After pressing @kbd{< <}, you still need to press the
5755 character selecting the command.
5756 @end table
5757
5758 You can also define custom commands that will be accessible through the
5759 dispatcher, just like the default commands. This includes the
5760 possibility to create extended agenda buffers that contain several
5761 blocks together, for example the weekly agenda, the global TODO list and
5762 a number of special tags matches. @xref{Custom agenda views}.
5763
5764 @node Built-in agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda dispatcher, Agenda Views
5765 @section The built-in agenda views
5766
5767 In this section we describe the built-in views.
5768
5769 @menu
5770 * Weekly/daily agenda:: The calendar page with current tasks
5771 * Global TODO list:: All unfinished action items
5772 * Matching tags and properties:: Structured information with fine-tuned search
5773 * Timeline:: Time-sorted view for single file
5774 * Keyword search:: Finding entries by keyword
5775 * Stuck projects:: Find projects you need to review
5776 @end menu
5777
5778 @node Weekly/daily agenda, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views, Built-in agenda views
5779 @subsection The weekly/daily agenda
5780 @cindex agenda
5781 @cindex weekly agenda
5782 @cindex daily agenda
5783
5784 The purpose of the weekly/daily @emph{agenda} is to act like a page of a
5785 paper agenda, showing all the tasks for the current week or day.
5786
5787 @table @kbd
5788 @cindex org-agenda, command
5789 @kindex C-c a a
5790 @item C-c a a
5791 Compile an agenda for the current week from a list of org files. The agenda
5792 shows the entries for each day. With a numeric prefix@footnote{For backward
5793 compatibility, the universal prefix @kbd{C-u} causes all TODO entries to be
5794 listed before the agenda. This feature is deprecated, use the dedicated TODO
5795 list, or a block agenda instead (@pxref{Block agenda}).} (like @kbd{C-u 2 1
5796 C-c a a}) you may set the number of days to be displayed (see also the
5797 variable @code{org-agenda-ndays})
5798 @end table
5799
5800 Remote editing from the agenda buffer means, for example, that you can
5801 change the dates of deadlines and appointments from the agenda buffer.
5802 The commands available in the Agenda buffer are listed in @ref{Agenda
5803 commands}.
5804
5805 @subsubheading Calendar/Diary integration
5806 @cindex calendar integration
5807 @cindex diary integration
5808
5809 Emacs contains the calendar and diary by Edward M. Reingold. The
5810 calendar displays a three-month calendar with holidays from different
5811 countries and cultures. The diary allows you to keep track of
5812 anniversaries, lunar phases, sunrise/set, recurrent appointments
5813 (weekly, monthly) and more. In this way, it is quite complementary to
5814 Org. It can be very useful to combine output from Org with
5815 the diary.
5816
5817 In order to include entries from the Emacs diary into Org mode's
5818 agenda, you only need to customize the variable
5819
5820 @lisp
5821 (setq org-agenda-include-diary t)
5822 @end lisp
5823
5824 @noindent After that, everything will happen automatically. All diary
5825 entries including holidays, anniversaries etc will be included in the
5826 agenda buffer created by Org mode. @key{SPC}, @key{TAB}, and
5827 @key{RET} can be used from the agenda buffer to jump to the diary
5828 file in order to edit existing diary entries. The @kbd{i} command to
5829 insert new entries for the current date works in the agenda buffer, as
5830 well as the commands @kbd{S}, @kbd{M}, and @kbd{C} to display
5831 Sunrise/Sunset times, show lunar phases and to convert to other
5832 calendars, respectively. @kbd{c} can be used to switch back and forth
5833 between calendar and agenda.
5834
5835 If you are using the diary only for sexp entries and holidays, it is
5836 faster to not use the above setting, but instead to copy or even move
5837 the entries into an Org file. Org mode evaluates diary-style sexp
5838 entries, and does it faster because there is no overhead for first
5839 creating the diary display. Note that the sexp entries must start at
5840 the left margin, no white space is allowed before them. For example,
5841 the following segment of an Org file will be processed and entries
5842 will be made in the agenda:
5843
5844 @example
5845 * Birthdays and similar stuff
5846 #+CATEGORY: Holiday
5847 %%(org-calendar-holiday) ; special function for holiday names
5848 #+CATEGORY: Ann
5849 %%(diary-anniversary 14 5 1956) Arthur Dent is %d years old
5850 %%(diary-anniversary 2 10 1869) Mahatma Gandhi would be %d years old
5851 @end example
5852
5853 @subsubheading Appointment reminders
5854 @cindex @file{appt.el}
5855 @cindex appointment reminders
5856
5857 Org can interact with Emacs appointments notification facility.
5858
5859 To add all the appointments of your agenda files, use the command
5860 @code{org-agenda-to-appt}. This commands also lets you filter through
5861 the list of your appointments and add only those belonging to a specific
5862 category or matching a regular expression. See the docstring for
5863 details.
5864
5865 @node Global TODO list, Matching tags and properties, Weekly/daily agenda, Built-in agenda views
5866 @subsection The global TODO list
5867 @cindex global TODO list
5868 @cindex TODO list, global
5869
5870 The global TODO list contains all unfinished TODO items, formatted and
5871 collected into a single place.
5872
5873 @table @kbd
5874 @kindex C-c a t
5875 @item C-c a t
5876 Show the global TODO list. This collects the TODO items from all
5877 agenda files (@pxref{Agenda Views}) into a single buffer. The buffer is in
5878 @code{agenda-mode}, so there are commands to examine and manipulate
5879 the TODO entries directly from that buffer (@pxref{Agenda commands}).
5880 @kindex C-c a T
5881 @item C-c a T
5882 @cindex TODO keyword matching
5883 Like the above, but allows selection of a specific TODO keyword. You
5884 can also do this by specifying a prefix argument to @kbd{C-c a t}. With
5885 a @kbd{C-u} prefix you are prompted for a keyword, and you may also
5886 specify several keywords by separating them with @samp{|} as boolean OR
5887 operator. With a numeric prefix, the Nth keyword in
5888 @code{org-todo-keywords} is selected.
5889 @kindex r
5890 The @kbd{r} key in the agenda buffer regenerates it, and you can give
5891 a prefix argument to this command to change the selected TODO keyword,
5892 for example @kbd{3 r}. If you often need a search for a specific
5893 keyword, define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).@*
5894 Matching specific TODO keywords can also be done as part of a tags
5895 search (@pxref{Tag searches}).
5896 @end table
5897
5898 Remote editing of TODO items means that you can change the state of a
5899 TODO entry with a single key press. The commands available in the
5900 TODO list are described in @ref{Agenda commands}.
5901
5902 @cindex sublevels, inclusion into TODO list
5903 Normally the global TODO list simply shows all headlines with TODO
5904 keywords. This list can become very long. There are two ways to keep
5905 it more compact:
5906 @itemize @minus
5907 @item
5908 Some people view a TODO item that has been @emph{scheduled} for
5909 execution (@pxref{Timestamps}) as no longer @emph{open}. Configure the
5910 variable @code{org-agenda-todo-ignore-scheduled} to exclude scheduled
5911 items from the global TODO list.
5912 @item
5913 TODO items may have sublevels to break up the task into subtasks. In
5914 such cases it may be enough to list only the highest level TODO headline
5915 and omit the sublevels from the global list. Configure the variable
5916 @code{org-agenda-todo-list-sublevels} to get this behavior.
5917 @end itemize
5918
5919 @node Matching tags and properties, Timeline, Global TODO list, Built-in agenda views
5920 @subsection Matching tags and properties
5921 @cindex matching, of tags
5922 @cindex matching, of properties
5923 @cindex tags view
5924 @cindex match view
5925
5926 If headlines in the agenda files are marked with @emph{tags}
5927 (@pxref{Tags}), you can select headlines based on the tags that apply
5928 to them and collect them into an agenda buffer.
5929
5930 @table @kbd
5931 @kindex C-c a m
5932 @item C-c a m
5933 Produce a list of all headlines that match a given set of tags. The
5934 command prompts for a selection criterion, which is a boolean logic
5935 expression with tags, like @samp{+work+urgent-withboss} or
5936 @samp{work|home} (@pxref{Tags}). If you often need a specific search,
5937 define a custom command for it (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}).
5938 @kindex C-c a M
5939 @item C-c a M
5940 Like @kbd{C-c a m}, but only select headlines that are also TODO items
5941 and force checking subitems (see variable
5942 @code{org-tags-match-list-sublevels}). Matching specific TODO keywords
5943 together with a tags match is also possible, see @ref{Tag searches}.
5944 @end table
5945
5946 The commands available in the tags list are described in @ref{Agenda
5947 commands}.
5948
5949 @node Timeline, Keyword search, Matching tags and properties, Built-in agenda views
5950 @subsection Timeline for a single file
5951 @cindex timeline, single file
5952 @cindex time-sorted view
5953
5954 The timeline summarizes all time-stamped items from a single Org mode
5955 file in a @emph{time-sorted view}. The main purpose of this command is
5956 to give an overview over events in a project.
5957
5958 @table @kbd
5959 @kindex C-c a L
5960 @item C-c a L
5961 Show a time-sorted view of the org file, with all time-stamped items.
5962 When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, all unfinished TODO entries
5963 (scheduled or not) are also listed under the current date.
5964 @end table
5965
5966 @noindent
5967 The commands available in the timeline buffer are listed in
5968 @ref{Agenda commands}.
5969
5970 @node Keyword search, Stuck projects, Timeline, Built-in agenda views
5971 @subsection Keyword search
5972 @cindex keyword search
5973 @cindex searching, for keywords
5974
5975 This agenda view is a general text search facility for Org mode entries.
5976 It is particularly useful to find notes.
5977
5978 @table @kbd
5979 @kindex C-c a s
5980 @item C-c a s
5981 This is a special search that lets you select entries by keywords or
5982 regular expression, using a boolean logic. For example, the search
5983 string
5984
5985 @example
5986 +computer +wifi -ethernet -@{8\.11[bg]@}
5987 @end example
5988
5989 @noindent
5990 will search for note entries that contain the keywords @code{computer}
5991 and @code{wifi}, but not the keyword @code{ethernet}, and which are also
5992 not matched by the regular expression @code{8\.11[bg]}, meaning to
5993 exclude both 8.11b and 8.11g.
5994
5995 Note that in addition to the agenda files, this command will also search
5996 the files listed in @code{org-agenda-text-search-extra-files}.
5997 @end table
5998
5999 @node Stuck projects, , Keyword search, Built-in agenda views
6000 @subsection Stuck projects
6001
6002 If you are following a system like David Allen's GTD to organize your
6003 work, one of the ``duties'' you have is a regular review to make sure
6004 that all projects move along. A @emph{stuck} project is a project that
6005 has no defined next actions, so it will never show up in the TODO lists
6006 Org mode produces. During the review, you need to identify such
6007 projects and define next actions for them.
6008
6009 @table @kbd
6010 @kindex C-c a #
6011 @item C-c a #
6012 List projects that are stuck.
6013 @kindex C-c a !
6014 @item C-c a !
6015 Customize the variable @code{org-stuck-projects} to define what a stuck
6016 project is and how to find it.
6017 @end table
6018
6019 You almost certainly will have to configure this view before it will
6020 work for you. The built-in default assumes that all your projects are
6021 level-2 headlines, and that a project is not stuck if it has at least
6022 one entry marked with a TODO keyword TODO or NEXT or NEXTACTION.
6023
6024 Let's assume that you, in your own way of using Org mode, identify
6025 projects with a tag PROJECT, and that you use a TODO keyword MAYBE to
6026 indicate a project that should not be considered yet. Let's further
6027 assume that the TODO keyword DONE marks finished projects, and that NEXT
6028 and TODO indicate next actions. The tag @@SHOP indicates shopping and
6029 is a next action even without the NEXT tag. Finally, if the project
6030 contains the special word IGNORE anywhere, it should not be listed
6031 either. In this case you would start by identifying eligible projects
6032 with a tags/todo match @samp{+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE}, and then check for
6033 TODO, NEXT, @@SHOP, and IGNORE in the subtree to identify projects that
6034 are not stuck. The correct customization for this is
6035
6036 @lisp
6037 (setq org-stuck-projects
6038 '("+PROJECT/-MAYBE-DONE" ("NEXT" "TODO") ("@@SHOP")
6039 "\\<IGNORE\\>"))
6040 @end lisp
6041
6042
6043 @node Presentation and sorting, Agenda commands, Built-in agenda views, Agenda Views
6044 @section Presentation and sorting
6045 @cindex presentation, of agenda items
6046
6047 Before displaying items in an agenda view, Org mode visually prepares
6048 the items and sorts them. Each item occupies a single line. The line
6049 starts with a @emph{prefix} that contains the @emph{category}
6050 (@pxref{Categories}) of the item and other important information. You can
6051 customize the prefix using the option @code{org-agenda-prefix-format}.
6052 The prefix is followed by a cleaned-up version of the outline headline
6053 associated with the item.
6054
6055 @menu
6056 * Categories:: Not all tasks are equal
6057 * Time-of-day specifications:: How the agenda knows the time
6058 * Sorting of agenda items:: The order of things
6059 @end menu
6060
6061 @node Categories, Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting, Presentation and sorting
6062 @subsection Categories
6063
6064 @cindex category
6065 The category is a broad label assigned to each agenda item. By default,
6066 the category is simply derived from the file name, but you can also
6067 specify it with a special line in the buffer, like this@footnote{For
6068 backward compatibility, the following also works: If there are several
6069 such lines in a file, each specifies the category for the text below it.
6070 The first category also applies to any text before the first CATEGORY
6071 line. However, using this method is @emph{strongly} deprecated as it is
6072 incompatible with the outline structure of the document. The correct
6073 method for setting multiple categories in a buffer is using a
6074 property.}:
6075
6076 @example
6077 #+CATEGORY: Thesis
6078 @end example
6079
6080 @noindent
6081 If you would like to have a special CATEGORY for a single entry or a
6082 (sub)tree, give the entry a @code{:CATEGORY:} property with the
6083 special category you want to apply as the value.
6084
6085 @noindent
6086 The display in the agenda buffer looks best if the category is not
6087 longer than 10 characters.
6088
6089 @node Time-of-day specifications, Sorting of agenda items, Categories, Presentation and sorting
6090 @subsection Time-of-day specifications
6091 @cindex time-of-day specification
6092
6093 Org mode checks each agenda item for a time-of-day specification. The
6094 time can be part of the time stamp that triggered inclusion into the
6095 agenda, for example as in @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 19:00>}}. Time
6096 ranges can be specified with two time stamps, like
6097 @c
6098 @w{@samp{<2005-05-10 Tue 20:30>--<2005-05-10 Tue 22:15>}}.
6099
6100 In the headline of the entry itself, a time(range) may also appear as
6101 plain text (like @samp{12:45} or a @samp{8:30-1pm}). If the agenda
6102 integrates the Emacs diary (@pxref{Weekly/daily agenda}), time
6103 specifications in diary entries are recognized as well.
6104
6105 For agenda display, Org mode extracts the time and displays it in a
6106 standard 24 hour format as part of the prefix. The example times in
6107 the previous paragraphs would end up in the agenda like this:
6108
6109 @example
6110 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
6111 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
6112 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
6113 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
6114 @end example
6115
6116 @cindex time grid
6117 If the agenda is in single-day mode, or for the display of today, the
6118 timed entries are embedded in a time grid, like
6119
6120 @example
6121 8:00...... ------------------
6122 8:30-13:00 Arthur Dent lies in front of the bulldozer
6123 10:00...... ------------------
6124 12:00...... ------------------
6125 12:45...... Ford Prefect arrives and takes Arthur to the pub
6126 14:00...... ------------------
6127 16:00...... ------------------
6128 18:00...... ------------------
6129 19:00...... The Vogon reads his poem
6130 20:00...... ------------------
6131 20:30-22:15 Marvin escorts the Hitchhikers to the bridge
6132 @end example
6133
6134 The time grid can be turned on and off with the variable
6135 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid}, and can be configured with
6136 @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
6137
6138 @node Sorting of agenda items, , Time-of-day specifications, Presentation and sorting
6139 @subsection Sorting of agenda items
6140 @cindex sorting, of agenda items
6141 @cindex priorities, of agenda items
6142 Before being inserted into a view, the items are sorted. How this is
6143 done depends on the type of view.
6144 @itemize @bullet
6145 @item
6146 For the daily/weekly agenda, the items for each day are sorted. The
6147 default order is to first collect all items containing an explicit
6148 time-of-day specification. These entries will be shown at the beginning
6149 of the list, as a @emph{schedule} for the day. After that, items remain
6150 grouped in categories, in the sequence given by @code{org-agenda-files}.
6151 Within each category, items are sorted by priority (@pxref{Priorities}),
6152 which is composed of the base priority (2000 for priority @samp{A}, 1000
6153 for @samp{B}, and 0 for @samp{C}), plus additional increments for
6154 overdue scheduled or deadline items.
6155 @item
6156 For the TODO list, items remain in the order of categories, but within
6157 each category, sorting takes place according to priority
6158 (@pxref{Priorities}).
6159 @item
6160 For tags matches, items are not sorted at all, but just appear in the
6161 sequence in which they are found in the agenda files.
6162 @end itemize
6163
6164 Sorting can be customized using the variable
6165 @code{org-agenda-sorting-strategy}, and may also include criteria based on
6166 the estimated effort of an entry (@pxref{Effort estimates}).
6167
6168 @node Agenda commands, Custom agenda views, Presentation and sorting, Agenda Views
6169 @section Commands in the agenda buffer
6170 @cindex commands, in agenda buffer
6171
6172 Entries in the agenda buffer are linked back to the org file or diary
6173 file where they originate. You are not allowed to edit the agenda
6174 buffer itself, but commands are provided to show and jump to the
6175 original entry location, and to edit the org-files ``remotely'' from
6176 the agenda buffer. In this way, all information is stored only once,
6177 removing the risk that your agenda and note files may diverge.
6178
6179 Some commands can be executed with mouse clicks on agenda lines. For
6180 the other commands, the cursor needs to be in the desired line.
6181
6182 @table @kbd
6183 @tsubheading{Motion}
6184 @cindex motion commands in agenda
6185 @kindex n
6186 @item n
6187 Next line (same as @key{up} and @kbd{C-p}).
6188 @kindex p
6189 @item p
6190 Previous line (same as @key{down} and @kbd{C-n}).
6191 @tsubheading{View/Go to org file}
6192 @kindex mouse-3
6193 @kindex @key{SPC}
6194 @item mouse-3
6195 @itemx @key{SPC}
6196 Display the original location of the item in another window.
6197 With prefix arg, make sure that the entire entry is made visible in the
6198 outline, not only the heading.
6199 @c
6200 @kindex L
6201 @item L
6202 Display original location and recenter that window.
6203 @c
6204 @kindex mouse-2
6205 @kindex mouse-1
6206 @kindex @key{TAB}
6207 @item mouse-2
6208 @itemx mouse-1
6209 @itemx @key{TAB}
6210 Go to the original location of the item in another window. Under Emacs
6211 22, @kbd{mouse-1} will also works for this.
6212 @c
6213 @kindex @key{RET}
6214 @itemx @key{RET}
6215 Go to the original location of the item and delete other windows.
6216 @c
6217 @kindex f
6218 @item f
6219 Toggle Follow mode. In Follow mode, as you move the cursor through
6220 the agenda buffer, the other window always shows the corresponding
6221 location in the org file. The initial setting for this mode in new
6222 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
6223 @code{org-agenda-start-with-follow-mode}.
6224 @c
6225 @kindex b
6226 @item b
6227 Display the entire subtree of the current item in an indirect buffer. With a
6228 numeric prefix argument N, go up to level N and then take that tree. If N is
6229 negative, go up that many levels. With a @kbd{C-u} prefix, do not remove the
6230 previously used indirect buffer.
6231 @c
6232 @kindex l
6233 @item l
6234 Toggle Logbook mode. In Logbook mode, entries that were marked DONE while
6235 logging was on (variable @code{org-log-done}) are shown in the agenda, as are
6236 entries that have been clocked on that day. You can configure the entry
6237 types that should be included in log mode using the variable
6238 @code{org-agenda-log-mode-items}. When called with a @kbd{C-u} prefix, show
6239 all possible logbook entries, including state changes. When called with two
6240 prefix args @kbd{C-u C-u}, show only logging information, nothing else.
6241 @c
6242 @kindex v
6243 @item v
6244 Toggle Archives mode. In archives mode, trees that are marked
6245 @code{ARCHIVED} are also scanned when producing the agenda. When you call
6246 this command with a @kbd{C-u} prefix argument, even all archive files are
6247 included. To exit archives mode, press @kbd{v} again.
6248 @c
6249 @kindex R
6250 @item R
6251 Toggle Clockreport mode. In clockreport mode, the daily/weekly agenda will
6252 always show a table with the clocked times for the timespan and file scope
6253 covered by the current agenda view. The initial setting for this mode in new
6254 agenda buffers can be set with the variable
6255 @code{org-agenda-start-with-clockreport-mode}.
6256
6257 @tsubheading{Change display}
6258 @cindex display changing, in agenda
6259 @kindex o
6260 @item o
6261 Delete other windows.
6262 @c
6263 @kindex d
6264 @kindex w
6265 @kindex m
6266 @kindex y
6267 @item d w m y
6268 Switch to day/week/month/year view. When switching to day or week view,
6269 this setting becomes the default for subsequent agenda commands. Since
6270 month and year views are slow to create, they do not become the default.
6271 A numeric prefix argument may be used to jump directly to a specific day
6272 of the year, ISO week, month, or year, respectively. For example,
6273 @kbd{32 d} jumps to February 1st, @kbd{9 w} to ISO week number 9. When
6274 setting day, week, or month view, a year may be encoded in the prefix
6275 argument as well. For example, @kbd{200712 w} will jump to week 12 in
6276 2007. If such a year specification has only one or two digits, it will
6277 be mapped to the interval 1938-2037.
6278 @c
6279 @kindex D
6280 @item D
6281 Toggle the inclusion of diary entries. See @ref{Weekly/daily agenda}.
6282 @c
6283 @kindex G
6284 @item G
6285 Toggle the time grid on and off. See also the variables
6286 @code{org-agenda-use-time-grid} and @code{org-agenda-time-grid}.
6287 @c
6288 @kindex r
6289 @item r
6290 Recreate the agenda buffer, for example to reflect the changes
6291 after modification of the time stamps of items with S-@key{left} and
6292 S-@key{right}. When the buffer is the global TODO list, a prefix
6293 argument is interpreted to create a selective list for a specific TODO
6294 keyword.
6295 @kindex g
6296 @item g
6297 Same as @kbd{r}.
6298 @c
6299 @kindex s
6300 @kindex C-x C-s
6301 @item s
6302 @itemx C-x C-s
6303 Save all Org buffers in the current Emacs session.
6304 @c
6305 @kindex @key{right}
6306 @item @key{right}
6307 Display the following @code{org-agenda-ndays} days. For example, if
6308 the display covers a week, switch to the following week. With prefix
6309 arg, go forward that many times @code{org-agenda-ndays} days.
6310 @c
6311 @kindex @key{left}
6312 @item @key{left}
6313 Display the previous dates.
6314 @c
6315 @kindex .
6316 @item .
6317 Go to today.
6318 @c
6319 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
6320 @item C-c C-x C-c
6321 Invoke column view (@pxref{Column view}) in the agenda buffer. The column
6322 view format is taken from the entry at point, or (if there is no entry at
6323 point), from the first entry in the agenda view. So whatever the format for
6324 that entry would be in the original buffer (taken from a property, from a
6325 @code{#+COLUMNS} line, or from the default variable
6326 @code{org-columns-default-format}), will be used in the agenda.
6327
6328 @tsubheading{Secondary filtering and query editing}
6329 @cindex filtering, by tag and effort, in agenda
6330 @cindex tag filtering, in agenda
6331 @cindex effort filtering, in agenda
6332 @cindex query editing, in agenda
6333
6334 @kindex /
6335 @item /
6336 Filter the current agenda view with respect to a tag and/or effort estimates.
6337 The difference between this and a custom agenda commands is that filtering is
6338 very fast, so that you can switch quickly between different filters without
6339 having to recreate the agenda.
6340
6341 You will be prompted for a tag selection letter. Pressing @key{TAB} at that
6342 prompt will offer use completion to select a tag (including any tags that do
6343 not have a selection character). The command then hides all entries that do
6344 not contain or inherit this tag. When called with prefix arg, remove the
6345 entries that @emph{do} have the tag. A second @kbd{/} at the prompt will
6346 turn off the filter and unhide any hidden entries. If the first key you
6347 press is either @kbd{+} or @kbd{-}, the previous filter will be narrowed by
6348 requiring or forbidding the selected additional tag. Instead of pressing
6349 @kbd{+} or @kbd{-} after @kbd{/}, you can also immediately use the @kbd{\}
6350 command.
6351
6352 In order to filter for effort estimates, you should set-up allowed
6353 efforts globally, for example
6354 @lisp
6355 (setq org-global-properties
6356 '(("Effort_ALL". "0 0:10 0:30 1:00 2:00 3:00 4:00")))
6357 @end lisp
6358 You can then filter for an effort by first typing an operator, one of @kbd{<},
6359 @kbd{>}, and @kbd{=}, and then the one-digit index of an effort estimate in
6360 your array of allowed values, where @kbd{0} means the 10th value. The filter
6361 will then restrict to entries with effort smaller-or-equal, equal, or
6362 larger-or-equal than the selected value. If the digits 0-9 are not used as
6363 fast access keys to tags, you can also simply press the index digit directly
6364 without an operator. In this case, @kbd{<} will be assumed.
6365
6366 @kindex \
6367 @item \
6368 Narrow the current agenda filter by an additional condition. When called with
6369 prefix arg, remove the entries that @emph{do} have the tag, or that do match
6370 the effort criterion. You can achieve the same effect by pressing @kbd{+} or
6371 @kbd{-} as the first key after the @kbd{/} command.
6372
6373 @kindex [
6374 @kindex ]
6375 @kindex @{
6376 @kindex @}
6377 @item [ ] @{ @}
6378 In the @i{search view} (@pxref{Keyword search}), these keys add new search
6379 words (@kbd{[} and @kbd{]}) or new regular expressions (@kbd{@{} and
6380 @kbd{@}}) to the query string. The opening bracket/brace will add a positive
6381 search term prefixed by @samp{+}, indicating that this search term @i{must}
6382 occur/match in the entry. The closing bracket/brace will add a negative
6383 search term which @i{must not} occur/match in the entry for it to be
6384 selected.
6385
6386
6387 @tsubheading{Remote editing}
6388 @cindex remote editing, from agenda
6389
6390 @item 0-9
6391 Digit argument.
6392 @c
6393 @cindex undoing remote-editing events
6394 @cindex remote editing, undo
6395 @kindex C-_
6396 @item C-_
6397 Undo a change due to a remote editing command. The change is undone
6398 both in the agenda buffer and in the remote buffer.
6399 @c
6400 @kindex t
6401 @item t
6402 Change the TODO state of the item, both in the agenda and in the
6403 original org file.
6404 @c
6405 @kindex C-k
6406 @item C-k
6407 Delete the current agenda item along with the entire subtree belonging
6408 to it in the original Org file. If the text to be deleted remotely
6409 is longer than one line, the kill needs to be confirmed by the user. See
6410 variable @code{org-agenda-confirm-kill}.
6411 @c
6412 @kindex a
6413 @item a
6414 Toggle the ARCHIVE tag for the current headline.
6415 @c
6416 @kindex A
6417 @item A
6418 Move the subtree corresponding to the current entry to its @emph{Archive
6419 Sibling}.
6420 @c
6421 @kindex $
6422 @item $
6423 Archive the subtree corresponding to the current headline. This means the
6424 entry will be moved to the configured archive location, most likely a
6425 different file.
6426 @c
6427 @kindex T
6428 @item T
6429 Show all tags associated with the current item. This is useful if you have
6430 turned off @code{org-agenda-show-inherited-tags}, but still want to see all
6431 tags of a headline occasionally.
6432 @c
6433 @kindex :
6434 @item :
6435 Set tags for the current headline. If there is an active region in the
6436 agenda, change a tag for all headings in the region.
6437 @c
6438 @kindex ,
6439 @item ,
6440 Set the priority for the current item. Org mode prompts for the
6441 priority character. If you reply with @key{SPC}, the priority cookie
6442 is removed from the entry.
6443 @c
6444 @kindex P
6445 @item P
6446 Display weighted priority of current item.
6447 @c
6448 @kindex +
6449 @kindex S-@key{up}
6450 @item +
6451 @itemx S-@key{up}
6452 Increase the priority of the current item. The priority is changed in
6453 the original buffer, but the agenda is not resorted. Use the @kbd{r}
6454 key for this.
6455 @c
6456 @kindex -
6457 @kindex S-@key{down}
6458 @item -
6459 @itemx S-@key{down}
6460 Decrease the priority of the current item.
6461 @c
6462 @kindex C-c C-a
6463 @item C-c C-a
6464 Dispatcher for all command related to attachments.
6465 @c
6466 @kindex C-c C-s
6467 @item C-c C-s
6468 Schedule this item
6469 @c
6470 @kindex C-c C-d
6471 @item C-c C-d
6472 Set a deadline for this item.
6473 @c
6474 @kindex k
6475 @item k
6476 Agenda actions, to set dates for selected items to the cursor date.
6477 This command also works in the calendar! The command prompts for an
6478 additional key:
6479 @example
6480 m @r{Mark the entry at point for action. You can also make entries}
6481 @r{in Org files with @kbd{C-c C-x C-k}.}
6482 d @r{Set the deadline of the marked entry to the date at point.}
6483 s @r{Schedule the marked entry at the date at point.}
6484 r @r{Call @code{org-remember} with the cursor date as default date.}
6485 @end example
6486 Press @kbd{r} afterward to refresh the agenda and see the effect of the
6487 command.
6488 @c
6489 @kindex S-@key{right}
6490 @item S-@key{right}
6491 Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day into the
6492 future. With a numeric prefix argument, change it by that many days. For
6493 example, @kbd{3 6 5 S-@key{right}} will change it by a year. The stamp is
6494 changed in the original org file, but the change is not directly reflected in
6495 the agenda buffer. Use the @kbd{r} key to update the buffer.
6496 @c
6497 @kindex S-@key{left}
6498 @item S-@key{left}
6499 Change the time stamp associated with the current line by one day
6500 into the past.
6501 @c
6502 @kindex >
6503 @item >
6504 Change the time stamp associated with the current line to today.
6505 The key @kbd{>} has been chosen, because it is the same as @kbd{S-.}
6506 on my keyboard.
6507 @c
6508 @kindex I
6509 @item I
6510 Start the clock on the current item. If a clock is running already, it
6511 is stopped first.
6512 @c
6513 @kindex O
6514 @item O
6515 Stop the previously started clock.
6516 @c
6517 @kindex X
6518 @item X
6519 Cancel the currently running clock.
6520
6521 @kindex J
6522 @item J
6523 Jump to the running clock in another window.
6524
6525 @tsubheading{Calendar commands}
6526 @cindex calendar commands, from agenda
6527 @kindex c
6528 @item c
6529 Open the Emacs calendar and move to the date at the agenda cursor.
6530 @c
6531 @item c
6532 When in the calendar, compute and show the Org mode agenda for the
6533 date at the cursor.
6534 @c
6535 @cindex diary entries, creating from agenda
6536 @kindex i
6537 @item i
6538 Insert a new entry into the diary. Prompts for the type of entry
6539 (day, weekly, monthly, yearly, anniversary, cyclic) and creates a new
6540 entry in the diary, just as @kbd{i d} etc. would do in the calendar.
6541 The date is taken from the cursor position.
6542 @c
6543 @kindex M
6544 @item M
6545 Show the phases of the moon for the three months around current date.
6546 @c
6547 @kindex S
6548 @item S
6549 Show sunrise and sunset times. The geographical location must be set
6550 with calendar variables, see documentation of the Emacs calendar.
6551 @c
6552 @kindex C
6553 @item C
6554 Convert the date at cursor into many other cultural and historic
6555 calendars.
6556 @c
6557 @kindex H
6558 @item H
6559 Show holidays for three month around the cursor date.
6560
6561 @item M-x org-export-icalendar-combine-agenda-files
6562 Export a single iCalendar file containing entries from all agenda files.
6563 This is a globally available command, and also available in the agenda menu.
6564
6565 @tsubheading{Exporting to a file}
6566 @kindex C-x C-w
6567 @item C-x C-w
6568 @cindex exporting agenda views
6569 @cindex agenda views, exporting
6570 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the
6571 selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension
6572 @file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}), or
6573 plain text (any other extension). Use the variable
6574 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to set options for @file{ps-print}
6575 and for @file{htmlize} to be used during export.
6576
6577 @tsubheading{Quit and Exit}
6578 @kindex q
6579 @item q
6580 Quit agenda, remove the agenda buffer.
6581 @c
6582 @kindex x
6583 @cindex agenda files, removing buffers
6584 @item x
6585 Exit agenda, remove the agenda buffer and all buffers loaded by Emacs
6586 for the compilation of the agenda. Buffers created by the user to
6587 visit org files will not be removed.
6588 @end table
6589
6590
6591 @node Custom agenda views, Agenda column view, Agenda commands, Agenda Views
6592 @section Custom agenda views
6593 @cindex custom agenda views
6594 @cindex agenda views, custom
6595
6596 Custom agenda commands serve two purposes: to store and quickly access
6597 frequently used TODO and tags searches, and to create special composite
6598 agenda buffers. Custom agenda commands will be accessible through the
6599 dispatcher (@pxref{Agenda dispatcher}), just like the default commands.
6600
6601 @menu
6602 * Storing searches:: Type once, use often
6603 * Block agenda:: All the stuff you need in a single buffer
6604 * Setting Options:: Changing the rules
6605 * Exporting Agenda Views:: Writing agendas to files
6606 * Using the agenda elsewhere:: Using agenda information in other programs
6607 @end menu
6608
6609 @node Storing searches, Block agenda, Custom agenda views, Custom agenda views
6610 @subsection Storing searches
6611
6612 The first application of custom searches is the definition of keyboard
6613 shortcuts for frequently used searches, either creating an agenda
6614 buffer, or a sparse tree (the latter covering of course only the current
6615 buffer).
6616 @kindex C-c a C
6617 Custom commands are configured in the variable
6618 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. You can customize this variable, for
6619 example by pressing @kbd{C-c a C}. You can also directly set it with
6620 Emacs Lisp in @file{.emacs}. The following example contains all valid
6621 search types:
6622
6623 @lisp
6624 @group
6625 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6626 '(("w" todo "WAITING")
6627 ("W" todo-tree "WAITING")
6628 ("u" tags "+boss-urgent")
6629 ("v" tags-todo "+boss-urgent")
6630 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent")
6631 ("f" occur-tree "\\<FIXME\\>")
6632 ("h" . "HOME+Name tags searches") ; description for "h" prefix
6633 ("hl" tags "+home+Lisa")
6634 ("hp" tags "+home+Peter")
6635 ("hk" tags "+home+Kim")))
6636 @end group
6637 @end lisp
6638
6639 @noindent
6640 The initial string in each entry defines the keys you have to press
6641 after the dispatcher command @kbd{C-c a} in order to access the command.
6642 Usually this will be just a single character, but if you have many
6643 similar commands, you can also define two-letter combinations where the
6644 first character is the same in several combinations and serves as a
6645 prefix key@footnote{You can provide a description for a prefix key by
6646 inserting a cons cell with the prefix and the description.}. The second
6647 parameter is the search type, followed by the string or regular
6648 expression to be used for the matching. The example above will
6649 therefore define:
6650
6651 @table @kbd
6652 @item C-c a w
6653 as a global search for TODO entries with @samp{WAITING} as the TODO
6654 keyword
6655 @item C-c a W
6656 as the same search, but only in the current buffer and displaying the
6657 results as a sparse tree
6658 @item C-c a u
6659 as a global tags search for headlines marked @samp{:boss:} but not
6660 @samp{:urgent:}
6661 @item C-c a v
6662 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but limiting the search to
6663 headlines that are also TODO items
6664 @item C-c a U
6665 as the same search as @kbd{C-c a u}, but only in the current buffer and
6666 displaying the result as a sparse tree
6667 @item C-c a f
6668 to create a sparse tree (again: current buffer only) with all entries
6669 containing the word @samp{FIXME}
6670 @item C-c a h
6671 as a prefix command for a HOME tags search where you have to press an
6672 additional key (@kbd{l}, @kbd{p} or @kbd{k}) to select a name (Lisa,
6673 Peter, or Kim) as additional tag to match.
6674 @end table
6675
6676 @node Block agenda, Setting Options, Storing searches, Custom agenda views
6677 @subsection Block agenda
6678 @cindex block agenda
6679 @cindex agenda, with block views
6680
6681 Another possibility is the construction of agenda views that comprise
6682 the results of @emph{several} commands, each of which creates a block in
6683 the agenda buffer. The available commands include @code{agenda} for the
6684 daily or weekly agenda (as created with @kbd{C-c a a}), @code{alltodo}
6685 for the global TODO list (as constructed with @kbd{C-c a t}), and the
6686 matching commands discussed above: @code{todo}, @code{tags}, and
6687 @code{tags-todo}. Here are two examples:
6688
6689 @lisp
6690 @group
6691 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6692 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
6693 ((agenda "")
6694 (tags-todo "home")
6695 (tags "garden")))
6696 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
6697 ((agenda "")
6698 (tags-todo "work")
6699 (tags "office")))))
6700 @end group
6701 @end lisp
6702
6703 @noindent
6704 This will define @kbd{C-c a h} to create a multi-block view for stuff
6705 you need to attend to at home. The resulting agenda buffer will contain
6706 your agenda for the current week, all TODO items that carry the tag
6707 @samp{home}, and also all lines tagged with @samp{garden}. Finally the
6708 command @kbd{C-c a o} provides a similar view for office tasks.
6709
6710 @node Setting Options, Exporting Agenda Views, Block agenda, Custom agenda views
6711 @subsection Setting options for custom commands
6712 @cindex options, for custom agenda views
6713
6714 Org mode contains a number of variables regulating agenda construction
6715 and display. The global variables define the behavior for all agenda
6716 commands, including the custom commands. However, if you want to change
6717 some settings just for a single custom view, you can do so. Setting
6718 options requires inserting a list of variable names and values at the
6719 right spot in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}. For example:
6720
6721 @lisp
6722 @group
6723 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6724 '(("w" todo "WAITING"
6725 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))
6726 (org-agenda-prefix-format " Mixed: ")))
6727 ("U" tags-tree "+boss-urgent"
6728 ((org-show-following-heading nil)
6729 (org-show-hierarchy-above nil)))
6730 ("N" search ""
6731 ((org-agenda-files '("~org/notes.org"))
6732 (org-agenda-text-search-extra-files nil)))))
6733 @end group
6734 @end lisp
6735
6736 @noindent
6737 Now the @kbd{C-c a w} command will sort the collected entries only by
6738 priority, and the prefix format is modified to just say @samp{ Mixed: }
6739 instead of giving the category of the entry. The sparse tags tree of
6740 @kbd{C-c a U} will now turn out ultra-compact, because neither the
6741 headline hierarchy above the match, nor the headline following the match
6742 will be shown. The command @kbd{C-c a N} will do a text search limited
6743 to only a single file.
6744
6745 For command sets creating a block agenda,
6746 @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} has two separate spots for setting
6747 options. You can add options that should be valid for just a single
6748 command in the set, and options that should be valid for all commands in
6749 the set. The former are just added to the command entry, the latter
6750 must come after the list of command entries. Going back to the block
6751 agenda example (@pxref{Block agenda}), let's change the sorting strategy
6752 for the @kbd{C-c a h} commands to @code{priority-down}, but let's sort
6753 the results for GARDEN tags query in the opposite order,
6754 @code{priority-up}. This would look like this:
6755
6756 @lisp
6757 @group
6758 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6759 '(("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
6760 ((agenda)
6761 (tags-todo "home")
6762 (tags "garden"
6763 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-up)))))
6764 ((org-agenda-sorting-strategy '(priority-down))))
6765 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
6766 ((agenda)
6767 (tags-todo "work")
6768 (tags "office")))))
6769 @end group
6770 @end lisp
6771
6772 As you see, the values and parenthesis setting is a little complex.
6773 When in doubt, use the customize interface to set this variable - it
6774 fully supports its structure. Just one caveat: When setting options in
6775 this interface, the @emph{values} are just lisp expressions. So if the
6776 value is a string, you need to add the double quotes around the value
6777 yourself.
6778
6779
6780 @node Exporting Agenda Views, Using the agenda elsewhere, Setting Options, Custom agenda views
6781 @subsection Exporting Agenda Views
6782 @cindex agenda views, exporting
6783
6784 If you are away from your computer, it can be very useful to have a printed
6785 version of some agenda views to carry around. Org mode can export custom
6786 agenda views as plain text, HTML@footnote{You need to install Hrvoje Niksic's
6787 @file{htmlize.el}.}, Postscript, and iCalendar files. If you want to do this
6788 only occasionally, use the command
6789
6790 @table @kbd
6791 @kindex C-x C-w
6792 @item C-x C-w
6793 @cindex exporting agenda views
6794 @cindex agenda views, exporting
6795 Write the agenda view to a file. Depending on the extension of the
6796 selected file name, the view will be exported as HTML (extension
6797 @file{.html} or @file{.htm}), Postscript (extension @file{.ps}),
6798 iCalendar (extension @file{.ics}), or plain text (any other extension).
6799 Use the variable @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} to
6800 set options for @file{ps-print} and for @file{htmlize} to be used during
6801 export, for example
6802
6803 @lisp
6804 (setq org-agenda-exporter-settings
6805 '((ps-number-of-columns 2)
6806 (ps-landscape-mode t)
6807 (htmlize-output-type 'css)))
6808 @end lisp
6809 @end table
6810
6811 If you need to export certain agenda views frequently, you can associate
6812 any custom agenda command with a list of output file names
6813 @footnote{If you want to store standard views like the weekly agenda
6814 or the global TODO list as well, you need to define custom commands for
6815 them in order to be able to specify file names.}. Here is an example
6816 that first does define custom commands for the agenda and the global
6817 todo list, together with a number of files to which to export them.
6818 Then we define two block agenda commands and specify file names for them
6819 as well. File names can be relative to the current working directory,
6820 or absolute.
6821
6822 @lisp
6823 @group
6824 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6825 '(("X" agenda "" nil ("agenda.html" "agenda.ps"))
6826 ("Y" alltodo "" nil ("todo.html" "todo.txt" "todo.ps"))
6827 ("h" "Agenda and Home-related tasks"
6828 ((agenda "")
6829 (tags-todo "home")
6830 (tags "garden"))
6831 nil
6832 ("~/views/home.html"))
6833 ("o" "Agenda and Office-related tasks"
6834 ((agenda)
6835 (tags-todo "work")
6836 (tags "office"))
6837 nil
6838 ("~/views/office.ps" "~/calendars/office.ics"))))
6839 @end group
6840 @end lisp
6841
6842 The extension of the file name determines the type of export. If it is
6843 @file{.html}, Org mode will use the @file{htmlize.el} package to convert
6844 the buffer to HTML and save it to this file name. If the extension is
6845 @file{.ps}, @code{ps-print-buffer-with-faces} is used to produce
6846 postscript output. If the extension is @file{.ics}, iCalendar export is
6847 run export over all files that were used to construct the agenda, and
6848 limit the export to entries listed in the agenda now. Any other
6849 extension produces a plain ASCII file.
6850
6851 The export files are @emph{not} created when you use one of those
6852 commands interactively because this might use too much overhead.
6853 Instead, there is a special command to produce @emph{all} specified
6854 files in one step:
6855
6856 @table @kbd
6857 @kindex C-c a e
6858 @item C-c a e
6859 Export all agenda views that have export file names associated with
6860 them.
6861 @end table
6862
6863 You can use the options section of the custom agenda commands to also
6864 set options for the export commands. For example:
6865
6866 @lisp
6867 (setq org-agenda-custom-commands
6868 '(("X" agenda ""
6869 ((ps-number-of-columns 2)
6870 (ps-landscape-mode t)
6871 (org-agenda-prefix-format " [ ] ")
6872 (org-agenda-with-colors nil)
6873 (org-agenda-remove-tags t))
6874 ("theagenda.ps"))))
6875 @end lisp
6876
6877 @noindent
6878 This command sets two options for the postscript exporter, to make it
6879 print in two columns in landscape format - the resulting page can be cut
6880 in two and then used in a paper agenda. The remaining settings modify
6881 the agenda prefix to omit category and scheduling information, and
6882 instead include a checkbox to check off items. We also remove the tags
6883 to make the lines compact, and we don't want to use colors for the
6884 black-and-white printer. Settings specified in
6885 @code{org-agenda-exporter-settings} will also apply, but the settings
6886 in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands} take precedence.
6887
6888 @noindent
6889 From the command line you may also use
6890 @example
6891 emacs -f org-batch-store-agenda-views -kill
6892 @end example
6893 @noindent
6894 or, if you need to modify some parameters@footnote{Quoting may depend on the
6895 system you use, please check th FAQ for examples.}
6896 @example
6897 emacs -eval '(org-batch-store-agenda-views \
6898 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
6899 org-agenda-start-day "2007-11-01" \
6900 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
6901 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
6902 -kill
6903 @end example
6904 @noindent
6905 which will create the agenda views restricted to the file
6906 @file{~/org/project.org}, without diary entries and with 30 days
6907 extent.
6908
6909 @node Using the agenda elsewhere, , Exporting Agenda Views, Custom agenda views
6910 @subsection Using agenda information outside of Org
6911 @cindex agenda, pipe
6912 @cindex Scripts, for agenda processing
6913
6914 Org provides commands to access agenda information for the command
6915 line in emacs batch mode. This extracted information can be sent
6916 directly to a printer, or it can be read by a program that does further
6917 processing of the data. The first of these commands is the function
6918 @code{org-batch-agenda}, that produces an agenda view and sends it as
6919 ASCII text to STDOUT. The command takes a single string as parameter.
6920 If the string has length 1, it is used as a key to one of the commands
6921 you have configured in @code{org-agenda-custom-commands}, basically any
6922 key you can use after @kbd{C-c a}. For example, to directly print the
6923 current TODO list, you could use
6924
6925 @example
6926 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda "t")' | lpr
6927 @end example
6928
6929 If the parameter is a string with 2 or more characters, it is used as a
6930 tags/todo match string. For example, to print your local shopping list
6931 (all items with the tag @samp{shop}, but excluding the tag
6932 @samp{NewYork}), you could use
6933
6934 @example
6935 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
6936 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "+shop-NewYork")' | lpr
6937 @end example
6938
6939 @noindent
6940 You may also modify parameters on the fly like this:
6941
6942 @example
6943 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs \
6944 -eval '(org-batch-agenda "a" \
6945 org-agenda-ndays 30 \
6946 org-agenda-include-diary nil \
6947 org-agenda-files (quote ("~/org/project.org")))' \
6948 | lpr
6949 @end example
6950
6951 @noindent
6952 which will produce a 30 day agenda, fully restricted to the Org file
6953 @file{~/org/projects.org}, not even including the diary.
6954
6955 If you want to process the agenda data in more sophisticated ways, you
6956 can use the command @code{org-batch-agenda-csv} to get a comma-separated
6957 list of values for each agenda item. Each line in the output will
6958 contain a number of fields separated by commas. The fields in a line
6959 are:
6960
6961 @example
6962 category @r{The category of the item}
6963 head @r{The headline, without TODO kwd, TAGS and PRIORITY}
6964 type @r{The type of the agenda entry, can be}
6965 todo @r{selected in TODO match}
6966 tagsmatch @r{selected in tags match}
6967 diary @r{imported from diary}
6968 deadline @r{a deadline}
6969 scheduled @r{scheduled}
6970 timestamp @r{appointment, selected by timestamp}
6971 closed @r{entry was closed on date}
6972 upcoming-deadline @r{warning about nearing deadline}
6973 past-scheduled @r{forwarded scheduled item}
6974 block @r{entry has date block including date}
6975 todo @r{The TODO keyword, if any}
6976 tags @r{All tags including inherited ones, separated by colons}
6977 date @r{The relevant date, like 2007-2-14}
6978 time @r{The time, like 15:00-16:50}
6979 extra @r{String with extra planning info}
6980 priority-l @r{The priority letter if any was given}
6981 priority-n @r{The computed numerical priority}
6982 @end example
6983
6984 @noindent
6985 Time and date will only be given if a timestamp (or deadline/scheduled)
6986 lead to the selection of the item.
6987
6988 A CSV list like this is very easy to use in a post processing script.
6989 For example, here is a Perl program that gets the TODO list from
6990 Emacs/Org and prints all the items, preceded by a checkbox:
6991
6992 @example
6993 @group
6994 #!/usr/bin/perl
6995
6996 # define the Emacs command to run
6997 $cmd = "emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -eval '(org-batch-agenda-csv \"t\")'";
6998
6999 # run it and capture the output
7000 $agenda = qx@{$cmd 2>/dev/null@};
7001
7002 # loop over all lines
7003 foreach $line (split(/\n/,$agenda)) @{
7004
7005 # get the individual values
7006 ($category,$head,$type,$todo,$tags,$date,$time,$extra,
7007 $priority_l,$priority_n) = split(/,/,$line);
7008
7009 # process and print
7010 print "[ ] $head\n";
7011 @}
7012 @end group
7013 @end example
7014
7015 @node Agenda column view, , Custom agenda views, Agenda Views
7016 @section Using column view in the agenda
7017 @cindex column view, in agenda
7018 @cindex agenda, column view
7019
7020 Column view (@pxref{Column view}) is normally used to view and edit
7021 properties embedded in the hierarchical structure of an Org file. It can be
7022 quite useful to use column view also from the agenda, where entries are
7023 collected by certain criteria.
7024
7025 @table @kbd
7026 @kindex C-c C-x C-c
7027 @item C-c C-x C-c
7028 Turn on column view in the agenda.
7029 @end table
7030
7031 To understand how to use this properly, it is important to realize that the
7032 entries in the agenda are no longer in their proper outline environment.
7033 This causes the following issues:
7034
7035 @enumerate
7036 @item
7037 Org needs to make a decision which @code{COLUMNS} format to use. Since the
7038 entries in the agenda are collected from different files, and different files
7039 may have different @code{COLUMNS} formats, this is a non-trivial problem.
7040 Org first checks if the variable @code{org-overriding-columns-format} is
7041 currently set, and if yes takes the format from there. Otherwise it takes
7042 the format associated with the first item in the agenda, or, if that item
7043 does not have a specific format (defined in a property, or in it's file), it
7044 uses @code{org-columns-default-format}.
7045 @item
7046 If any of the columns has a summary type defined (@pxref{Column attributes}),
7047 turning on column view in the agenda will visit all relevant agenda files and
7048 make sure that the computations of this property are up to date. This is
7049 also true for the special @code{CLOCKSUM} property. Org will then sum the
7050 values displayed in the agenda. In the daily/weekly agenda, the sums will
7051 cover a single day, in all other views they cover the entire block. It is
7052 vital to realize that the agenda may show the same entry @emph{twice} (for
7053 example as scheduled and as a deadline), and it may show two entries from the
7054 same hierarchy (for example a @emph{parent} and it's @emph{child}). In these
7055 cases, the summation in the agenda will lead to incorrect results because
7056 some values will count double.
7057 @item
7058 When the column view in the agenda shows the @code{CLOCKSUM}, that is always
7059 the entire clocked time for this item. So even in the daily/weekly agenda,
7060 the clocksum listed in column view may originate from times outside the
7061 current view. This has the advantage that you can compare these values with
7062 a column listing the planned total effort for a task - one of the major
7063 applications for column view in the agenda. If you want information about
7064 clocked time in the displayed period use clock table mode (press @kbd{R} in
7065 the agenda).
7066 @end enumerate
7067
7068
7069 @node Embedded LaTeX, Exporting, Agenda Views, Top
7070 @chapter Embedded LaTeX
7071 @cindex @TeX{} interpretation
7072 @cindex La@TeX{} interpretation
7073
7074 Plain ASCII is normally sufficient for almost all note taking. One
7075 exception, however, are scientific notes which need to be able to contain
7076 mathematical symbols and the occasional formula. La@TeX{}@footnote{La@TeX{}
7077 is a macro system based on Donald E. Knuth's @TeX{} system. Many of the
7078 features described here as ``La@TeX{}'' are really from @TeX{}, but for
7079 simplicity I am blurring this distinction.} is widely used to typeset
7080 scientific documents. Org mode supports embedding La@TeX{} code into its
7081 files, because many academics are used to reading La@TeX{} source code, and
7082 because it can be readily processed into images for HTML production.
7083
7084 It is not necessary to mark La@TeX{} macros and code in any special way.
7085 If you observe a few conventions, Org mode knows how to find it and what
7086 to do with it.
7087
7088 @menu
7089 * Math symbols:: TeX macros for symbols and Greek letters
7090 * Subscripts and superscripts:: Simple syntax for raising/lowering text
7091 * LaTeX fragments:: Complex formulas made easy
7092 * Processing LaTeX fragments:: Previewing LaTeX processing
7093 * CDLaTeX mode:: Speed up entering of formulas
7094 @end menu
7095
7096 @node Math symbols, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX, Embedded LaTeX
7097 @section Math symbols
7098 @cindex math symbols
7099 @cindex TeX macros
7100
7101 You can use La@TeX{} macros to insert special symbols like @samp{\alpha} to
7102 indicate the Greek letter, or @samp{\to} to indicate an arrow. Completion
7103 for these macros is available, just type @samp{\} and maybe a few letters,
7104 and press @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} to see possible completions. Unlike La@TeX{}
7105 code, Org mode allows these macros to be present without surrounding math
7106 delimiters, for example:
7107
7108 @example
7109 Angles are written as Greek letters \alpha, \beta and \gamma.
7110 @end example
7111
7112 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), these symbols are translated
7113 into the proper syntax for HTML, for the above examples this is
7114 @samp{&alpha;} and @samp{&rarr;}, respectively. If you need such a symbol
7115 inside a word, terminate it like this: @samp{\Aacute@{@}stor}.
7116
7117 @node Subscripts and superscripts, LaTeX fragments, Math symbols, Embedded LaTeX
7118 @section Subscripts and superscripts
7119 @cindex subscript
7120 @cindex superscript
7121
7122 Just like in La@TeX{}, @samp{^} and @samp{_} are used to indicate super-
7123 and subscripts. Again, these can be used without embedding them in
7124 math-mode delimiters. To increase the readability of ASCII text, it is
7125 not necessary (but OK) to surround multi-character sub- and superscripts
7126 with curly braces. For example
7127
7128 @example
7129 The mass if the sun is M_sun = 1.989 x 10^30 kg. The radius of
7130 the sun is R_@{sun@} = 6.96 x 10^8 m.
7131 @end example
7132
7133 To avoid interpretation as raised or lowered text, you can quote
7134 @samp{^} and @samp{_} with a backslash: @samp{\_} and @samp{\^}.
7135
7136 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), subscript and superscripts
7137 are surrounded with @code{<sub>} and @code{<sup>} tags, respectively.
7138
7139 @node LaTeX fragments, Processing LaTeX fragments, Subscripts and superscripts, Embedded LaTeX
7140 @section LaTeX fragments
7141 @cindex LaTeX fragments
7142
7143 With symbols, sub- and superscripts, HTML is pretty much at its end when
7144 it comes to representing mathematical formulas@footnote{Yes, there is
7145 MathML, but that is not yet fully supported by many browsers, and there
7146 is no decent converter for turning La@TeX{} or ASCII representations of
7147 formulas into MathML. So for the time being, converting formulas into
7148 images seems the way to go.}. More complex expressions need a dedicated
7149 formula processor. To this end, Org mode can contain arbitrary La@TeX{}
7150 fragments. It provides commands to preview the typeset result of these
7151 fragments, and upon export to HTML, all fragments will be converted to
7152 images and inlined into the HTML document@footnote{The La@TeX{} export
7153 will not use images for displaying La@TeX{} fragments but include these
7154 fragments directly into the La@TeX{} code.}. For this to work you
7155 need to be on a system with a working La@TeX{} installation. You also
7156 need the @file{dvipng} program, available at
7157 @url{http://sourceforge.net/projects/dvipng/}. The La@TeX{} header that
7158 will be used when processing a fragment can be configured with the
7159 variable @code{org-format-latex-header}.
7160
7161 La@TeX{} fragments don't need any special marking at all. The following
7162 snippets will be identified as La@TeX{} source code:
7163 @itemize @bullet
7164 @item
7165 Environments of any kind. The only requirement is that the
7166 @code{\begin} statement appears on a new line, preceded by only
7167 whitespace.
7168 @item
7169 Text within the usual La@TeX{} math delimiters. To avoid conflicts with
7170 currency specifications, single @samp{$} characters are only recognized as
7171 math delimiters if the enclosed text contains at most two line breaks, is
7172 directly attached to the @samp{$} characters with no whitespace in between,
7173 and if the closing @samp{$} is followed by whitespace, punctuation or a dash.
7174 For the other delimiters, there is no such restriction, so when in doubt, use
7175 @samp{\(...\)} as inline math delimiters.
7176 @end itemize
7177
7178 @noindent For example:
7179
7180 @example
7181 \begin@{equation@} % arbitrary environments,
7182 x=\sqrt@{b@} % even tables, figures
7183 \end@{equation@} % etc
7184
7185 If $a^2=b$ and \( b=2 \), then the solution must be
7186 either $$ a=+\sqrt@{2@} $$ or \[ a=-\sqrt@{2@} \].
7187 @end example
7188
7189 @noindent
7190 If you need any of the delimiter ASCII sequences for other purposes, you
7191 can configure the option @code{org-format-latex-options} to deselect the
7192 ones you do not wish to have interpreted by the La@TeX{} converter.
7193
7194 @node Processing LaTeX fragments, CDLaTeX mode, LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
7195 @section Processing LaTeX fragments
7196 @cindex LaTeX fragments, preview
7197
7198 La@TeX{} fragments can be processed to produce a preview images of the
7199 typeset expressions:
7200
7201 @table @kbd
7202 @kindex C-c C-x C-l
7203 @item C-c C-x C-l
7204 Produce a preview image of the La@TeX{} fragment at point and overlay it
7205 over the source code. If there is no fragment at point, process all
7206 fragments in the current entry (between two headlines). When called
7207 with a prefix argument, process the entire subtree. When called with
7208 two prefix arguments, or when the cursor is before the first headline,
7209 process the entire buffer.
7210 @kindex C-c C-c
7211 @item C-c C-c
7212 Remove the overlay preview images.
7213 @end table
7214
7215 During HTML export (@pxref{HTML export}), all La@TeX{} fragments are
7216 converted into images and inlined into the document if the following
7217 setting is active:
7218
7219 @lisp
7220 (setq org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments t)
7221 @end lisp
7222
7223 @node CDLaTeX mode, , Processing LaTeX fragments, Embedded LaTeX
7224 @section Using CDLaTeX to enter math
7225 @cindex CDLaTeX
7226
7227 CDLaTeX mode is a minor mode that is normally used in combination with a
7228 major La@TeX{} mode like AUCTeX in order to speed-up insertion of
7229 environments and math templates. Inside Org mode, you can make use of
7230 some of the features of CDLaTeX mode. You need to install
7231 @file{cdlatex.el} and @file{texmathp.el} (the latter comes also with
7232 AUCTeX) from @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools/cdlatex}.
7233 Don't use CDLaTeX mode itself under Org mode, but use the light
7234 version @code{org-cdlatex-mode} that comes as part of Org mode. Turn it
7235 on for the current buffer with @code{M-x org-cdlatex-mode}, or for all
7236 Org files with
7237
7238 @lisp
7239 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook 'turn-on-org-cdlatex)
7240 @end lisp
7241
7242 When this mode is enabled, the following features are present (for more
7243 details see the documentation of CDLaTeX mode):
7244 @itemize @bullet
7245 @kindex C-c @{
7246 @item
7247 Environment templates can be inserted with @kbd{C-c @{}.
7248 @item
7249 @kindex @key{TAB}
7250 The @key{TAB} key will do template expansion if the cursor is inside a
7251 La@TeX{} fragment@footnote{Org mode has a method to test if the cursor is
7252 inside such a fragment, see the documentation of the function
7253 @code{org-inside-LaTeX-fragment-p}.}. For example, @key{TAB} will
7254 expand @code{fr} to @code{\frac@{@}@{@}} and position the cursor
7255 correctly inside the first brace. Another @key{TAB} will get you into
7256 the second brace. Even outside fragments, @key{TAB} will expand
7257 environment abbreviations at the beginning of a line. For example, if
7258 you write @samp{equ} at the beginning of a line and press @key{TAB},
7259 this abbreviation will be expanded to an @code{equation} environment.
7260 To get a list of all abbreviations, type @kbd{M-x cdlatex-command-help}.
7261 @item
7262 @kindex _
7263 @kindex ^
7264 Pressing @kbd{_} and @kbd{^} inside a La@TeX{} fragment will insert these
7265 characters together with a pair of braces. If you use @key{TAB} to move
7266 out of the braces, and if the braces surround only a single character or
7267 macro, they are removed again (depending on the variable
7268 @code{cdlatex-simplify-sub-super-scripts}).
7269 @item
7270 @kindex `
7271 Pressing the backquote @kbd{`} followed by a character inserts math
7272 macros, also outside La@TeX{} fragments. If you wait more than 1.5 seconds
7273 after the backquote, a help window will pop up.
7274 @item
7275 @kindex '
7276 Pressing the normal quote @kbd{'} followed by another character modifies
7277 the symbol before point with an accent or a font. If you wait more than
7278 1.5 seconds after the backquote, a help window will pop up. Character
7279 modification will work only inside La@TeX{} fragments, outside the quote
7280 is normal.
7281 @end itemize
7282
7283 @node Exporting, Publishing, Embedded LaTeX, Top
7284 @chapter Exporting
7285 @cindex exporting
7286
7287 Org mode documents can be exported into a variety of other formats. For
7288 printing and sharing of notes, ASCII export produces a readable and
7289 simple version of an Org file. HTML export allows you to publish a
7290 notes file on the web, while the XOXO format provides a solid base for
7291 exchange with a broad range of other applications. La@TeX{} export lets
7292 you use Org mode and its structured editing functions to easily create
7293 La@TeX{} files. To incorporate entries with associated times like
7294 deadlines or appointments into a desktop calendar program like iCal,
7295 Org mode can also produce extracts in the iCalendar format. Currently
7296 Org mode only supports export, not import of these different formats.
7297
7298 Org supports export of selected regions when @code{transient-mark-mode} is
7299 enabled (default in Emacs 23).
7300
7301 @menu
7302 * Markup rules:: Which structures are recognized?
7303 * Selective export:: Using tags to select and exclude trees
7304 * Export options:: Per-file export settings
7305 * The export dispatcher:: How to access exporter commands
7306 * ASCII export:: Exporting to plain ASCII
7307 * HTML export:: Exporting to HTML
7308 * LaTeX and PDF export:: Exporting to LaTeX, and processing to PDF
7309 * XOXO export:: Exporting to XOXO
7310 * iCalendar export:: Exporting in iCalendar format
7311 @end menu
7312
7313 @node Markup rules, Selective export, Exporting, Exporting
7314 @section Markup rules
7315
7316 When exporting Org mode documents, the exporter tries to reflect the
7317 structure of the document as accurately as possible in the back-end. Since
7318 export targets like HTML or La@TeX{} allow much richer formatting, Org mode
7319 has rules how to prepare text for rich export. This section summarizes the
7320 markup rule used in an Org mode buffer.
7321
7322 @menu
7323 * Document title:: How the document title is determined
7324 * Headings and sections:: The main structure of the exported document
7325 * Table of contents:: If, where, how to create a table of contents
7326 * Initial text:: Text before the first headline
7327 * Lists:: Plain lists are exported
7328 * Paragraphs:: What determines beginning and ending
7329 * Literal examples:: Source code and other examples
7330 * Include files:: Include the contents of a file during export
7331 * Tables exported:: Tables are exported richly
7332 * Inlined images:: How to inline images during export
7333 * Footnote markup::
7334 * Emphasis and monospace:: To bold or not to bold
7335 * TeX macros and LaTeX fragments:: Create special, rich export.
7336 * Horizontal rules:: A line across the page
7337 * Comment lines:: Some lines will not be exported
7338 @end menu
7339
7340 @node Document title, Headings and sections, Markup rules, Markup rules
7341 @subheading Document title
7342 @cindex document title, markup rules
7343
7344 @noindent
7345 The title of the exported document is taken from the special line
7346
7347 @example
7348 #+TITLE: This is the title of the document
7349 @end example
7350
7351 @noindent
7352 If this line does not exist, the title is derived from the first non-empty,
7353 non-comment line in the buffer. If no such line exists, or if you have
7354 turned off exporting of the text before the first headline (see below), the
7355 title will be the file name without extension.
7356
7357 If you are exporting only a subtree by marking is as the region, the heading
7358 of the subtree will become the title of the document. If the subtree has a
7359 property @code{EXPORT_TITLE}, that will take precedence.
7360
7361 @node Headings and sections, Table of contents, Document title, Markup rules
7362 @subheading Headings and sections
7363 @cindex headings and sections, markup rules
7364
7365 The outline structure of the document as described in @ref{Document
7366 Structure} forms the basis for defining sections of the exported document.
7367 However, since the outline structure is also used for (for example) lists of
7368 tasks, only the first three outline levels will be used as headings. Deeper
7369 levels will become itemized lists. You can change the location of this
7370 switch, globally by setting the variable @code{org-headline-levels}, or on a
7371 per file basis with a line
7372
7373 @example
7374 #+OPTIONS: H:4
7375 @end example
7376
7377 @node Table of contents, Initial text, Headings and sections, Markup rules
7378 @subheading Table of contents
7379 @cindex table of contents, markup rules
7380
7381 The table of contents is normally inserted directly before the first headline
7382 of the file. If you would like to get it to a different location, insert the
7383 string @code{[TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]} on a line by itself at the desired
7384 location. The depth of the table of contents is by default the same as the
7385 number of headline levels, but you can choose a smaller number or turn off
7386 the table of contents entirely by configuring the variable
7387 @code{org-export-with-toc}, or on a per-file basis with a line like
7388
7389 @example
7390 #+OPTIONS: toc:2 (only to two levels in TOC)
7391 #+OPTIONS: toc:nil (no TOC at all)
7392 @end example
7393
7394 @node Initial text, Lists, Table of contents, Markup rules
7395 @subheading Text before the first headline
7396 @cindex text before first headline, markup rules
7397 @cindex #+TEXT
7398
7399 Org mode normally exports the text before the first headline, and even uses
7400 the first line as the document title. The text will be fully marked up. If
7401 you need to include literal HTML or La@TeX{} code, use the special constructs
7402 described below in the sections for the individual exporters.
7403
7404 Some people like to use the space before the first headline for setup and
7405 internal links and therefore would like to control the exported text before
7406 the first headline in a different way. You can do so by setting the variable
7407 @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading} to @code{t}. On a per-file
7408 basis, you can get the same effect with @samp{#+OPTIONS: skip:t}.
7409
7410 @noindent
7411 If you still want to have some text before the first headline, use the
7412 @code{#+TEXT} construct:
7413
7414 @example
7415 #+OPTIONS: skip:t
7416 #+TEXT: This text will go before the *first* headline.
7417 #+TEXT: [TABLE-OF-CONTENTS]
7418 #+TEXT: This goes between the table of contents and the first headline
7419 @end example
7420
7421 @node Lists, Paragraphs, Initial text, Markup rules
7422 @subheading Lists
7423 @cindex lists, markup rules
7424
7425 Plain lists as described in @ref{Plain lists} are translated to the back-ends
7426 syntax for such lists. Most back-ends support unordered, ordered, and
7427 description lists.
7428
7429 @node Paragraphs, Literal examples, Lists, Markup rules
7430 @subheading Paragraphs, line breaks, and quoting
7431 @cindex paragraphs, markup rules
7432
7433 Paragraphs are separated by at least one empty line. If you need to enforce
7434 a line break within a paragraph, use @samp{\\} at the end of a line.
7435
7436 To keep the line breaks in a region, but otherwise use normal formatting, you
7437 can use this construct, which can also be used to format poetry.
7438
7439 @example
7440 #+BEGIN_VERSE
7441 Great clouds overhead
7442 Tiny black birds rise and fall
7443 Snow covers Emacs
7444
7445 -- AlexSchroeder
7446 #+END_VERSE
7447 @end example
7448
7449 When quoting a passage from another document, it is customary to format this
7450 as a paragraph that is indented on both the left and the right margin. You
7451 can include quotations in Org mode documents like this:
7452
7453 @example
7454 #+BEGIN_QUOTE
7455 Everything should be made as simple as possible,
7456 but not any simpler -- Albert Einstein
7457 #+END_QUOTE
7458 @end example
7459
7460
7461 @node Literal examples, Include files, Paragraphs, Markup rules
7462 @subheading Literal examples
7463 @cindex literal examples, markup rules
7464 @cindex code line refenences, markup rules
7465
7466 You can include literal examples that should not be subjected to
7467 markup. Such examples will be typeset in monospace, so this is well suited
7468 for source code and similar examples.
7469 @cindex #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
7470
7471 @example
7472 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE
7473 Some example from a text file.
7474 #+END_EXAMPLE
7475 @end example
7476
7477 For simplicity when using small examples, you can also start the example
7478 lines with a colon followed by a space. There may also be additional
7479 whitespace before the colon:
7480
7481 @example
7482 Here is an example
7483 : Some example from a text file.
7484 @end example
7485
7486 @cindex formatting source code, markup rules
7487 If the example is source code from a programming language, or any other text
7488 that can be marked up by font-lock in Emacs, you can ask for the example to
7489 look like the fontified Emacs buffer@footnote{Currently this works only for
7490 the HTML back-end, and requires the @file{htmlize.el} package version 1.34 or
7491 later.}. This is done with the @samp{src} block, where you also need to
7492 specify the name of the major mode that should be used to fontify the
7493 example:
7494 @cindex #+BEGIN_SRC
7495
7496 @example
7497 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp
7498 (defun org-xor (a b)
7499 "Exclusive or."
7500 (if a (not b) b))
7501 #+END_SRC
7502 @end example
7503
7504 Both in @code{example} and in @code{src} snippets, you can add a @code{-n}
7505 switch to the end of the @code{BEGIN} line, to get the lines of the example
7506 numbered. If you use a @code{+n} switch, the numbering from the previous
7507 numbered snippet will be continued in the current one. In literal examples,
7508 Org will interpret strings like @samp{(ref:name)} as labels, and use them as
7509 targets for special hyperlinks like @code{[[(name)]]} (i.e. the reference
7510 name enclosed in single parenthesis). In HTML, hovering the mouse over such
7511 a link will remote-highlight the corresponding code line, which is kind of
7512 cool. If the example/src snippet is numbered, you can also add a @code{-r}
7513 switch. Then labels will be @i{removed} from the source code and the links
7514 will be @i{replaced}@footnote{If you want to explain the use of such labels
7515 themelves in org-mode example code, you can use the @code{-k} switch to make
7516 sure they are not touched.} with line numbers from the code listing. Here is
7517 an example:
7518
7519 @example
7520 #+BEGIN_SRC emacs-lisp -n -r
7521 (save-excursion (ref:sc)
7522 (goto-char (point-min)) (ref:jump)
7523 #+END SRC
7524 In line [[(sc)]] we remember the current positon. [[(jump)][Line (jump)]]
7525 jumps to point-min.
7526 @end example
7527
7528 If the syntax for the label format conflicts with the language syntax, use a
7529 @code{-l} switch to change the format, for example @samp{#+BEGIN_SRC pascal
7530 -n -r -l "((%s))"}. See also the variable @code{org-coderef-label-format}.
7531
7532 HTML export also allows examples to be published as text areas, @pxref{Text
7533 areas in HTML export}.
7534
7535 @table @kbd
7536 @kindex C-c '
7537 @item C-c '
7538 Edit the source code example at point in its native mode. This works by
7539 switching to an indirect buffer, narrowing the buffer and switching to the
7540 other mode. You need to exit by pressing @kbd{C-c '} again@footnote{Upon
7541 exit, lines starting with @samp{*} or @samp{#} will get a comma prepended, to
7542 keep them from being interpreted by Org as outline nodes or special
7543 comments. These commas will be striped for editing with @kbd{C-c '}, and
7544 also for export.}. Fixed-width
7545 regions (where each line starts with a colon followed by a space) will be
7546 edited using @code{artist-mode}@footnote{You may select a different-mode with
7547 the variable @code{org-edit-fixed-width-region-mode}.} to allow creating
7548 ASCII drawings easily. Using this command in an empty line will create a new
7549 fixed-width region.
7550 @kindex C-c l
7551 @item C-c l
7552 Calling @code{org-store-link} while editing a source code example in a
7553 temporary buffer created with @kbd{C-c '} will prompt for a label, make sure
7554 that it is unique in the current buffer, and insert it with the proper
7555 formatting like @samp{(ref:label)} at the end of the current line. Then the
7556 label is stored as a link @samp{(label)}, for retrieval with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
7557 @end table
7558
7559
7560 @node Include files, Tables exported, Literal examples, Markup rules
7561 @subheading Include files
7562 @cindex include files, markup rules
7563
7564 During export, you can include the content of another file. For example, to
7565 include your .emacs file, you could use:
7566 @cindex #+INCLUDE
7567
7568 @example
7569 #+INCLUDE: "~/.emacs" src emacs-lisp
7570 @end example
7571
7572 The optional second and third parameter are the markup (@samp{quote},
7573 @samp{example}, or @samp{src}), and, if the markup is @samp{src}, the
7574 language for formatting the contents. The markup is optional, if it is not
7575 given, the text will be assumed to be in Org mode format and will be
7576 processed normally. The include line will also allow additional keyword
7577 parameters @code{:prefix1} and @code{:prefix} to specify prefixes for the
7578 first line and for each following line, as well as any options accepted by
7579 the selected markup. For example, to include a file as an item, use
7580
7581 @example
7582 #+INCLUDE: "~/snippets/xx" :prefix1 " + " :prefix " "
7583 @end example
7584
7585 @table @kbd
7586 @kindex C-c '
7587 @item C-c '
7588 Visit the include file at point.
7589 @end table
7590
7591 @node Tables exported, Inlined images, Include files, Markup rules
7592 @subheading Tables
7593 @cindex tables, markup rules
7594
7595 Both the native Org mode tables (@pxref{Tables}) and tables formatted with
7596 the @file{table.el} package will be exported properly. For Org mode tables,
7597 the lines before the first horizontal separator line will become table header
7598 lines. You can use the following lines somewhere before the table to assign
7599 a caption and a label for cross references:
7600
7601 @example
7602 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next table (or link)
7603 #+LABEL: tbl:basic-data
7604 @end example
7605
7606 @node Inlined images, Footnote markup, Tables exported, Markup rules
7607 @subheading Inlined Images
7608 @cindex inlined images, markup rules
7609
7610 Some backends (HTML and LaTeX) allow to directly include images into the
7611 exported document. Org does this, if a link to an image files does not have
7612 a description part, for example @code{[[./img/a.jpg]]}. If you wish to
7613 define a caption for the image and maybe a label for internal cross
7614 references, you can use (before, but close to the link)
7615
7616 @example
7617 #+CAPTION: This is the caption for the next figure link (or table)
7618 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
7619 @end example
7620
7621 You may also define additional attributes for the figure. As this is
7622 backend-specific, see the sections about the individual backends for more
7623 information.
7624
7625 @node Footnote markup, Emphasis and monospace, Inlined images, Markup rules
7626 @subheading Footnote markup
7627 @cindex footnotes, markup rules
7628 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
7629
7630 Footnotes defined in the way descriped in @ref{Footnotes} will be exported by
7631 all backends. Org does allow multiple references to the same note, and
7632 different backends support this to varying degree.
7633
7634 @node Emphasis and monospace, TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Footnote markup, Markup rules
7635 @subheading Emphasis and monospace
7636
7637 @cindex underlined text, markup rules
7638 @cindex bold text, markup rules
7639 @cindex italic text, markup rules
7640 @cindex verbatim text, markup rules
7641 @cindex code text, markup rules
7642 @cindex strike-through text, markup rules
7643 You can make words @b{*bold*}, @i{/italic/}, _underlined_, @code{=code=}
7644 and @code{~verbatim~}, and, if you must, @samp{+strike-through+}. Text
7645 in the code and verbatim string is not processed for Org mode specific
7646 syntax, it is exported verbatim.
7647
7648 @node TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Horizontal rules, Emphasis and monospace, Markup rules
7649 @subheading @TeX{} macros and La@TeX{} fragments
7650 @cindex LaTeX fragments, markup rules
7651 @cindex TeX macros, markup rules
7652 @cindex HTML entities
7653 @cindex LaTeX entities
7654
7655 A @TeX{}-like syntax is used to specify special characters. Where possible,
7656 these will be transformed into the native format of the exporter back-end.
7657 Strings like @code{\alpha} will be exported as @code{&alpha;} in the HTML
7658 output, and as @code{$\alpha$} in the La@TeX{} output. Similarly,
7659 @code{\nbsp} will become @code{&nbsp;} in HTML and @code{~} in La@TeX{}.
7660 This applies for a large number of entities, with names taken from both HTML
7661 and La@TeX{}, see the variable @code{org-html-entities} for the complete
7662 list. If you are unsure about a name, use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} for completion
7663 after having typed the backslash and maybe a few characters
7664 (@pxref{Completion}).
7665
7666 La@TeX{} fragments are converted into images for HTML export, and they are
7667 written literally into the La@TeX{} export. See also @ref{Embedded LaTeX}.
7668
7669 Finally, @samp{\-} is treated as a shy hyphen, and @samp{--}, @samp{---}, and
7670 @samp{...} are all converted into special commands creating hyphens of
7671 different lengths or a compact set of dots.
7672
7673 @node Horizontal rules, Comment lines, TeX macros and LaTeX fragments, Markup rules
7674 @subheading Horizontal rules
7675 @cindex horizontal rules, markup rules
7676 A line consisting of only dashes, and at least 5 of them, will be
7677 exported as a horizontal line (@samp{<hr/>} in HTML).
7678
7679 @node Comment lines, , Horizontal rules, Markup rules
7680 @subheading Comment lines
7681 @cindex comment lines
7682 @cindex exporting, not
7683
7684 Lines starting with @samp{#} in column zero are treated as comments and will
7685 never be exported. Also entire subtrees starting with the word
7686 @samp{COMMENT} will never be exported. Finally, regions surrounded by
7687 @samp{#+BEGIN_COMMENT} ... @samp{#+END_COMMENT} will not be exported.
7688
7689 @table @kbd
7690 @kindex C-c ;
7691 @item C-c ;
7692 Toggle the COMMENT keyword at the beginning of an entry.
7693 @end table
7694
7695 @node Selective export, Export options, Markup rules, Exporting
7696 @section Selective export
7697 @cindex export, selective by tags
7698
7699 You may use tags to select the parts of a document that should be exported,
7700 or to exclude parts from export. This behavior is governed by two variables:
7701 @code{org-export-select-tags} and @code{org-export-exclude-tags}.
7702
7703 Org first checks if any of the @emph{select} tags is present in the buffer.
7704 If yes, all trees that do not carry one of these tags will be excluded. If a
7705 selected tree is a subtree, the heading hierarchy above it will also be
7706 selected for export, but not the text below those headings.
7707
7708 @noindent
7709 If none of the select tags is found, the whole buffer will be selected for
7710 export.
7711
7712 @noindent
7713 Finally, all subtrees that are marked by any of the @emph{exclude} tags will
7714 be removed from the export buffer.
7715
7716 @node Export options, The export dispatcher, Selective export, Exporting
7717 @section Export options
7718 @cindex options, for export
7719
7720 @cindex completion, of option keywords
7721 The exporter recognizes special lines in the buffer which provide
7722 additional information. These lines may be put anywhere in the file.
7723 The whole set of lines can be inserted into the buffer with @kbd{C-c
7724 C-e t}. For individual lines, a good way to make sure the keyword is
7725 correct is to type @samp{#+} and then use @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} completion
7726 (@pxref{Completion}).
7727
7728 @table @kbd
7729 @kindex C-c C-e t
7730 @item C-c C-e t
7731 Insert template with export options, see example below.
7732 @end table
7733
7734 @cindex #+TITLE:
7735 @cindex #+AUTHOR:
7736 @cindex #+DATE:
7737 @cindex #+EMAIL:
7738 @cindex #+LANGUAGE:
7739 @cindex #+TEXT:
7740 @cindex #+OPTIONS:
7741 @cindex #+LINK_UP:
7742 @cindex #+LINK_HOME:
7743 @cindex #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS:
7744 @cindex #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS:
7745 @example
7746 #+TITLE: the title to be shown (default is the buffer name)
7747 #+AUTHOR: the author (default taken from @code{user-full-name})
7748 #+DATE: A date, fixed, of a format string for @code{format-time-string}
7749 #+EMAIL: his/her email address (default from @code{user-mail-address})
7750 #+LANGUAGE: language for HTML, e.g. @samp{en} (@code{org-export-default-language})
7751 #+TEXT: Some descriptive text to be inserted at the beginning.
7752 #+TEXT: Several lines may be given.
7753 #+OPTIONS: H:2 num:t toc:t \n:nil @@:t ::t |:t ^:t f:t TeX:t ...
7754 #+LINK_UP: the ``up'' link of an exported page
7755 #+LINK_HOME: the ``home'' link of an exported page
7756 #+EXPORT_SELECT_TAGS: Tags that select a tree for export
7757 #+EXPORT_EXCLUDE_TAGS: Tags that exclude a tree from export
7758 @end example
7759
7760 @noindent
7761 The OPTIONS line is a compact@footnote{If you want to configure many options
7762 this way, you can use several OPTIONS lines.} form to specify export settings. Here
7763 you can:
7764 @cindex headline levels
7765 @cindex section-numbers
7766 @cindex table of contents
7767 @cindex line-break preservation
7768 @cindex quoted HTML tags
7769 @cindex fixed-width sections
7770 @cindex tables
7771 @cindex @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts
7772 @cindex footnotes
7773 @cindex special strings
7774 @cindex emphasized text
7775 @cindex @TeX{} macros
7776 @cindex La@TeX{} fragments
7777 @cindex author info, in export
7778 @cindex time info, in export
7779 @example
7780 H: @r{set the number of headline levels for export}
7781 num: @r{turn on/off section-numbers}
7782 toc: @r{turn on/off table of contents, or set level limit (integer)}
7783 \n: @r{turn on/off line-break-preservation}
7784 @@: @r{turn on/off quoted HTML tags}
7785 :: @r{turn on/off fixed-width sections}
7786 |: @r{turn on/off tables}
7787 ^: @r{turn on/off @TeX{}-like syntax for sub- and superscripts. If}
7788 @r{you write "^:@{@}", @code{a_@{b@}} will be interpreted, but}
7789 @r{the simple @code{a_b} will be left as it is.}
7790 -: @r{turn on/off conversion of special strings.}
7791 f: @r{turn on/off footnotes like this[1].}
7792 todo: @r{turn on/off inclusion of TODO keywords into exported text}
7793 pri: @r{turn on/off priority cookies}
7794 tags: @r{turn on/off inclusion of tags, may also be @code{not-in-toc}}
7795 <: @r{turn on/off inclusion of any time/date stamps like DEADLINES}
7796 *: @r{turn on/off emphasized text (bold, italic, underlined)}
7797 TeX: @r{turn on/off simple @TeX{} macros in plain text}
7798 LaTeX: @r{turn on/off La@TeX{} fragments}
7799 skip: @r{turn on/off skipping the text before the first heading}
7800 author: @r{turn on/off inclusion of author name/email into exported file}
7801 creator: @r{turn on/off inclusion of creator info into exported file}
7802 timestamp: @r{turn on/off inclusion creation time into exported file}
7803 d: @r{turn on/off inclusion of drawers}
7804 @end example
7805
7806 These options take effect in both the HTML and La@TeX{} export, except
7807 for @code{TeX} and @code{LaTeX}, which are respectively @code{t} and
7808 @code{nil} for the La@TeX{} export.
7809
7810 When exporting only a single subtree by selecting it with @kbd{C-c @@} before
7811 calling an export command, the subtree can overrule some of the file's export
7812 settings with properties @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}, @code{EXPORT_TITLE},
7813 @code{EXPORT_TEXT}, and @code{EXPORT_OPTIONS}.
7814
7815 @node The export dispatcher, ASCII export, Export options, Exporting
7816 @section The export dispatcher
7817 @cindex dispatcher, for export commands
7818
7819 All export commands can be reached using the export dispatcher, which is a
7820 prefix key that prompts for an additional key specifying the command.
7821 Normally the entire file is exported, but if there is an active region that
7822 contains one outline tree, the first heading is used as document title and
7823 the subtrees are exported.
7824
7825 @table @kbd
7826 @kindex C-c C-e
7827 @item C-c C-e
7828 Dispatcher for export and publishing commands. Displays a help-window
7829 listing the additional key(s) needed to launch an export or publishing
7830 command. The prefix arg is passed through to the exporter. A double prefix
7831 @kbd{C-u C-u} causes most commands to be executed in the background, in a
7832 separate emacs process@footnote{To make this behavior the default, customize
7833 the variable @code{org-export-run-in-background}.}.
7834 @kindex C-c C-e v
7835 @item C-c C-e v
7836 Like @kbd{C-c C-e}, but only export the text that is currently visible
7837 (i.e. not hidden by outline visibility).
7838 @kindex C-u C-u C-c C-e
7839 @item C-u C-u C-c C-e
7840 Call an the exporter, but reverse the setting of
7841 @code{org-export-run-in-background}, i.e. request background processing if
7842 not set, or force processing in the current Emacs process if st.
7843 @end table
7844
7845 @node ASCII export, HTML export, The export dispatcher, Exporting
7846 @section ASCII export
7847 @cindex ASCII export
7848
7849 ASCII export produces a simple and very readable version of an Org mode
7850 file.
7851
7852 @cindex region, active
7853 @cindex active region
7854 @cindex transient-mark-mode
7855 @table @kbd
7856 @kindex C-c C-e a
7857 @item C-c C-e a
7858 Export as ASCII file. For an org file @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file
7859 will be @file{myfile.txt}. The file will be overwritten without
7860 warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this requires
7861 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
7862 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
7863 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will
7864 become the document title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an
7865 @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME} property, that name will be used for the
7866 export.
7867 @kindex C-c C-e v a
7868 @item C-c C-e v a
7869 Export only the visible part of the document.
7870 @end table
7871
7872 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
7873 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
7874 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
7875 will be exported as itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur
7876 at a different level, specify it with a prefix argument. For example,
7877
7878 @example
7879 @kbd{C-1 C-c C-e a}
7880 @end example
7881
7882 @noindent
7883 creates only top level headlines and does the rest as items. When
7884 headlines are converted to items, the indentation of the text following
7885 the headline is changed to fit nicely under the item. This is done with
7886 the assumption that the first body line indicates the base indentation of
7887 the body text. Any indentation larger than this is adjusted to preserve
7888 the layout relative to the first line. Should there be lines with less
7889 indentation than the first, these are left alone.
7890
7891 @node HTML export, LaTeX and PDF export, ASCII export, Exporting
7892 @section HTML export
7893 @cindex HTML export
7894
7895 Org mode contains an HTML (XHTML 1.0 strict) exporter with extensive
7896 HTML formatting, in ways similar to John Gruber's @emph{markdown}
7897 language, but with additional support for tables.
7898
7899 @menu
7900 * HTML Export commands:: How to invoke HTML export
7901 * Quoting HTML tags:: Using direct HTML in Org mode
7902 * Links:: Transformation of links for HTML
7903 * Images in HTML export:: How to insert figures into HTML output
7904 * Text areas in HTML export:: An alternative way to show an example
7905 * CSS support:: Changing the appearance of the output
7906 * Javascript support:: Info and Folding in a web browser
7907 @end menu
7908
7909 @node HTML Export commands, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export, HTML export
7910 @subsection HTML export commands
7911
7912 @cindex region, active
7913 @cindex active region
7914 @cindex transient-mark-mode
7915 @table @kbd
7916 @kindex C-c C-e h
7917 @item C-c C-e h
7918 Export as HTML file @file{myfile.html}. For an org file @file{myfile.org},
7919 the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.html}. The file will be overwritten
7920 without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this requires
7921 @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
7922 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
7923 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
7924 title. If the tree head entry has, or inherits, an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
7925 property, that name will be used for the export.
7926 @kindex C-c C-e b
7927 @item C-c C-e b
7928 Export as HTML file and immediately open it with a browser.
7929 @kindex C-c C-e H
7930 @item C-c C-e H
7931 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
7932 @kindex C-c C-e R
7933 @item C-c C-e R
7934 Export the active region to a temporary buffer. With a prefix argument, do
7935 not produce the file header and footer, but just the plain HTML section for
7936 the region. This is good for cut-and-paste operations.
7937 @kindex C-c C-e v h
7938 @kindex C-c C-e v b
7939 @kindex C-c C-e v H
7940 @kindex C-c C-e v R
7941 @item C-c C-e v h
7942 @item C-c C-e v b
7943 @item C-c C-e v H
7944 @item C-c C-e v R
7945 Export only the visible part of the document.
7946 @item M-x org-export-region-as-html
7947 Convert the region to HTML under the assumption that it was Org mode
7948 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
7949 buffer.
7950 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-HTML
7951 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by HTML
7952 code.
7953 @end table
7954
7955 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
7956 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become headlines,
7957 defining a general document structure. Additional levels will be exported as
7958 itemized lists. If you want that transition to occur at a different level,
7959 specify it with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
7960
7961 @example
7962 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e b}
7963 @end example
7964
7965 @noindent
7966 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
7967
7968 @node Quoting HTML tags, Links, HTML Export commands, HTML export
7969 @subsection Quoting HTML tags
7970
7971 Plain @samp{<} and @samp{>} are always transformed to @samp{&lt;} and
7972 @samp{&gt;} in HTML export. If you want to include simple HTML tags
7973 which should be interpreted as such, mark them with @samp{@@} as in
7974 @samp{@@<b>bold text@@</b>}. Note that this really works only for
7975 simple tags. For more extensive HTML that should be copied verbatim to
7976 the exported file use either
7977
7978 @example
7979 #+HTML: Literal HTML code for export
7980 @end example
7981
7982 @noindent or
7983 @cindex #+BEGIN_HTML
7984
7985 @example
7986 #+BEGIN_HTML
7987 All lines between these markers are exported literally
7988 #+END_HTML
7989 @end example
7990
7991
7992 @node Links, Images in HTML export, Quoting HTML tags, HTML export
7993 @subsection Links
7994
7995 @cindex links, in HTML export
7996 @cindex internal links, in HTML export
7997 @cindex external links, in HTML export
7998 Internal links (@pxref{Internal links}) will continue to work in HTML. This
7999 does include automatic links created by radio targets (@pxref{Radio
8000 targets}). Links to external files will still work if the target file is on
8001 the same @i{relative} path as the published Org file. Links to other
8002 @file{.org} files will be translated into HTML links under the assumption
8003 that an HTML version also exists of the linked file, at the same relative
8004 path. @samp{id:} links can then be used to jump to specific entries across
8005 files. For information related to linking files while publishing them to a
8006 publishing directory see @ref{Publishing links}.
8007
8008 If you want to specify attributes for links, you can do so using a special
8009 @code{#+ATTR_HTML} line to define attributes that will be added to the
8010 @code{<a>} or @code{<img>} tags. Here is an example that sets @code{alt} and
8011 @code{title} attributes for an inlined image:
8012
8013 @example
8014 #+ATTR_HTML: alt="This is image A" title="Image with no action"
8015 [[./img/a.jpg]]
8016 @end example
8017
8018 @node Images in HTML export, Text areas in HTML export, Links, HTML export
8019 @subsection Images
8020
8021 @cindex images, inline in HTML
8022 @cindex inlining images in HTML
8023 HTML export can inline images given as links in the Org file, and
8024 it can make an image the clickable part of a link. By
8025 default@footnote{but see the variable
8026 @code{org-export-html-inline-images}}, images are inlined if a link does
8027 not have a description. So @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg]]} will be inlined,
8028 while @samp{[[file:myimg.jpg][the image]]} will just produce a link
8029 @samp{the image} that points to the image. If the description part
8030 itself is a @code{file:} link or a @code{http:} URL pointing to an
8031 image, this image will be inlined and activated so that clicking on the
8032 image will activate the link. For example, to include a thumbnail that
8033 will link to a high resolution version of the image, you could use:
8034
8035 @example
8036 [[file:highres.jpg][file:thumb.jpg]]
8037 @end example
8038
8039 @noindent
8040 and you could use @code{http} addresses just as well.
8041
8042 @node Text areas in HTML export, CSS support, Images in HTML export, HTML export
8043 @subsection Text areas
8044
8045 @cindex text areas, in HTML
8046 An alternative way to publish literal code examples in HTML is to use text
8047 areas, where the example can even be edited before pasting it into an
8048 application. It is triggered by a @code{-t} switch at an @code{example} or
8049 @code{src} block. Using this switch disables any options for syntax and
8050 label highlighting, and line numbering, which may be present. You may also
8051 use @code{-h} and @code{-w} switches to specify the height and width of the
8052 text area, which default to the number of lines in the example, and 80,
8053 respectively. For example
8054
8055 @example
8056 #+BEGIN_EXAMPLE -t -w 40
8057 (defun org-xor (a b)
8058 "Exclusive or."
8059 (if a (not b) b))
8060 #+END_EXAMPLE
8061 @end example
8062
8063
8064 @node CSS support, Javascript support, Text areas in HTML export, HTML export
8065 @subsection CSS support
8066 @cindex CSS, for HTML export
8067 @cindex HTML export, CSS
8068
8069 You can also give style information for the exported file. The HTML exporter
8070 assigns the following special CSS classes to appropriate parts of the
8071 document - your style specifications may change these, in addition to any of
8072 the standard classes like for headlines, tables etc.
8073 @example
8074 .todo @r{TODO keywords}
8075 .done @r{the DONE keyword}
8076 .timestamp @r{time stamp}
8077 .timestamp-kwd @r{keyword associated with a time stamp, like SCHEDULED}
8078 .tag @r{tag in a headline}
8079 .target @r{target for links}
8080 div.figure @r{how to format an inlined image}
8081 .linenr @r{the line number in a code example}
8082 .code-highlighted @r{for highlighting referenced code lines}
8083 @end example
8084
8085 Each exported files contains a compact default style that defines these
8086 classes in a basic way@footnote{This style is defined in the constant
8087 @code{org-export-html-style-default}, which you should not modify. To turn
8088 inclusion of these defaults off, customize
8089 @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}}. You may overwrite these
8090 settings, or add to them by using the variables @code{org-export-html-style}
8091 (for Org-wide settings) and @code{org-export-html-style-extra} (for more
8092 granular settings, like file-local settings). To set the latter variable
8093 individually for each file, you can use
8094
8095 @example
8096 #+STYLE: <link rel="stylesheet" type="text/css" href="stylesheet.css" />
8097 @end example
8098
8099 @noindent
8100 For longer style definitions, you can use several such lines. You could also
8101 directly write a @code{<style>} @code{</style>} section in this way, without
8102 referring to an external file.
8103
8104 @c FIXME: More about header and footer styles
8105 @c FIXME: Talk about links and targets.
8106
8107 @node Javascript support, , CSS support, HTML export
8108 @subsection Javascript supported display of web pages
8109
8110 @emph{Sebastian Rose} has written a JavaScript program especially designed to
8111 enhance the web viewing experience of HTML files created with Org. This
8112 program allows you to view large files in two different ways. The first one
8113 is an @emph{Info}-like mode where each section is displayed separately and
8114 navigation can be done with the @kbd{n} and @kbd{p} keys (and some other keys
8115 as well, press @kbd{?} for an overview of the available keys). The second
8116 view type is a @emph{folding} view much like Org provides inside Emacs. The
8117 script is available at @url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js} and you can find
8118 the documentation for it at @url{http://orgmode.org/worg/code/org-info-js/}.
8119 We are serving the script from our site, but if you use it a lot, you might
8120 not want to be dependent on @url{orgmode.org} and prefer to install a local
8121 copy on your own web server.
8122
8123 To use the script, you need to make sure that the @file{org-jsinfo.el} module
8124 gets loaded. It should be loaded by default, but you can try @kbd{M-x
8125 customize-variable @key{RET} org-modules @key{RET}} to convince yourself that
8126 this is indeed the case. All it then takes to make use of the program is
8127 adding a single line to the Org file:
8128
8129 @example
8130 #+INFOJS_OPT: view:info toc:nil
8131 @end example
8132
8133 @noindent
8134 If this line is found, the HTML header will automatically contain the code
8135 needed to invoke the script. Using the line above, you can set the following
8136 viewing options:
8137
8138 @example
8139 path: @r{The path to the script. The default is to grab the script from}
8140 @r{@url{http://orgmode.org/org-info.js}, but you might want to have}
8141 @r{a local copy and use a path like @samp{../scripts/org-info.js}.}
8142 view: @r{Initial view when website is first shown. Possible values are:}
8143 info @r{Info-like interface with one section per page.}
8144 overview @r{Folding interface, initially showing only top-level.}
8145 content @r{Folding interface, starting with all headlines visible.}
8146 showall @r{Folding interface, all headlines and text visible.}
8147 sdepth: @r{Maximum headline level that will still become an independent}
8148 @r{section for info and folding modes. The default is taken from}
8149 @r{@code{org-headline-levels} (= the @code{H} switch in @code{#+OPTIONS}).}
8150 @r{If this is smaller than in @code{org-headline-levels}, each}
8151 @r{info/folding section can still contain children headlines.}
8152 toc: @r{Should the table of content @emph{initially} be visible?}
8153 @r{Even when @code{nil}, you can always get to the toc with @kbd{i}.}
8154 tdepth: @r{The depth of the table of contents. The defaults are taken from}
8155 @r{the variables @code{org-headline-levels} and @code{org-export-with-toc}.}
8156 ftoc: @r{Does the css of the page specify a fixed position for the toc?}
8157 @r{If yes, the toc will never be displayed as a section.}
8158 ltoc: @r{Should there be short contents (children) in each section?}
8159 mouse: @r{Headings are highlighted when the mouse is over them. Should be}
8160 @r{@samp{underline} (default) or a background color like @samp{#cccccc}.}
8161 buttons: @r{Should view-toggle buttons be everywhere? When @code{nil} (the}
8162 @r{default), only one such button will be present.}
8163 @end example
8164
8165 You can choose default values for these options by customizing the variable
8166 @code{org-infojs-options}. If you always want to apply the script to your
8167 pages, configure the variable @code{org-export-html-use-infojs}.
8168
8169 @node LaTeX and PDF export, XOXO export, HTML export, Exporting
8170 @section LaTeX and PDF export
8171 @cindex LaTeX export
8172 @cindex PDF export
8173
8174 Org mode contains a La@TeX{} exporter written by Bastien Guerry. With
8175 further processing, this backend is also used to produce PDF output. Since
8176 the LaTeX output uses @file{hyperref} to implement links and cross
8177 references, the PDF output file will be fully linked.
8178
8179 @menu
8180 * LaTeX/PDF export commands:: Which key invokes which commands
8181 * Quoting LaTeX code:: Incorporating literal LaTeX code
8182 * Sectioning structure:: Changing sectioning in LaTeX output
8183 * Tables in LaTeX export:: Options for exporting tables to LaTeX
8184 * Images in LaTeX export:: How to insert figures into LaTeX output
8185 @end menu
8186
8187 @node LaTeX/PDF export commands, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export, LaTeX and PDF export
8188 @subsection LaTeX export commands
8189
8190 @cindex region, active
8191 @cindex active region
8192 @cindex transient-mark-mode
8193 @table @kbd
8194 @kindex C-c C-e l
8195 @item C-c C-e l
8196 Export as La@TeX{} file @file{myfile.tex}. For an org file
8197 @file{myfile.org}, the ASCII file will be @file{myfile.tex}. The file will
8198 be overwritten without warning. If there is an active region@footnote{this
8199 requires @code{transient-mark-mode} to be turned on}, only the region will be
8200 exported. If the selected region is a single tree@footnote{To select the
8201 current subtree, use @kbd{C-c @@}.}, the tree head will become the document
8202 title. If the tree head entry has or inherits an @code{EXPORT_FILE_NAME}
8203 property, that name will be used for the export.
8204 @kindex C-c C-e L
8205 @item C-c C-e L
8206 Export to a temporary buffer, do not create a file.
8207 @kindex C-c C-e v l
8208 @kindex C-c C-e v L
8209 @item C-c C-e v l
8210 @item C-c C-e v L
8211 Export only the visible part of the document.
8212 @item M-x org-export-region-as-latex
8213 Convert the region to La@TeX{} under the assumption that it was Org mode
8214 syntax before. This is a global command that can be invoked in any
8215 buffer.
8216 @item M-x org-replace-region-by-latex
8217 Replace the active region (assumed to be in Org mode syntax) by La@TeX{}
8218 code.
8219 @kindex C-c C-e p
8220 @item C-c C-e p
8221 Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF.
8222 @kindex C-c C-e d
8223 @item C-c C-e d
8224 Export as LaTeX and then process to PDF, then open the resulting PDF file.
8225 @end table
8226
8227 @cindex headline levels, for exporting
8228 In the exported version, the first 3 outline levels will become
8229 headlines, defining a general document structure. Additional levels
8230 will be exported as description lists. The exporter can ignore them or
8231 convert them to a custom string depending on
8232 @code{org-latex-low-levels}.
8233
8234 If you want that transition to occur at a different level, specify it
8235 with a numeric prefix argument. For example,
8236
8237 @example
8238 @kbd{C-2 C-c C-e l}
8239 @end example
8240
8241 @noindent
8242 creates two levels of headings and does the rest as items.
8243
8244 @node Quoting LaTeX code, Sectioning structure, LaTeX/PDF export commands, LaTeX and PDF export
8245 @subsection Quoting LaTeX code
8246
8247 Embedded La@TeX{} as described in @ref{Embedded LaTeX} will be correctly
8248 inserted into the La@TeX{} file. This includes simple macros like
8249 @samp{\ref@{LABEL@}} to create a cross reference to a figure. Furthermore,
8250 you can add special code that should only be present in La@TeX{} export with
8251 the following constructs:
8252
8253 @example
8254 #+LaTeX: Literal LaTeX code for export
8255 @end example
8256
8257 @noindent or
8258 @cindex #+BEGIN_LaTeX
8259
8260 @example
8261 #+BEGIN_LaTeX
8262 All lines between these markers are exported literally
8263 #+END_LaTeX
8264 @end example
8265
8266 @node Sectioning structure, Tables in LaTeX export, Quoting LaTeX code, LaTeX and PDF export
8267 @subsection Sectioning structure
8268 @cindex LaTeX class
8269 @cindex LaTeX sectioning structure
8270
8271 By default, the La@TeX{} output uses the class @code{article}.
8272
8273 You can change this globally by setting a different value for
8274 @code{org-export-latex-default-class} or locally by adding an option like
8275 @code{#+LaTeX_CLASS: myclass} in your file, or with a @code{:LaTeX_CLASS:}
8276 property that applies when exporting a region containing only this (sub)tree.
8277 The class should be listed in @code{org-export-latex-classes}, where you can
8278 also define the sectioning structure for each class, as well as defining
8279 additional classes.
8280
8281 @node Tables in LaTeX export, Images in LaTeX export, Sectioning structure, LaTeX and PDF export
8282 @subsection Tables in LaTeX export
8283 @cindex tables, in LaTeX export
8284
8285 For LaTeX export of a table, you can specify a label and a caption
8286 (@pxref{Markup rules}). You can also use the @code{ATTR_LaTeX} line to
8287 request a longtable environment for the table, so that it may span several
8288 pages:
8289
8290 @example
8291 #+CAPTION: A long table
8292 #+LABEL: tbl:long
8293 #+ATTR_LaTeX: longtable
8294 | ..... | ..... |
8295 | ..... | ..... |
8296 @end example
8297
8298
8299 @node Images in LaTeX export, , Tables in LaTeX export, LaTeX and PDF export
8300 @subsection Images in LaTeX export
8301 @cindex images, inline in LaTeX
8302 @cindex inlining images in LaTeX
8303
8304 Images that are linked to without a description part in the link, like
8305 @samp{[[file:img.jpg]]} or @samp{[[./img.jpg]]} will be inserted into the PDF
8306 output files resulting from LaTeX output. Org will use an
8307 @code{\includegraphics} macro to insert the image. If you have specified a
8308 caption and/or a label as described in @ref{Markup rules}, the figure will
8309 be wrapped into a @code{figure} environment and thus become a floating
8310 element. Finally, you can use an @code{#+ATTR_LaTeX:} line to specify the
8311 options that can be used in the optional argument of the
8312 @code{\includegraphics} macro.
8313
8314 @example
8315 #+CAPTION: The black-body emission of the disk around HR 4049
8316 #+LABEL: fig:SED-HR4049
8317 #+ATTR_LaTeX: width=5cm,angle=90
8318 [[./img/sed-hr4049.pdf]]
8319 @end example
8320
8321 If you need references to a label created in this way, write
8322 @samp{\ref@{fig:SED-HR4049@}} just like in LaTeX. The default settings will
8323 recognize files types that can be included as images during processing by
8324 pdflatex (@file{png}, @file{jpg}, and @file{pdf} files). If you process your
8325 files in a different way, you may need to customize the variable
8326 @code{org-export-latex-inline-image-extensions}.
8327
8328 @node XOXO export, iCalendar export, LaTeX and PDF export, Exporting
8329 @section XOXO export
8330 @cindex XOXO export
8331
8332 Org mode contains an exporter that produces XOXO-style output.
8333 Currently, this exporter only handles the general outline structure and
8334 does not interpret any additional Org mode features.
8335
8336 @table @kbd
8337 @kindex C-c C-e x
8338 @item C-c C-e x
8339 Export as XOXO file @file{myfile.html}.
8340 @kindex C-c C-e v
8341 @item C-c C-e v x
8342 Export only the visible part of the document.
8343 @end table
8344
8345 @node iCalendar export, , XOXO export, Exporting
8346 @section iCalendar export
8347 @cindex iCalendar export
8348
8349 Some people like to use Org mode for keeping track of projects, but still
8350 prefer a standard calendar application for anniversaries and appointments.
8351 In this case it can be useful to have deadlines and other time-stamped items
8352 in Org files show up in the calendar application. Org mode can export
8353 calendar information in the standard iCalendar format. If you also want to
8354 have TODO entries included in the export, configure the variable
8355 @code{org-icalendar-include-todo}. iCalendar export will export plain time
8356 stamps as VEVENT, and TODO items as VTODO. It will also create events from
8357 deadlines that are in non-TODO items. Deadlines and scheduling dates in TODO
8358 items will be used to set the start and due dates for the todo
8359 entry@footnote{See the variables @code{org-icalendar-use-deadline} and
8360 @code{org-icalendar-use-scheduled}.}. As categories, it will use the tags
8361 locally defined in the heading, and the file/tree category@footnote{To add
8362 inherited tags or the TODO state, configure the variable
8363 @code{org-icalendar-categories}.}.
8364
8365 The iCalendar standard requires each entry to have a globally unique
8366 identifier (UID). Org creates these identifiers during export. If you set
8367 the variable @code{org-icalendar-store-UID}, the UID will be stored in the
8368 @code{:ID:} property of the entry and re-used next time you report this
8369 entry. Since a single entry can give rise to multiple iCalendar entries (as
8370 a timestamp, a deadline, a scheduled item, and as a TODO item), Org adds
8371 prefixes to the UID, depending on what triggered the inclusion of the entry.
8372 In this way the UID remains unique, but a synchronization program can still
8373 figure out from which entry all the different instances originate.
8374
8375 @table @kbd
8376 @kindex C-c C-e i
8377 @item C-c C-e i
8378 Create iCalendar entries for the current file and store them in the same
8379 directory, using a file extension @file{.ics}.
8380 @kindex C-c C-e I
8381 @item C-c C-e I
8382 Like @kbd{C-c C-e i}, but do this for all files in
8383 @code{org-agenda-files}. For each of these files, a separate iCalendar
8384 file will be written.
8385 @kindex C-c C-e c
8386 @item C-c C-e c
8387 Create a single large iCalendar file from all files in
8388 @code{org-agenda-files} and write it to the file given by
8389 @code{org-combined-agenda-icalendar-file}.
8390 @end table
8391
8392 The export will honor SUMMARY, DESCRIPTION and LOCATION@footnote{The LOCATION
8393 property can be inherited from higher in the hierarchy if you configure
8394 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} accordingly.} properties if the selected
8395 entries have them. If not, the summary will be derived from the headline,
8396 and the description from the body (limited to
8397 @code{org-icalendar-include-body} characters).
8398
8399 How this calendar is best read and updated, that depends on the application
8400 you are using. The FAQ covers this issue.
8401
8402 @node Publishing, Miscellaneous, Exporting, Top
8403 @chapter Publishing
8404 @cindex publishing
8405
8406 Org includes@footnote{@file{org-publish.el} is not distributed with
8407 Emacs 21, if you are still using Emacs 21, you need you need to download
8408 this file separately.} a publishing management system that allows you to
8409 configure automatic HTML conversion of @emph{projects} composed of
8410 interlinked org files. This system is called @emph{org-publish}. You can
8411 also configure org-publish to automatically upload your exported HTML
8412 pages and related attachments, such as images and source code files, to
8413 a web server. Org-publish turns Org into a web-site authoring tool.
8414
8415 You can also use Org-publish to convert files into La@TeX{}, or even
8416 combine HTML and La@TeX{} conversion so that files are available in both
8417 formats on the server@footnote{Since La@TeX{} files on a server are not
8418 that helpful, you surely want to perform further conversion on them --
8419 e.g. convert them to @code{PDF} format.}.
8420
8421 Org-publish has been contributed to Org by David O'Toole.
8422
8423 @menu
8424 * Configuration:: Defining projects
8425 * Sample configuration:: Example projects
8426 * Triggering publication:: Publication commands
8427 @end menu
8428
8429 @node Configuration, Sample configuration, Publishing, Publishing
8430 @section Configuration
8431
8432 Publishing needs significant configuration to specify files, destination
8433 and many other properties of a project.
8434
8435 @menu
8436 * Project alist:: The central configuration variable
8437 * Sources and destinations:: From here to there
8438 * Selecting files:: What files are part of the project?
8439 * Publishing action:: Setting the function doing the publishing
8440 * Publishing options:: Tweaking HTML export
8441 * Publishing links:: Which links keep working after publishing?
8442 * Project page index:: Publishing a list of project files
8443 @end menu
8444
8445 @node Project alist, Sources and destinations, Configuration, Configuration
8446 @subsection The variable @code{org-publish-project-alist}
8447 @cindex org-publish-project-alist
8448 @cindex projects, for publishing
8449
8450 Org-publish is configured almost entirely through setting the value of
8451 one variable, called @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
8452 Each element of the list configures one project, and may be in one of
8453 the two following forms:
8454
8455 @lisp
8456 ("project-name" :property value :property value ...)
8457
8458 @r{or}
8459
8460 ("project-name" :components ("project-name" "project-name" ...))
8461
8462 @end lisp
8463
8464 In both cases, projects are configured by specifying property values.
8465 A project defines the set of files that will be published, as well as
8466 the publishing configuration to use when publishing those files. When
8467 a project takes the second form listed above, the individual members
8468 of the ``components'' property are taken to be components of the
8469 project, which group together files requiring different publishing
8470 options. When you publish such a ``meta-project'' all the components
8471 will also publish. The @code{:components} are published in the sequence
8472 provided.
8473
8474 @node Sources and destinations, Selecting files, Project alist, Configuration
8475 @subsection Sources and destinations for files
8476 @cindex directories, for publishing
8477
8478 Most properties are optional, but some should always be set. In
8479 particular, org-publish needs to know where to look for source files,
8480 and where to put published files.
8481
8482 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
8483 @item @code{:base-directory}
8484 @tab Directory containing publishing source files
8485 @item @code{:publishing-directory}
8486 @tab Directory (possibly remote) where output files will be published.
8487 @item @code{:preparation-function}
8488 @tab Function called before starting the publishing process, for example to
8489 run @code{make} for updating files to be published.
8490 @item @code{:completion-function}
8491 @tab Function called after finishing the publishing process, for example to
8492 change permissions of the resulting files.
8493 @end multitable
8494 @noindent
8495
8496 @node Selecting files, Publishing action, Sources and destinations, Configuration
8497 @subsection Selecting files
8498 @cindex files, selecting for publishing
8499
8500 By default, all files with extension @file{.org} in the base directory
8501 are considered part of the project. This can be modified by setting the
8502 properties
8503 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
8504 @item @code{:base-extension}
8505 @tab Extension (without the dot!) of source files. This actually is a
8506 regular expression.
8507
8508 @item @code{:exclude}
8509 @tab Regular expression to match file names that should not be
8510 published, even though they have been selected on the basis of their
8511 extension.
8512
8513 @item @code{:include}
8514 @tab List of files to be included regardless of @code{:base-extension}
8515 and @code{:exclude}.
8516 @end multitable
8517
8518 @node Publishing action, Publishing options, Selecting files, Configuration
8519 @subsection Publishing action
8520 @cindex action, for publishing
8521
8522 Publishing means that a file is copied to the destination directory and
8523 possibly transformed in the process. The default transformation is to export
8524 Org files as HTML files, and this is done by the function
8525 @code{org-publish-org-to-html} which calls the HTML exporter (@pxref{HTML
8526 export}). But you also can publish your files in La@TeX{} by using the
8527 function @code{org-publish-org-to-latex} instead, or as PDF files using
8528 @code{org-publish-org-to-pdf}. Other files like images only need to be
8529 copied to the publishing destination. For non-Org files, you need to provide
8530 your own publishing function:
8531
8532 @multitable @columnfractions 0.3 0.7
8533 @item @code{:publishing-function}
8534 @tab Function executing the publication of a file. This may also be a
8535 list of functions, which will all be called in turn.
8536 @end multitable
8537
8538 The function must accept two arguments: a property list containing at
8539 least a @code{:publishing-directory} property, and the name of the file
8540 to be published. It should take the specified file, make the necessary
8541 transformation (if any) and place the result into the destination folder.
8542 You can write your own publishing function, but @code{org-publish}
8543 provides one for attachments (files that only need to be copied):
8544 @code{org-publish-attachment}.
8545
8546 @node Publishing options, Publishing links, Publishing action, Configuration
8547 @subsection Options for the HTML/LaTeX exporters
8548 @cindex options, for publishing
8549
8550 The property list can be used to set many export options for the HTML
8551 and La@TeX{} exporters. In most cases, these properties correspond to user
8552 variables in Org. The table below lists these properties along
8553 with the variable they belong to. See the documentation string for the
8554 respective variable for details.
8555
8556 @multitable @columnfractions 0.32 0.68
8557 @item @code{:link-up} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-up}
8558 @item @code{:link-home} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-home}
8559 @item @code{:language} @tab @code{org-export-default-language}
8560 @item @code{:customtime} @tab @code{org-display-custom-times}
8561 @item @code{:headline-levels} @tab @code{org-export-headline-levels}
8562 @item @code{:section-numbers} @tab @code{org-export-with-section-numbers}
8563 @item @code{:section-number-format} @tab @code{org-export-section-number-format}
8564 @item @code{:table-of-contents} @tab @code{org-export-with-toc}
8565 @item @code{:preserve-breaks} @tab @code{org-export-preserve-breaks}
8566 @item @code{:archived-trees} @tab @code{org-export-with-archived-trees}
8567 @item @code{:emphasize} @tab @code{org-export-with-emphasize}
8568 @item @code{:sub-superscript} @tab @code{org-export-with-sub-superscripts}
8569 @item @code{:special-strings} @tab @code{org-export-with-special-strings}
8570 @item @code{:footnotes} @tab @code{org-export-with-footnotes}
8571 @item @code{:drawers} @tab @code{org-export-with-drawers}
8572 @item @code{:tags} @tab @code{org-export-with-tags}
8573 @item @code{:todo-keywords} @tab @code{org-export-with-todo-keywords}
8574 @item @code{:priority} @tab @code{org-export-with-priority}
8575 @item @code{:TeX-macros} @tab @code{org-export-with-TeX-macros}
8576 @item @code{:LaTeX-fragments} @tab @code{org-export-with-LaTeX-fragments}
8577 @item @code{:skip-before-1st-heading} @tab @code{org-export-skip-text-before-1st-heading}
8578 @item @code{:fixed-width} @tab @code{org-export-with-fixed-width}
8579 @item @code{:timestamps} @tab @code{org-export-with-timestamps}
8580 @item @code{:author-info} @tab @code{org-export-author-info}
8581 @item @code{:creator-info} @tab @code{org-export-creator-info}
8582 @item @code{:tables} @tab @code{org-export-with-tables}
8583 @item @code{:table-auto-headline} @tab @code{org-export-highlight-first-table-line}
8584 @item @code{:style-include-default} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-include-default}
8585 @item @code{:style} @tab @code{org-export-html-style}
8586 @item @code{:style-extra} @tab @code{org-export-html-style-extra}
8587 @item @code{:convert-org-links} @tab @code{org-export-html-link-org-files-as-html}
8588 @item @code{:inline-images} @tab @code{org-export-html-inline-images}
8589 @item @code{:html-extension} @tab @code{org-export-html-extension}
8590 @item @code{:html-table-tag} @tab @code{org-export-html-table-tag}
8591 @item @code{:expand-quoted-html} @tab @code{org-export-html-expand}
8592 @item @code{:timestamp} @tab @code{org-export-html-with-timestamp}
8593 @item @code{:publishing-directory} @tab @code{org-export-publishing-directory}
8594 @item @code{:preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-preamble}
8595 @item @code{:postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-postamble}
8596 @item @code{:auto-preamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-preamble}
8597 @item @code{:auto-postamble} @tab @code{org-export-html-auto-postamble}
8598 @item @code{:author} @tab @code{user-full-name}
8599 @item @code{:email} @tab @code{user-mail-address}
8600 @item @code{:select-tags} @tab @code{org-export-select-tags}
8601 @item @code{:exclude-tags} @tab @code{org-export-exclude-tags}
8602 @end multitable
8603
8604 If you use several email addresses, separate them by a semi-column.
8605
8606 Most of the @code{org-export-with-*} variables have the same effect in
8607 both HTML and La@TeX{} exporters, except for @code{:TeX-macros} and
8608 @code{:LaTeX-fragments}, respectively @code{nil} and @code{t} in the
8609 La@TeX{} export.
8610
8611 When a property is given a value in @code{org-publish-project-alist},
8612 its setting overrides the value of the corresponding user variable (if
8613 any) during publishing. Options set within a file (@pxref{Export
8614 options}), however, override everything.
8615
8616 @node Publishing links, Project page index, Publishing options, Configuration
8617 @subsection Links between published files
8618 @cindex links, publishing
8619
8620 To create a link from one Org file to another, you would use
8621 something like @samp{[[file:foo.org][The foo]]} or simply
8622 @samp{file:foo.org.} (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). Upon publishing this link
8623 becomes a link to @file{foo.html}. In this way, you can interlink the
8624 pages of your "org web" project and the links will work as expected when
8625 you publish them to HTML.
8626
8627 You may also link to related files, such as images. Provided you are
8628 careful with relative pathnames, and provided you have also configured
8629 @code{org-publish} to upload the related files, these links will work
8630 too. See @ref{Complex example} for an example of this usage.
8631
8632 Sometime an Org file to be published may contain links that are
8633 only valid in your production environment, but not in the publishing
8634 location. In this case, use the property
8635
8636 @multitable @columnfractions 0.4 0.6
8637 @item @code{:link-validation-function}
8638 @tab Function to validate links
8639 @end multitable
8640
8641 @noindent
8642 to define a function for checking link validity. This function must
8643 accept two arguments, the file name and a directory relative to which
8644 the file name is interpreted in the production environment. If this
8645 function returns @code{nil}, then the HTML generator will only insert a
8646 description into the HTML file, but no link. One option for this
8647 function is @code{org-publish-validate-link} which checks if the given
8648 file is part of any project in @code{org-publish-project-alist}.
8649
8650 @node Project page index, , Publishing links, Configuration
8651 @subsection Project page index
8652 @cindex index, of published pages
8653
8654 The following properties may be used to control publishing of an
8655 index of files or summary page for a given project.
8656
8657 @multitable @columnfractions 0.25 0.75
8658 @item @code{:auto-index}
8659 @tab When non-nil, publish an index during org-publish-current-project or
8660 org-publish-all.
8661
8662 @item @code{:index-filename}
8663 @tab Filename for output of index. Defaults to @file{index.org} (which
8664 becomes @file{index.html}).
8665
8666 @item @code{:index-title}
8667 @tab Title of index page. Defaults to name of file.
8668
8669 @item @code{:index-function}
8670 @tab Plug-in function to use for generation of index.
8671 Defaults to @code{org-publish-org-index}, which generates a plain list
8672 of links to all files in the project.
8673 @end multitable
8674
8675 @node Sample configuration, Triggering publication, Configuration, Publishing
8676 @section Sample configuration
8677
8678 Below we provide two example configurations. The first one is a simple
8679 project publishing only a set of Org files. The second example is
8680 more complex, with a multi-component project.
8681
8682 @menu
8683 * Simple example:: One-component publishing
8684 * Complex example:: A multi-component publishing example
8685 @end menu
8686
8687 @node Simple example, Complex example, Sample configuration, Sample configuration
8688 @subsection Example: simple publishing configuration
8689
8690 This example publishes a set of Org files to the @file{public_html}
8691 directory on the local machine.
8692
8693 @lisp
8694 (setq org-publish-project-alist
8695 '(("org"
8696 :base-directory "~/org/"
8697 :publishing-directory "~/public_html"
8698 :section-numbers nil
8699 :table-of-contents nil
8700 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
8701 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\"
8702 type=\"text/css\">")))
8703 @end lisp
8704
8705 @node Complex example, , Simple example, Sample configuration
8706 @subsection Example: complex publishing configuration
8707
8708 This more complicated example publishes an entire website, including
8709 org files converted to HTML, image files, emacs lisp source code, and
8710 style sheets. The publishing-directory is remote and private files are
8711 excluded.
8712
8713 To ensure that links are preserved, care should be taken to replicate
8714 your directory structure on the web server, and to use relative file
8715 paths. For example, if your org files are kept in @file{~/org} and your
8716 publishable images in @file{~/images}, you'd link to an image with
8717 @c
8718 @example
8719 file:../images/myimage.png
8720 @end example
8721 @c
8722 On the web server, the relative path to the image should be the
8723 same. You can accomplish this by setting up an "images" folder in the
8724 right place on the web server, and publishing images to it.
8725
8726 @lisp
8727 (setq org-publish-project-alist
8728 '(("orgfiles"
8729 :base-directory "~/org/"
8730 :base-extension "org"
8731 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/notebook/"
8732 :publishing-function org-publish-org-to-html
8733 :exclude "PrivatePage.org" ;; regexp
8734 :headline-levels 3
8735 :section-numbers nil
8736 :table-of-contents nil
8737 :style "<link rel=\"stylesheet\"
8738 href=\"../other/mystyle.css\" type=\"text/css\">"
8739 :auto-preamble t
8740 :auto-postamble nil)
8741
8742 ("images"
8743 :base-directory "~/images/"
8744 :base-extension "jpg\\|gif\\|png"
8745 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/images/"
8746 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
8747
8748 ("other"
8749 :base-directory "~/other/"
8750 :base-extension "css\\|el"
8751 :publishing-directory "/ssh:user@@host:~/html/other/"
8752 :publishing-function org-publish-attachment)
8753 ("website" :components ("orgfiles" "images" "other"))))
8754 @end lisp
8755
8756 @node Triggering publication, , Sample configuration, Publishing
8757 @section Triggering publication
8758
8759 Once org-publish is properly configured, you can publish with the
8760 following functions:
8761
8762 @table @kbd
8763 @item C-c C-e C
8764 Prompt for a specific project and publish all files that belong to it.
8765 @item C-c C-e P
8766 Publish the project containing the current file.
8767 @item C-c C-e F
8768 Publish only the current file.
8769 @item C-c C-e A
8770 Publish all projects.
8771 @end table
8772
8773 Org uses timestamps to track when a file has changed. The above
8774 functions normally only publish changed files. You can override this and
8775 force publishing of all files by giving a prefix argument.
8776
8777 @node Miscellaneous, Extensions, Publishing, Top
8778 @chapter Miscellaneous
8779
8780 @menu
8781 * Completion:: M-TAB knows what you need
8782 * Customization:: Adapting Org to your taste
8783 * In-buffer settings:: Overview of the #+KEYWORDS
8784 * The very busy C-c C-c key:: When in doubt, press C-c C-c
8785 * Clean view:: Getting rid of leading stars in the outline
8786 * TTY keys:: Using Org on a tty
8787 * Interaction:: Other Emacs packages
8788 * Bugs:: Things which do not work perfectly
8789 @end menu
8790
8791 @node Completion, Customization, Miscellaneous, Miscellaneous
8792 @section Completion
8793 @cindex completion, of @TeX{} symbols
8794 @cindex completion, of TODO keywords
8795 @cindex completion, of dictionary words
8796 @cindex completion, of option keywords
8797 @cindex completion, of tags
8798 @cindex completion, of property keys
8799 @cindex completion, of link abbreviations
8800 @cindex @TeX{} symbol completion
8801 @cindex TODO keywords completion
8802 @cindex dictionary word completion
8803 @cindex option keyword completion
8804 @cindex tag completion
8805 @cindex link abbreviations, completion of
8806
8807 Org supports in-buffer completion. This type of completion does
8808 not make use of the minibuffer. You simply type a few letters into
8809 the buffer and use the key to complete text right there.
8810
8811 @table @kbd
8812 @kindex M-@key{TAB}
8813 @item M-@key{TAB}
8814 Complete word at point
8815 @itemize @bullet
8816 @item
8817 At the beginning of a headline, complete TODO keywords.
8818 @item
8819 After @samp{\}, complete @TeX{} symbols supported by the exporter.
8820 @item
8821 After @samp{*}, complete headlines in the current buffer so that they
8822 can be used in search links like @samp{[[*find this headline]]}.
8823 @item
8824 After @samp{:} in a headline, complete tags. The list of tags is taken
8825 from the variable @code{org-tag-alist} (possibly set through the
8826 @samp{#+TAGS} in-buffer option, @pxref{Setting tags}), or it is created
8827 dynamically from all tags used in the current buffer.
8828 @item
8829 After @samp{:} and not in a headline, complete property keys. The list
8830 of keys is constructed dynamically from all keys used in the current
8831 buffer.
8832 @item
8833 After @samp{[}, complete link abbreviations (@pxref{Link abbreviations}).
8834 @item
8835 After @samp{#+}, complete the special keywords like @samp{TYP_TODO} or
8836 @samp{OPTIONS} which set file-specific options for Org mode. When the
8837 option keyword is already complete, pressing @kbd{M-@key{TAB}} again
8838 will insert example settings for this keyword.
8839 @item
8840 In the line after @samp{#+STARTUP: }, complete startup keywords,
8841 i.e. valid keys for this line.
8842 @item
8843 Elsewhere, complete dictionary words using Ispell.
8844 @end itemize
8845 @end table
8846
8847 @node Customization, In-buffer settings, Completion, Miscellaneous
8848 @section Customization
8849 @cindex customization
8850 @cindex options, for customization
8851 @cindex variables, for customization
8852
8853 There are more than 180 variables that can be used to customize
8854 Org. For the sake of compactness of the manual, I am not
8855 describing the variables here. A structured overview of customization
8856 variables is available with @kbd{M-x org-customize}. Or select
8857 @code{Browse Org Group} from the @code{Org->Customization} menu. Many
8858 settings can also be activated on a per-file basis, by putting special
8859 lines into the buffer (@pxref{In-buffer settings}).
8860
8861 @node In-buffer settings, The very busy C-c C-c key, Customization, Miscellaneous
8862 @section Summary of in-buffer settings
8863 @cindex in-buffer settings
8864 @cindex special keywords
8865
8866 Org mode uses special lines in the buffer to define settings on a
8867 per-file basis. These lines start with a @samp{#+} followed by a
8868 keyword, a colon, and then individual words defining a setting. Several
8869 setting words can be in the same line, but you can also have multiple
8870 lines for the keyword. While these settings are described throughout
8871 the manual, here is a summary. After changing any of those lines in the
8872 buffer, press @kbd{C-c C-c} with the cursor still in the line to
8873 activate the changes immediately. Otherwise they become effective only
8874 when the file is visited again in a new Emacs session.
8875
8876 @table @kbd
8877 @item #+ARCHIVE: %s_done::
8878 This line sets the archive location for the agenda file. It applies for
8879 all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+ARCHIVE} line, or the end
8880 of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
8881 The corresponding variable is @code{org-archive-location}.
8882 @item #+CATEGORY:
8883 This line sets the category for the agenda file. The category applies
8884 for all subsequent lines until the next @samp{#+CATEGORY} line, or the
8885 end of the file. The first such line also applies to any entries before it.
8886 @item #+COLUMNS: %25ITEM .....
8887 Set the default format for columns view. This format applies when
8888 columns view is invoked in location where no @code{COLUMNS} property
8889 applies.
8890 @item #+CONSTANTS: name1=value1 ...
8891 Set file-local values for constants to be used in table formulas. This
8892 line set the local variable @code{org-table-formula-constants-local}.
8893 The global version of this variable is
8894 @code{org-table-formula-constants}.
8895 @item #+FILETAGS: :tag1:tag2:tag3:
8896 Set tags that can be inherited by any entry in the file, including the
8897 top-level entries.
8898 @item #+DRAWERS: NAME1 .....
8899 Set the file-local set of drawers. The corresponding global variable is
8900 @code{org-drawers}.
8901 @item #+LINK: linkword replace
8902 These lines (several are allowed) specify link abbreviations.
8903 @xref{Link abbreviations}. The corresponding variable is
8904 @code{org-link-abbrev-alist}.
8905 @item #+PRIORITIES: highest lowest default
8906 This line sets the limits and the default for the priorities. All three
8907 must be either letters A-Z or numbers 0-9. The highest priority must
8908 have a lower ASCII number that the lowest priority.
8909 @item #+PROPERTY: Property_Name Value
8910 This line sets a default inheritance value for entries in the current
8911 buffer, most useful for specifying the allowed values of a property.
8912 @item #+SETUPFILE: file
8913 This line defines a file that holds more in-buffer setup. Normally this is
8914 entirely ignored. Only when the buffer is parsed for option-setting lines
8915 (i.e. when starting Org mode for a file, when pressing @kbd{C-c C-c} in a
8916 settings line, or when exporting), then the contents of this file are parsed
8917 as if they had been included in the buffer. In particular, the file can be
8918 any other Org mode file with internal setup. You can visit the file the
8919 cursor is in the line with @kbd{C-c '}.
8920 @item #+STARTUP:
8921 This line sets options to be used at startup of Org mode, when an
8922 Org file is being visited. The first set of options deals with the
8923 initial visibility of the outline tree. The corresponding variable for
8924 global default settings is @code{org-startup-folded}, with a default
8925 value @code{t}, which means @code{overview}.
8926 @cindex @code{overview}, STARTUP keyword
8927 @cindex @code{content}, STARTUP keyword
8928 @cindex @code{showall}, STARTUP keyword
8929 @example
8930 overview @r{top-level headlines only}
8931 content @r{all headlines}
8932 showall @r{no folding at all, show everything}
8933 @end example
8934 Then there are options for aligning tables upon visiting a file. This
8935 is useful in files containing narrowed table columns. The corresponding
8936 variable is @code{org-startup-align-all-tables}, with a default value
8937 @code{nil}.
8938 @cindex @code{align}, STARTUP keyword
8939 @cindex @code{noalign}, STARTUP keyword
8940 @example
8941 align @r{align all tables}
8942 noalign @r{don't align tables on startup}
8943 @end example
8944 Logging closing and reinstating TODO items, and clock intervals
8945 (variables @code{org-log-done}, @code{org-log-note-clock-out}, and
8946 @code{org-log-repeat}) can be configured using these options.
8947 @cindex @code{logdone}, STARTUP keyword
8948 @cindex @code{lognotedone}, STARTUP keyword
8949 @cindex @code{nologdone}, STARTUP keyword
8950 @cindex @code{lognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
8951 @cindex @code{nolognoteclock-out}, STARTUP keyword
8952 @cindex @code{logrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
8953 @cindex @code{lognoterepeat}, STARTUP keyword
8954 @cindex @code{nologrepeat}, STARTUP keyword
8955 @example
8956 logdone @r{record a timestamp when an item is marked DONE}
8957 lognotedone @r{record timestamp and a note when DONE}
8958 nologdone @r{don't record when items are marked DONE}
8959 logrepeat @r{record a time when reinstating a repeating item}
8960 lognoterepeat @r{record a note when reinstating a repeating item}
8961 nologrepeat @r{do not record when reinstating repeating item}
8962 lognoteclock-out @r{record a note when clocking out}
8963 nolognoteclock-out @r{don't record a note when clocking out}
8964 @end example
8965 Here are the options for hiding leading stars in outline headings, and for
8966 indenting outlines. The corresponding variables are
8967 @code{org-hide-leading-stars} and @code{org-odd-levels-only}, both with a
8968 default setting @code{nil} (meaning @code{showstars} and @code{oddeven}).
8969 @cindex @code{hidestars}, STARTUP keyword
8970 @cindex @code{showstars}, STARTUP keyword
8971 @cindex @code{odd}, STARTUP keyword
8972 @cindex @code{even}, STARTUP keyword
8973 @example
8974 hidestars @r{make all but one of the stars starting a headline invisible.}
8975 showstars @r{show all stars starting a headline}
8976 indent @r{virtual indentation according to outline level}
8977 noindent @r{no virtual indentation according to outline level}
8978 odd @r{allow only odd outline levels (1,3,...)}
8979 oddeven @r{allow all outline levels}
8980 @end example
8981 To turn on custom format overlays over time stamps (variables
8982 @code{org-put-time-stamp-overlays} and
8983 @code{org-time-stamp-overlay-formats}), use
8984 @cindex @code{customtime}, STARTUP keyword
8985 @example
8986 customtime @r{overlay custom time format}
8987 @end example
8988 The following options influence the table spreadsheet (variable
8989 @code{constants-unit-system}).
8990 @cindex @code{constcgs}, STARTUP keyword
8991 @cindex @code{constSI}, STARTUP keyword
8992 @example
8993 constcgs @r{@file{constants.el} should use the c-g-s unit system}
8994 constSI @r{@file{constants.el} should use the SI unit system}
8995 @end example
8996 To influence footnote settings, use the following keywords. The
8997 corresponding variables are @code{org-footnote-define-inline} and
8998 @code{org-footnote-auto-label}.
8999 @cindex @code{fninline}, STARTUP keyword
9000 @cindex @code{fnnoinline}, STARTUP keyword
9001 @cindex @code{fnlocal}, STARTUP keyword
9002 @cindex @code{fnprompt}, STARTUP keyword
9003 @cindex @code{fnauto}, STARTUP keyword
9004 @cindex @code{fnconfirm}, STARTUP keyword
9005 @cindex @code{fnplain}, STARTUP keyword
9006 @example
9007 fninline @r{define footnotes inline}
9008 fnnoinline @r{define footnotes in separate section}
9009 fnlocal @r{define footnotes near first reference, but not inline}
9010 fnprompt @r{prompt for footnote labels}
9011 fnauto @r{create [fn:1]-like labels automatically (default)}
9012 fnconfirm @r{offer automatic label for editing or confirmation}
9013 fnplain @r{create [1]-like labels automatically}
9014 @end example
9015 @item #+TAGS: TAG1(c1) TAG2(c2)
9016 These lines (several such lines are allowed) specify the valid tags in
9017 this file, and (potentially) the corresponding @emph{fast tag selection}
9018 keys. The corresponding variable is @code{org-tag-alist}.
9019 @item #+TBLFM:
9020 This line contains the formulas for the table directly above the line.
9021 @item #+TITLE:, #+AUTHOR:, #+EMAIL:, #+LANGUAGE:, #+TEXT:, #+OPTIONS, #+DATE:
9022 These lines provide settings for exporting files. For more details see
9023 @ref{Export options}.
9024 @item #+SEQ_TODO: #+TYP_TODO:
9025 These lines set the TODO keywords and their interpretation in the
9026 current file. The corresponding variables are @code{org-todo-keywords}
9027 and @code{org-todo-interpretation}.
9028 @end table
9029
9030 @node The very busy C-c C-c key, Clean view, In-buffer settings, Miscellaneous
9031 @section The very busy C-c C-c key
9032 @kindex C-c C-c
9033 @cindex C-c C-c, overview
9034
9035 The key @kbd{C-c C-c} has many purposes in Org, which are all
9036 mentioned scattered throughout this manual. One specific function of
9037 this key is to add @emph{tags} to a headline (@pxref{Tags}). In many
9038 other circumstances it means something like @emph{Hey Org, look
9039 here and update according to what you see here}. Here is a summary of
9040 what this means in different contexts.
9041
9042 @itemize @minus
9043 @item
9044 If there are highlights in the buffer from the creation of a sparse
9045 tree, or from clock display, remove these highlights.
9046 @item
9047 If the cursor is in one of the special @code{#+KEYWORD} lines, this
9048 triggers scanning the buffer for these lines and updating the
9049 information.
9050 @item
9051 If the cursor is inside a table, realign the table. This command
9052 works even if the automatic table editor has been turned off.
9053 @item
9054 If the cursor is on a @code{#+TBLFM} line, re-apply the formulas to
9055 the entire table.
9056 @item
9057 If the cursor is inside a table created by the @file{table.el} package,
9058 activate that table.
9059 @item
9060 If the current buffer is a remember buffer, close the note and file it.
9061 With a prefix argument, file it, without further interaction, to the
9062 default location.
9063 @item
9064 If the cursor is on a @code{<<<target>>>}, update radio targets and
9065 corresponding links in this buffer.
9066 @item
9067 If the cursor is in a property line or at the start or end of a property
9068 drawer, offer property commands.
9069 @item
9070 If the cursor is at a footnote reference, go to the corresponding
9071 definition, and vice versa.
9072 @item
9073 If the cursor is in a plain list item with a checkbox, toggle the status
9074 of the checkbox.
9075 @item
9076 If the cursor is on a numbered item in a plain list, renumber the
9077 ordered list.
9078 @item
9079 If the cursor is on the @code{#+BEGIN} line of a dynamical block, the
9080 block is updated.
9081 @end itemize
9082
9083 @node Clean view, TTY keys, The very busy C-c C-c key, Miscellaneous
9084 @section A cleaner outline view
9085 @cindex hiding leading stars
9086 @cindex dynamic indentation
9087 @cindex odd-levels-only outlines
9088 @cindex clean outline view
9089
9090 Some people find it noisy and distracting that the Org headlines are starting
9091 with a potentially large number of stars, and that text below the headlines
9092 is not indented. This is not really a problem when you are writing a book
9093 where the outline headings are really section headlines. However, in a more
9094 list-oriented outline, it is clear that an indented structure is a lot
9095 cleaner, as can be seen by comparing the two columns in the following
9096 example:
9097
9098 @example
9099 @group
9100 * Top level headline | * Top level headline
9101 ** Second level | * Second level
9102 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
9103 some text | some text
9104 *** 3rd level | * 3rd level
9105 more text | more text
9106 * Another top level headline | * Another top level headline
9107 @end group
9108 @end example
9109
9110 @noindent
9111 It is non-trivial to make such a look work in Emacs, but Org contains three
9112 separate features that, combined, achieve just that.
9113
9114 @enumerate
9115 @item
9116 @emph{Indentation of text below headlines}@*
9117 You may indent text below each headline to make the left boundary line up
9118 with the headline, like
9119
9120 @example
9121 *** 3rd level
9122 more text, now indented
9123 @end example
9124
9125 A good way to get this indentation is by hand, and Org supports this with
9126 paragraph filling, line wrapping, and structure editing@footnote{See also the
9127 variable @code{org-adapt-indentation}.} preserving or adapting the
9128 indentation appropriate. A different approach would be to have a way to
9129 automatically indent lines according to outline structure by adding overlays
9130 or text properties. But I have not yet found a robust and efficient way to
9131 do this in large files.
9132
9133 @item
9134 @emph{Hiding leading stars}@* You can modify the display in such a way that
9135 all leading stars become invisible. To do this in a global way, configure
9136 the variable @code{org-hide-leading-stars} or change this on a per-file basis
9137 with
9138
9139 @example
9140 #+STARTUP: hidestars
9141 @end example
9142
9143 @noindent
9144 Note that the opposite behavior is selected with @code{showstars}.
9145
9146 With hidden stars, the tree becomes:
9147
9148 @example
9149 @group
9150 * Top level headline
9151 * Second level
9152 * 3rd level
9153 ...
9154 @end group
9155 @end example
9156
9157 @noindent
9158 Note that the leading stars are not truly replaced by whitespace, they
9159 are only fontified with the face @code{org-hide} that uses the
9160 background color as font color. If you are not using either white or
9161 black background, you may have to customize this face to get the wanted
9162 effect. Another possibility is to set this font such that the extra
9163 stars are @i{almost} invisible, for example using the color
9164 @code{grey90} on a white background.
9165
9166 @item
9167 Things become cleaner still if you skip all the even levels and use only odd
9168 levels 1, 3, 5..., effectively adding two stars to go from one outline level
9169 to the next. In this way we get the outline view shown at the beginning of
9170 this section. In order to make the structure editing and export commands
9171 handle this convention correctly, configure the variable
9172 @code{org-odd-levels-only}, or set this on a per-file basis with one of the
9173 following lines:
9174
9175 @example
9176 #+STARTUP: odd
9177 #+STARTUP: oddeven
9178 @end example
9179
9180 You can convert an Org file from single-star-per-level to the
9181 double-star-per-level convention with @kbd{M-x org-convert-to-odd-levels
9182 RET} in that file. The reverse operation is @kbd{M-x
9183 org-convert-to-oddeven-levels}.
9184 @end enumerate
9185
9186 @node TTY keys, Interaction, Clean view, Miscellaneous
9187 @section Using Org on a tty
9188 @cindex tty key bindings
9189
9190 Because Org contains a large number of commands, by default much of
9191 Org's core commands are bound to keys that are generally not
9192 accessible on a tty, such as the cursor keys (@key{left}, @key{right},
9193 @key{up}, @key{down}), @key{TAB} and @key{RET}, in particular when used
9194 together with modifiers like @key{Meta} and/or @key{Shift}. To access
9195 these commands on a tty when special keys are unavailable, the following
9196 alternative bindings can be used. The tty bindings below will likely be
9197 more cumbersome; you may find for some of the bindings below that a
9198 customized work-around suits you better. For example, changing a time
9199 stamp is really only fun with @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} keys, whereas on a
9200 tty you would rather use @kbd{C-c .} to re-insert the timestamp.
9201
9202 @multitable @columnfractions 0.15 0.2 0.2
9203 @item @b{Default} @tab @b{Alternative 1} @tab @b{Alternative 2}
9204 @item @kbd{S-@key{TAB}} @tab @kbd{C-u @key{TAB}} @tab
9205 @item @kbd{M-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x l} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{left}}
9206 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x L} @tab
9207 @item @kbd{M-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x i} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{right}}
9208 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x R} @tab
9209 @item @kbd{M-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x u} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{up}}
9210 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x U} @tab
9211 @item @kbd{M-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x d} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{down}}
9212 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x D} @tab
9213 @item @kbd{S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x c} @tab
9214 @item @kbd{M-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x m} @tab @kbd{@key{Esc} @key{RET}}
9215 @item @kbd{M-S-@key{RET}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x M} @tab
9216 @item @kbd{S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{left}} @tab
9217 @item @kbd{S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{right}} @tab
9218 @item @kbd{S-@key{up}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{up}} @tab
9219 @item @kbd{S-@key{down}} @tab @kbd{C-c @key{down}} @tab
9220 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{left}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{left}} @tab
9221 @item @kbd{C-S-@key{right}} @tab @kbd{C-c C-x @key{right}} @tab
9222 @end multitable
9223
9224 @node Interaction, Bugs, TTY keys, Miscellaneous
9225 @section Interaction with other packages
9226 @cindex packages, interaction with other
9227 Org lives in the world of GNU Emacs and interacts in various ways
9228 with other code out there.
9229
9230 @menu
9231 * Cooperation:: Packages Org cooperates with
9232 * Conflicts:: Packages that lead to conflicts
9233 @end menu
9234
9235 @node Cooperation, Conflicts, Interaction, Interaction
9236 @subsection Packages that Org cooperates with
9237
9238 @table @asis
9239 @cindex @file{calc.el}
9240 @item @file{calc.el} by Dave Gillespie
9241 Org uses the Calc package for implementing spreadsheet
9242 functionality in its tables (@pxref{The spreadsheet}). Org
9243 checks for the availability of Calc by looking for the function
9244 @code{calc-eval} which should be autoloaded in your setup if Calc has
9245 been installed properly. As of Emacs 22, Calc is part of the Emacs
9246 distribution. Another possibility for interaction between the two
9247 packages is using Calc for embedded calculations. @xref{Embedded Mode,
9248 , Embedded Mode, Calc, GNU Emacs Calc Manual}.
9249 @cindex @file{constants.el}
9250 @item @file{constants.el} by Carsten Dominik
9251 In a table formula (@pxref{The spreadsheet}), it is possible to use
9252 names for natural constants or units. Instead of defining your own
9253 constants in the variable @code{org-table-formula-constants}, install
9254 the @file{constants} package which defines a large number of constants
9255 and units, and lets you use unit prefixes like @samp{M} for
9256 @samp{Mega} etc. You will need version 2.0 of this package, available
9257 at @url{http://www.astro.uva.nl/~dominik/Tools}. Org checks for
9258 the function @code{constants-get}, which has to be autoloaded in your
9259 setup. See the installation instructions in the file
9260 @file{constants.el}.
9261 @item @file{cdlatex.el} by Carsten Dominik
9262 @cindex @file{cdlatex.el}
9263 Org mode can make use of the CDLaTeX package to efficiently enter
9264 La@TeX{} fragments into Org files. See @ref{CDLaTeX mode}.
9265 @item @file{imenu.el} by Ake Stenhoff and Lars Lindberg
9266 @cindex @file{imenu.el}
9267 Imenu allows menu access to an index of items in a file. Org mode
9268 supports Imenu - all you need to do to get the index is the following:
9269 @lisp
9270 (add-hook 'org-mode-hook
9271 (lambda () (imenu-add-to-menubar "Imenu")))
9272 @end lisp
9273 By default the index is two levels deep - you can modify the depth using
9274 the option @code{org-imenu-depth}.
9275 @item @file{remember.el} by John Wiegley
9276 @cindex @file{remember.el}
9277 Org cooperates with remember, see @ref{Remember}.
9278 @file{Remember.el} is not part of Emacs, find it on the web.
9279 @item @file{speedbar.el} by Eric M. Ludlam
9280 @cindex @file{speedbar.el}
9281 Speedbar is a package that creates a special frame displaying files and
9282 index items in files. Org mode supports Speedbar and allows you to
9283 drill into Org files directly from the Speedbar. It also allows to
9284 restrict the scope of agenda commands to a file or a subtree by using
9285 the command @kbd{<} in the Speedbar frame.
9286 @cindex @file{table.el}
9287 @item @file{table.el} by Takaaki Ota
9288 @kindex C-c C-c
9289 @cindex table editor, @file{table.el}
9290 @cindex @file{table.el}
9291
9292 Complex ASCII tables with automatic line wrapping, column- and
9293 row-spanning, and alignment can be created using the Emacs table
9294 package by Takaaki Ota (@uref{http://sourceforge.net/projects/table},
9295 and also part of Emacs 22).
9296 When @key{TAB} or @kbd{C-c C-c} is pressed in such a table, Org mode
9297 will call @command{table-recognize-table} and move the cursor into the
9298 table. Inside a table, the keymap of Org mode is inactive. In order
9299 to execute Org mode-related commands, leave the table.
9300
9301 @table @kbd
9302 @kindex C-c C-c
9303 @item C-c C-c
9304 Recognize @file{table.el} table. Works when the cursor is in a
9305 table.el table.
9306 @c
9307 @kindex C-c ~
9308 @item C-c ~
9309 Insert a table.el table. If there is already a table at point, this
9310 command converts it between the table.el format and the Org mode
9311 format. See the documentation string of the command
9312 @code{org-convert-table} for the restrictions under which this is
9313 possible.
9314 @end table
9315 @file{table.el} is part of Emacs 22.
9316 @cindex @file{footnote.el}
9317 @item @file{footnote.el} by Steven L. Baur
9318 Org mode recognizes numerical footnotes as provided by this package.
9319 However, Org-mode also has its own footnote support (@pxref{Footnotes}),
9320 which makes using @file{footnote.el} unnecessary.
9321 @end table
9322
9323 @node Conflicts, , Cooperation, Interaction
9324 @subsection Packages that lead to conflicts with Org mode
9325
9326 @table @asis
9327
9328 @cindex @code{shift-selection-mode}
9329 In Emacs 23, @code{shift-selection-mode} is on by default, meaning that
9330 cursor motions combined with the shift key should start or enlarge regions.
9331 This conflicts with the use of @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands in Org to change
9332 timestamps, TODO keywords, priorities, and item bullet types if the cursor is
9333 at such a location. By default, @kbd{S-@key{cursor}} commands outside
9334 special contexts don't do anything, but you can customize the variable
9335 @code{org-support-shift-select}. Org-mode then tries to accommodate shift
9336 selection by (i) using it outside of the special contexts where special
9337 commands apply, and by (ii) extending an existing active region even if the
9338 cursor moves across a special context.
9339
9340 @cindex @file{CUA.el}
9341 @item @file{CUA.el} by Kim. F. Storm
9342 Key bindings in Org conflict with the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys used by CUA mode
9343 (as well as pc-select-mode and s-region-mode) to select and extend the
9344 region. In fact, Emacs 23 has this built-in in the form of
9345 @code{shift-selection-mode}, see previous paragraph. If you are using Emacs
9346 23 you probably don't want to use another package for this purpose. However,
9347 if you prefer to leave these keys to a different package while working in
9348 Org-mode, configure the variable @code{org-replace-disputed-keys}. When set,
9349 Org will move the following key bindings in Org files, and in the agenda
9350 buffer (but not during date selection).
9351
9352 @example
9353 S-UP -> M-p S-DOWN -> M-n
9354 S-LEFT -> M-- S-RIGHT -> M-+
9355 C-S-LEFT -> M-S-- C-S-RIGHT -> M-S-+
9356 @end example
9357
9358 Yes, these are unfortunately more difficult to remember. If you want
9359 to have other replacement keys, look at the variable
9360 @code{org-disputed-keys}.
9361
9362 @item @file{windmove.el} by Hovav Shacham
9363 @cindex @file{windmove.el}
9364 Also this package uses the @kbd{S-<cursor>} keys, so everything written
9365 in the paragraph above about CUA mode also applies here.
9366
9367 @end table
9368
9369
9370 @node Bugs, , Interaction, Miscellaneous
9371 @section Bugs
9372 @cindex bugs
9373
9374 Here is a list of things that should work differently, but which I
9375 have found too hard to fix.
9376
9377 @itemize @bullet
9378 @item
9379 If a table field starts with a link, and if the corresponding table
9380 column is narrowed (@pxref{Narrow columns}) to a width too small to
9381 display the link, the field would look entirely empty even though it is
9382 not. To prevent this, Org throws an error. The work-around is to
9383 make the column wide enough to fit the link, or to add some text (at
9384 least 2 characters) before the link in the same field.
9385 @item
9386 Narrowing table columns does not work on XEmacs, because the
9387 @code{format} function does not transport text properties.
9388 @item
9389 Text in an entry protected with the @samp{QUOTE} keyword should not
9390 autowrap.
9391 @item
9392 When the application called by @kbd{C-c C-o} to open a file link fails
9393 (for example because the application does not exist or refuses to open
9394 the file), it does so silently. No error message is displayed.
9395 @item
9396 Recalculating a table line applies the formulas from left to right.
9397 If a formula uses @emph{calculated} fields further down the row,
9398 multiple recalculation may be needed to get all fields consistent. You
9399 may use the command @code{org-table-iterate} (@kbd{C-u C-c *}) to
9400 recalculate until convergence.
9401 @item
9402 The exporters work well, but could be made more efficient.
9403 @end itemize
9404
9405
9406 @node Extensions, Hacking, Miscellaneous, Top
9407 @appendix Extensions
9408
9409 This appendix lists the extension modules that have been written for Org.
9410 Many of these extensions live in the @file{contrib} directory of the Org
9411 distribution, others are available somewhere on the web.
9412
9413 @menu
9414 * Extensions in the contrib directory:: These come with the Org distro
9415 * Other extensions:: These you have to find on the web.
9416 @end menu
9417
9418 @node Extensions in the contrib directory, Other extensions, Extensions, Extensions
9419 @section Extensions in the @file{contrib} directory
9420
9421 A number of extension are distributed with Org when you download it from its
9422 homepage. Please note that these extensions are @emph{not} distributed as
9423 part of Emacs, so if you use Org as delivered with Emacs, you still need to
9424 go to @url{http://orgmode.org} to get access to these modules.
9425
9426 @table @asis
9427 @item @file{org-annotate-file.el} by @i{Philip Jackson}
9428 Annotate a file with org syntax, in a separate file, with links back to the
9429 annotated file.
9430
9431 @item @file{org-annotation-helper.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry and Daniel E. German}
9432 Call @i{remember} directly from Firefox/Opera, or from Adobe Reader. When
9433 activating a special link or bookmark, Emacs receives a trigger to create a
9434 note with a link back to the website. Requires some setup, a detailed
9435 description is in @file{contrib/packages/org-annotation-helper}.
9436
9437 @item @file{org-bookmark.el} by @i{Tokuya Kameshima}
9438 Support for links to Emacs bookmarks.
9439
9440 @item @file{org-depend.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9441 TODO dependencies for Org-mode. Make TODO state changes in one entry trigger
9442 changes in another, or be blocked by the state of another entry. Also,
9443 easily create chains of TODO items with exactly one active item at any time.
9444
9445 @item @file{org-elisp-symbol.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9446 Org links to emacs-lisp symbols. This can create annotated links that
9447 exactly point to the definition location of a variable of function.
9448
9449 @item @file{org-eval.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9450 The @code{<lisp>} tag, adapted from Emacs Wiki and Emacs Muse, allows text to
9451 be included in a document that is the result of evaluating some code. Other
9452 scripting languages like @code{perl} can be supported with this package as
9453 well.
9454
9455 @item @file{org-eval-light.el} by @i{Eric Schulte}
9456 User-controlled evaluation of code in an Org buffer.
9457
9458 @item @file{org-exp-blocks.el} by @i{Eric Schulte}
9459 Preprocess user-defined blocks for export.
9460
9461 @item @file{org-expiry.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9462 Expiry mechanism for Org entries.
9463
9464 @item @file{org-indent.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9465 Dynamic indentation of Org outlines. The plan is to indent an outline
9466 according to level, but so far this is too hard for a proper and stable
9467 implementation. Still, it works somewhat.
9468
9469 @item @file{org-interactive-query.el} by @i{Christopher League}
9470 Interactive modification of tags queries. After running a general query in
9471 Org, this package allows you to narrow down the results by adding more tags
9472 or keywords.
9473
9474 @item @file{org-mairix.el} by @i{Georg C. F. Greve}
9475 Hook mairix search into Org for different MUAs.
9476
9477 @item @file{org-man.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9478 Support for links to manpages in Org-mode.
9479
9480 @item @file{org-mtags.el} by @i{Carsten Dominik}
9481 Support for some Muse-like tags in Org-mode. This package allows you to
9482 write @code{<example>} and @code{<src>} and other syntax copied from Emacs
9483 Muse, right inside an Org file. The goal here is to make it easy to publish
9484 the same file using either org-publish or Muse.
9485
9486 @item @file{org-panel.el} by @i{Lennart Borgman}
9487 Simplified and display-aided access to some Org commands.
9488
9489 @item @file{org-registry.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9490 A registry for Org links, to find out from where links point to a given file
9491 or location.
9492
9493 @item @file{org2rem.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9494 Convert org appointments into reminders for the @file{remind} program.
9495
9496 @item @file{org-screen.el} by @i{Andrew Hyatt}
9497 Visit screen sessions through Org-mode links.
9498
9499 @item @file{org-toc.el} by @i{Bastien Guerry}
9500 Table of contents in a separate buffer, with fast access to sections and easy
9501 visibility cycling.
9502
9503 @item @file{orgtbl-sqlinsert.el} by @i{Jason Riedy}
9504 Convert Org-mode tables to SQL insertions. Documentation for this can be
9505 found on the Worg pages.
9506
9507 @end table
9508
9509 @node Other extensions, , Extensions in the contrib directory, Extensions
9510 @section Other extensions
9511
9512 @i{TO BE DONE}
9513
9514 @node Hacking, History and Acknowledgments, Extensions, Top
9515 @appendix Hacking
9516
9517 This appendix covers some aspects where users can extend the functionality of
9518 Org.
9519
9520 @menu
9521 * Adding hyperlink types:: New custom link types
9522 * Tables in arbitrary syntax:: Orgtbl for LaTeX and other programs
9523 * Dynamic blocks:: Automatically filled blocks
9524 * Special agenda views:: Customized views
9525 * Using the property API:: Writing programs that use entry properties
9526 * Using the mapping API:: Mapping over all or selected entries
9527 @end menu
9528
9529 @node Adding hyperlink types, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking, Hacking
9530 @section Adding hyperlink types
9531 @cindex hyperlinks, adding new types
9532
9533 Org has a large number of hyperlink types built-in
9534 (@pxref{Hyperlinks}). If you would like to add new link types, it
9535 provides an interface for doing so. Let's look at an example file
9536 @file{org-man.el} that will add support for creating links like
9537 @samp{[[man:printf][The printf manpage]]} to show Unix manual pages inside
9538 emacs:
9539
9540 @lisp
9541 ;;; org-man.el - Support for links to manpages in Org
9542
9543 (require 'org)
9544
9545 (org-add-link-type "man" 'org-man-open)
9546 (add-hook 'org-store-link-functions 'org-man-store-link)
9547
9548 (defcustom org-man-command 'man
9549 "The Emacs command to be used to display a man page."
9550 :group 'org-link
9551 :type '(choice (const man) (const woman)))
9552
9553 (defun org-man-open (path)
9554 "Visit the manpage on PATH.
9555 PATH should be a topic that can be thrown at the man command."
9556 (funcall org-man-command path))
9557
9558 (defun org-man-store-link ()
9559 "Store a link to a manpage."
9560 (when (memq major-mode '(Man-mode woman-mode))
9561 ;; This is a man page, we do make this link
9562 (let* ((page (org-man-get-page-name))
9563 (link (concat "man:" page))
9564 (description (format "Manpage for %s" page)))
9565 (org-store-link-props
9566 :type "man"
9567 :link link
9568 :description description))))
9569
9570 (defun org-man-get-page-name ()
9571 "Extract the page name from the buffer name."
9572 ;; This works for both `Man-mode' and `woman-mode'.
9573 (if (string-match " \\(\\S-+\\)\\*" (buffer-name))
9574 (match-string 1 (buffer-name))
9575 (error "Cannot create link to this man page")))
9576
9577 (provide 'org-man)
9578
9579 ;;; org-man.el ends here
9580 @end lisp
9581
9582 @noindent
9583 You would activate this new link type in @file{.emacs} with
9584
9585 @lisp
9586 (require 'org-man)
9587 @end lisp
9588
9589 @noindent
9590 Let's go through the file and see what it does.
9591 @enumerate
9592 @item
9593 It does @code{(require 'org)} to make sure that @file{org.el} has been
9594 loaded.
9595 @item
9596 The next line calls @code{org-add-link-type} to define a new link type
9597 with prefix @samp{man}. The call also contains the name of a function
9598 that will be called to follow such a link.
9599 @item
9600 The next line adds a function to @code{org-store-link-functions}, in
9601 order to allow the command @kbd{C-c l} to record a useful link in a
9602 buffer displaying a man page.
9603 @end enumerate
9604
9605 The rest of the file defines the necessary variables and functions.
9606 First there is a customization variable that determines which emacs
9607 command should be used to display man pages. There are two options,
9608 @code{man} and @code{woman}. Then the function to follow a link is
9609 defined. It gets the link path as an argument - in this case the link
9610 path is just a topic for the manual command. The function calls the
9611 value of @code{org-man-command} to display the man page.
9612
9613 Finally the function @code{org-man-store-link} is defined. When you try
9614 to store a link with @kbd{C-c l}, also this function will be called to
9615 try to make a link. The function must first decide if it is supposed to
9616 create the link for this buffer type, we do this by checking the value
9617 of the variable @code{major-mode}. If not, the function must exit and
9618 return the value @code{nil}. If yes, the link is created by getting the
9619 manual topic from the buffer name and prefixing it with the string
9620 @samp{man:}. Then it must call the command @code{org-store-link-props}
9621 and set the @code{:type} and @code{:link} properties. Optionally you
9622 can also set the @code{:description} property to provide a default for
9623 the link description when the link is later inserted into an Org
9624 buffer with @kbd{C-c C-l}.
9625
9626 @node Tables in arbitrary syntax, Dynamic blocks, Adding hyperlink types, Hacking
9627 @section Tables and lists in arbitrary syntax
9628 @cindex tables, in other modes
9629 @cindex lists, in other modes
9630 @cindex Orgtbl mode
9631
9632 Since Orgtbl mode can be used as a minor mode in arbitrary buffers, a
9633 frequent feature request has been to make it work with native tables in
9634 specific languages, for example La@TeX{}. However, this is extremely
9635 hard to do in a general way, would lead to a customization nightmare,
9636 and would take away much of the simplicity of the Orgtbl mode table
9637 editor.
9638
9639
9640 This appendix describes a different approach. We keep the Orgtbl mode
9641 table in its native format (the @i{source table}), and use a custom
9642 function to @i{translate} the table to the correct syntax, and to
9643 @i{install} it in the right location (the @i{target table}). This puts
9644 the burden of writing conversion functions on the user, but it allows
9645 for a very flexible system.
9646
9647 Bastien added the ability to do the same with lists. You can use Org's
9648 facilities to edit and structure lists by turning @code{orgstruct-mode}
9649 on, then locally exporting such lists in another format (HTML, La@TeX{}
9650 or Texinfo.)
9651
9652
9653 @menu
9654 * Radio tables:: Sending and receiving
9655 * A LaTeX example:: Step by step, almost a tutorial
9656 * Translator functions:: Copy and modify
9657 * Radio lists:: Doing the same for lists
9658 @end menu
9659
9660 @node Radio tables, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9661 @subsection Radio tables
9662 @cindex radio tables
9663
9664 To define the location of the target table, you first need to create two
9665 lines that are comments in the current mode, but contain magic words for
9666 Orgtbl mode to find. Orgtbl mode will insert the translated table
9667 between these lines, replacing whatever was there before. For example:
9668
9669 @example
9670 /* BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
9671 /* END RECEIVE ORGTBL table_name */
9672 @end example
9673
9674 @noindent
9675 Just above the source table, we put a special line that tells
9676 Orgtbl mode how to translate this table and where to install it. For
9677 example:
9678 @example
9679 #+ORGTBL: SEND table_name translation_function arguments....
9680 @end example
9681
9682 @noindent
9683 @code{table_name} is the reference name for the table that is also used
9684 in the receiver lines. @code{translation_function} is the Lisp function
9685 that does the translation. Furthermore, the line can contain a list of
9686 arguments (alternating key and value) at the end. The arguments will be
9687 passed as a property list to the translation function for
9688 interpretation. A few standard parameters are already recognized and
9689 acted upon before the translation function is called:
9690
9691 @table @code
9692 @item :skip N
9693 Skip the first N lines of the table. Hlines do count as separate lines for
9694 this parameter!
9695
9696 @item :skipcols (n1 n2 ...)
9697 List of columns that should be skipped. If the table has a column with
9698 calculation marks, that column is automatically discarded as well.
9699 Please note that the translator function sees the table @emph{after} the
9700 removal of these columns, the function never knows that there have been
9701 additional columns.
9702 @end table
9703
9704 @noindent
9705 The one problem remaining is how to keep the source table in the buffer
9706 without disturbing the normal workings of the file, for example during
9707 compilation of a C file or processing of a La@TeX{} file. There are a
9708 number of different solutions:
9709
9710 @itemize @bullet
9711 @item
9712 The table could be placed in a block comment if that is supported by the
9713 language. For example, in C mode you could wrap the table between
9714 @samp{/*} and @samp{*/} lines.
9715 @item
9716 Sometimes it is possible to put the table after some kind of @i{END}
9717 statement, for example @samp{\bye} in TeX and @samp{\end@{document@}}
9718 in La@TeX{}.
9719 @item
9720 You can just comment the table line by line whenever you want to process
9721 the file, and uncomment it whenever you need to edit the table. This
9722 only sounds tedious - the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-toggle-comment} does
9723 make this comment-toggling very easy, in particular if you bind it to a
9724 key.
9725 @end itemize
9726
9727 @node A LaTeX example, Translator functions, Radio tables, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9728 @subsection A LaTeX example of radio tables
9729 @cindex LaTeX, and Orgtbl mode
9730
9731 The best way to wrap the source table in La@TeX{} is to use the
9732 @code{comment} environment provided by @file{comment.sty}. It has to be
9733 activated by placing @code{\usepackage@{comment@}} into the document
9734 header. Orgtbl mode can insert a radio table skeleton@footnote{By
9735 default this works only for La@TeX{}, HTML, and Texinfo. Configure the
9736 variable @code{orgtbl-radio-tables} to install templates for other
9737 modes.} with the command @kbd{M-x orgtbl-insert-radio-table}. You will
9738 be prompted for a table name, let's say we use @samp{salesfigures}. You
9739 will then get the following template:
9740
9741 @cindex #+ORGTBL: SEND
9742 @example
9743 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9744 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9745 \begin@{comment@}
9746 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
9747 | | |
9748 \end@{comment@}
9749 @end example
9750
9751 @noindent
9752 The @code{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line tells Orgtbl mode to use the function
9753 @code{orgtbl-to-latex} to convert the table into La@TeX{} and to put it
9754 into the receiver location with name @code{salesfigures}. You may now
9755 fill in the table, feel free to use the spreadsheet features@footnote{If
9756 the @samp{#+TBLFM} line contains an odd number of dollar characters,
9757 this may cause problems with font-lock in LaTeX mode. As shown in the
9758 example you can fix this by adding an extra line inside the
9759 @code{comment} environment that is used to balance the dollar
9760 expressions. If you are using AUCTeX with the font-latex library, a
9761 much better solution is to add the @code{comment} environment to the
9762 variable @code{LaTeX-verbatim-environments}.}:
9763
9764 @example
9765 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9766 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9767 \begin@{comment@}
9768 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex
9769 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
9770 |-------+------+---------+---------|
9771 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
9772 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
9773 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
9774 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
9775 % $ (optional extra dollar to keep font-lock happy, see footnote)
9776 \end@{comment@}
9777 @end example
9778
9779 @noindent
9780 When you are done, press @kbd{C-c C-c} in the table to get the converted
9781 table inserted between the two marker lines.
9782
9783 Now let's assume you want to make the table header by hand, because you
9784 want to control how columns are aligned etc. In this case we make sure
9785 that the table translator does skip the first 2 lines of the source
9786 table, and tell the command to work as a @i{splice}, i.e. to not produce
9787 header and footer commands of the target table:
9788
9789 @example
9790 \begin@{tabular@}@{lrrr@}
9791 Month & \multicolumn@{1@}@{c@}@{Days@} & Nr.\ sold & per day\\
9792 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9793 % END RECEIVE ORGTBL salesfigures
9794 \end@{tabular@}
9795 %
9796 \begin@{comment@}
9797 #+ORGTBL: SEND salesfigures orgtbl-to-latex :splice t :skip 2
9798 | Month | Days | Nr sold | per day |
9799 |-------+------+---------+---------|
9800 | Jan | 23 | 55 | 2.4 |
9801 | Feb | 21 | 16 | 0.8 |
9802 | March | 22 | 278 | 12.6 |
9803 #+TBLFM: $4=$3/$2;%.1f
9804 \end@{comment@}
9805 @end example
9806
9807 The La@TeX{} translator function @code{orgtbl-to-latex} is already part of
9808 Orgtbl mode. It uses a @code{tabular} environment to typeset the table
9809 and marks horizontal lines with @code{\hline}. Furthermore, it
9810 interprets the following parameters (see also @ref{Translator functions}):
9811
9812 @table @code
9813 @item :splice nil/t
9814 When set to t, return only table body lines, don't wrap them into a
9815 tabular environment. Default is nil.
9816
9817 @item :fmt fmt
9818 A format to be used to wrap each field, should contain @code{%s} for the
9819 original field value. For example, to wrap each field value in dollars,
9820 you could use @code{:fmt "$%s$"}. This may also be a property list with
9821 column numbers and formats. for example @code{:fmt (2 "$%s$" 4 "%s\\%%")}.
9822 A function of one argument can be used in place of the strings; the
9823 function must return a formatted string.
9824
9825 @item :efmt efmt
9826 Use this format to print numbers with exponentials. The format should
9827 have @code{%s} twice for inserting mantissa and exponent, for example
9828 @code{"%s\\times10^@{%s@}"}. The default is @code{"%s\\,(%s)"}. This
9829 may also be a property list with column numbers and formats, for example
9830 @code{:efmt (2 "$%s\\times10^@{%s@}$" 4 "$%s\\cdot10^@{%s@}$")}. After
9831 @code{efmt} has been applied to a value, @code{fmt} will also be
9832 applied. Similar to @code{fmt}, functions of two arguments can be
9833 supplied instead of strings.
9834 @end table
9835
9836 @node Translator functions, Radio lists, A LaTeX example, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9837 @subsection Translator functions
9838 @cindex HTML, and Orgtbl mode
9839 @cindex translator function
9840
9841 Orgtbl mode has several translator functions built-in: @code{orgtbl-to-csv}
9842 (comma-separated values), @code{orgtbl-to-tsv} (TAB-separated values)
9843 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-html}, and @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}.
9844 Except for @code{orgtbl-to-html}@footnote{The HTML translator uses the same
9845 code that produces tables during HTML export.}, these all use a generic
9846 translator, @code{orgtbl-to-generic}. For example, @code{orgtbl-to-latex}
9847 itself is a very short function that computes the column definitions for the
9848 @code{tabular} environment, defines a few field and line separators and then
9849 hands over to the generic translator. Here is the entire code:
9850
9851 @lisp
9852 @group
9853 (defun orgtbl-to-latex (table params)
9854 "Convert the Orgtbl mode TABLE to LaTeX."
9855 (let* ((alignment (mapconcat (lambda (x) (if x "r" "l"))
9856 org-table-last-alignment ""))
9857 (params2
9858 (list
9859 :tstart (concat "\\begin@{tabular@}@{" alignment "@}")
9860 :tend "\\end@{tabular@}"
9861 :lstart "" :lend " \\\\" :sep " & "
9862 :efmt "%s\\,(%s)" :hline "\\hline")))
9863 (orgtbl-to-generic table (org-combine-plists params2 params))))
9864 @end group
9865 @end lisp
9866
9867 As you can see, the properties passed into the function (variable
9868 @var{PARAMS}) are combined with the ones newly defined in the function
9869 (variable @var{PARAMS2}). The ones passed into the function (i.e. the
9870 ones set by the @samp{ORGTBL SEND} line) take precedence. So if you
9871 would like to use the La@TeX{} translator, but wanted the line endings to
9872 be @samp{\\[2mm]} instead of the default @samp{\\}, you could just
9873 overrule the default with
9874
9875 @example
9876 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-latex :lend " \\\\[2mm]"
9877 @end example
9878
9879 For a new language, you can either write your own converter function in
9880 analogy with the La@TeX{} translator, or you can use the generic function
9881 directly. For example, if you have a language where a table is started
9882 with @samp{!BTBL!}, ended with @samp{!ETBL!}, and where table lines are
9883 started with @samp{!BL!}, ended with @samp{!EL!} and where the field
9884 separator is a TAB, you could call the generic translator like this (on
9885 a single line!):
9886
9887 @example
9888 #+ORGTBL: SEND test orgtbl-to-generic :tstart "!BTBL!" :tend "!ETBL!"
9889 :lstart "!BL! " :lend " !EL!" :sep "\t"
9890 @end example
9891
9892 @noindent
9893 Please check the documentation string of the function
9894 @code{orgtbl-to-generic} for a full list of parameters understood by
9895 that function and remember that you can pass each of them into
9896 @code{orgtbl-to-latex}, @code{orgtbl-to-texinfo}, and any other function
9897 using the generic function.
9898
9899 Of course you can also write a completely new function doing complicated
9900 things the generic translator cannot do. A translator function takes
9901 two arguments. The first argument is the table, a list of lines, each
9902 line either the symbol @code{hline} or a list of fields. The second
9903 argument is the property list containing all parameters specified in the
9904 @samp{#+ORGTBL: SEND} line. The function must return a single string
9905 containing the formatted table. If you write a generally useful
9906 translator, please post it on @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} so that
9907 others can benefit from your work.
9908
9909 @node Radio lists, , Translator functions, Tables in arbitrary syntax
9910 @subsection Radio lists
9911 @cindex radio lists
9912 @cindex org-list-insert-radio-list
9913
9914 Sending and receiving radio lists works exactly the same way than
9915 sending and receiving radio tables (@pxref{Radio tables}) @footnote{You
9916 need to load the @code{org-export-latex.el} package to use radio lists
9917 since the relevant code is there for now.}. As for radio tables, you
9918 can insert radio lists templates in HTML, La@TeX{} and Texinfo modes by
9919 calling @code{org-list-insert-radio-list}.
9920
9921 Here are the differences with radio tables:
9922
9923 @itemize @minus
9924 @item
9925 Use @code{ORGLST} instead of @code{ORGTBL}.
9926 @item
9927 The available translation functions for radio lists don't take
9928 parameters.
9929 @item
9930 `C-c C-c' will work when pressed on the first item of the list.
9931 @end itemize
9932
9933 Here is a La@TeX{} example. Let's say that you have this in your
9934 La@TeX{} file:
9935
9936 @example
9937 % BEGIN RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
9938 % END RECEIVE ORGLST to-buy
9939 \begin@{comment@}
9940 #+ORGLIST: SEND to-buy orgtbl-to-latex
9941 - a new house
9942 - a new computer
9943 + a new keyboard
9944 + a new mouse
9945 - a new life
9946 \end@{comment@}
9947 @end example
9948
9949 Pressing `C-c C-c' on @code{a new house} and will insert the converted
9950 La@TeX{} list between the two marker lines.
9951
9952 @node Dynamic blocks, Special agenda views, Tables in arbitrary syntax, Hacking
9953 @section Dynamic blocks
9954 @cindex dynamic blocks
9955
9956 Org documents can contain @emph{dynamic blocks}. These are
9957 specially marked regions that are updated by some user-written function.
9958 A good example for such a block is the clock table inserted by the
9959 command @kbd{C-c C-x C-r} (@pxref{Clocking work time}).
9960
9961 Dynamic block are enclosed by a BEGIN-END structure that assigns a name
9962 to the block and can also specify parameters for the function producing
9963 the content of the block.
9964
9965 #+BEGIN:dynamic block
9966 @example
9967 #+BEGIN: myblock :parameter1 value1 :parameter2 value2 ...
9968
9969 #+END:
9970 @end example
9971
9972 Dynamic blocks are updated with the following commands
9973
9974 @table @kbd
9975 @kindex C-c C-x C-u
9976 @item C-c C-x C-u
9977 Update dynamic block at point.
9978 @kindex C-u C-c C-x C-u
9979 @item C-u C-c C-x C-u
9980 Update all dynamic blocks in the current file.
9981 @end table
9982
9983 Updating a dynamic block means to remove all the text between BEGIN and
9984 END, parse the BEGIN line for parameters and then call the specific
9985 writer function for this block to insert the new content. If you want
9986 to use the original content in the writer function, you can use the
9987 extra parameter @code{:content}.
9988
9989 For a block with name @code{myblock}, the writer function is
9990 @code{org-dblock-write:myblock} with as only parameter a property list
9991 with the parameters given in the begin line. Here is a trivial example
9992 of a block that keeps track of when the block update function was last
9993 run:
9994
9995 @example
9996 #+BEGIN: block-update-time :format "on %m/%d/%Y at %H:%M"
9997
9998 #+END:
9999 @end example
10000
10001 @noindent
10002 The corresponding block writer function could look like this:
10003
10004 @lisp
10005 (defun org-dblock-write:block-update-time (params)
10006 (let ((fmt (or (plist-get params :format) "%d. %m. %Y")))
10007 (insert "Last block update at: "
10008 (format-time-string fmt (current-time)))))
10009 @end lisp
10010
10011 If you want to make sure that all dynamic blocks are always up-to-date,
10012 you could add the function @code{org-update-all-dblocks} to a hook, for
10013 example @code{before-save-hook}. @code{org-update-all-dblocks} is
10014 written in a way that is does nothing in buffers that are not in
10015 @code{org-mode}.
10016
10017 @node Special agenda views, Using the property API, Dynamic blocks, Hacking
10018 @section Special agenda views
10019 @cindex agenda views, user-defined
10020
10021 Org provides a special hook that can be used to narrow down the
10022 selection made by any of the agenda views. You may specify a function
10023 that is used at each match to verify if the match should indeed be part
10024 of the agenda view, and if not, how much should be skipped.
10025
10026 Let's say you want to produce a list of projects that contain a WAITING
10027 tag anywhere in the project tree. Let's further assume that you have
10028 marked all tree headings that define a project with the TODO keyword
10029 PROJECT. In this case you would run a TODO search for the keyword
10030 PROJECT, but skip the match unless there is a WAITING tag anywhere in
10031 the subtree belonging to the project line.
10032
10033 To achieve this, you must write a function that searches the subtree for
10034 the tag. If the tag is found, the function must return @code{nil} to
10035 indicate that this match should not be skipped. If there is no such
10036 tag, return the location of the end of the subtree, to indicate that
10037 search should continue from there.
10038
10039 @lisp
10040 (defun my-skip-unless-waiting ()
10041 "Skip trees that are not waiting"
10042 (let ((subtree-end (save-excursion (org-end-of-subtree t))))
10043 (if (re-search-forward ":waiting:" subtree-end t)
10044 nil ; tag found, do not skip
10045 subtree-end))) ; tag not found, continue after end of subtree
10046 @end lisp
10047
10048 Now you may use this function in an agenda custom command, for example
10049 like this:
10050
10051 @lisp
10052 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
10053 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
10054 ((org-agenda-skip-function 'my-skip-unless-waiting)
10055 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
10056 @end lisp
10057
10058 Note that this also binds @code{org-agenda-overriding-header} to get a
10059 meaningful header in the agenda view.
10060
10061 A general way to create custom searches is to base them on a search for
10062 entries with a certain level limit. If you want to study all entries with
10063 your custom search function, simply do a search for @samp{LEVEL>0}, and then
10064 use @code{org-agenda-skip-function} to select the entries you really want to
10065 have.
10066
10067 You may also put a Lisp form into @code{org-agenda-skip-function}. In
10068 particular, you may use the functions @code{org-agenda-skip-entry-if}
10069 and @code{org-agenda-skip-subtree-if} in this form, for example:
10070
10071 @table @code
10072 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled)
10073 Skip current entry if it has been scheduled.
10074 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'notscheduled)
10075 Skip current entry if it has not been scheduled.
10076 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'deadline)
10077 Skip current entry if it has a deadline.
10078 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry-if 'scheduled 'deadline)
10079 Skip current entry if it has a deadline, or if it is scheduled.
10080 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'regexp "regular expression")
10081 Skip current entry if the regular expression matches in the entry.
10082 @item '(org-agenda-skip-entry 'notregexp "regular expression")
10083 Skip current entry unless the regular expression matches.
10084 @item '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if 'regexp "regular expression")
10085 Same as above, but check and skip the entire subtree.
10086 @end table
10087
10088 Therefore we could also have written the search for WAITING projects
10089 like this, even without defining a special function:
10090
10091 @lisp
10092 (org-add-agenda-custom-command
10093 '("b" todo "PROJECT"
10094 ((org-agenda-skip-function '(org-agenda-skip-subtree-if
10095 'regexp ":waiting:"))
10096 (org-agenda-overriding-header "Projects waiting for something: "))))
10097 @end lisp
10098
10099 @node Using the property API, Using the mapping API, Special agenda views, Hacking
10100 @section Using the property API
10101 @cindex API, for properties
10102 @cindex properties, API
10103
10104 Here is a description of the functions that can be used to work with
10105 properties.
10106
10107 @defun org-entry-properties &optional pom which
10108 Get all properties of the entry at point-or-marker POM.
10109 This includes the TODO keyword, the tags, time strings for deadline,
10110 scheduled, and clocking, and any additional properties defined in the
10111 entry. The return value is an alist, keys may occur multiple times
10112 if the property key was used several times.
10113 POM may also be nil, in which case the current entry is used.
10114 If WHICH is nil or `all', get all properties. If WHICH is
10115 `special' or `standard', only get that subclass.
10116 @end defun
10117 @defun org-entry-get pom property &optional inherit
10118 Get value of PROPERTY for entry at point-or-marker POM. By default,
10119 this only looks at properties defined locally in the entry. If INHERIT
10120 is non-nil and the entry does not have the property, then also check
10121 higher levels of the hierarchy. If INHERIT is the symbol
10122 @code{selective}, use inheritance if and only if the setting of
10123 @code{org-use-property-inheritance} selects PROPERTY for inheritance.
10124 @end defun
10125
10126 @defun org-entry-delete pom property
10127 Delete the property PROPERTY from entry at point-or-marker POM.
10128 @end defun
10129
10130 @defun org-entry-put pom property value
10131 Set PROPERTY to VALUE for entry at point-or-marker POM.
10132 @end defun
10133
10134 @defun org-buffer-property-keys &optional include-specials
10135 Get all property keys in the current buffer.
10136 @end defun
10137
10138 @defun org-insert-property-drawer
10139 Insert a property drawer at point.
10140 @end defun
10141
10142 @defun org-entry-put-multivalued-property pom property &rest values
10143 Set PROPERTY at point-or-marker POM to VALUES. VALUES should be a list of
10144 strings. They will be concatenated, with spaces as separators.
10145 @end defun
10146
10147 @defun org-entry-get-multivalued-property pom property
10148 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
10149 values and return the values as a list of strings.
10150 @end defun
10151
10152 @defun org-entry-add-to-multivalued-property pom property value
10153 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
10154 values and make sure that VALUE is in this list.
10155 @end defun
10156
10157 @defun org-entry-remove-from-multivalued-property pom property value
10158 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
10159 values and make sure that VALUE is @emph{not} in this list.
10160 @end defun
10161
10162 @defun org-entry-member-in-multivalued-property pom property value
10163 Treat the value of the property PROPERTY as a whitespace-separated list of
10164 values and check if VALUE is in this list.
10165 @end defun
10166
10167 @node Using the mapping API, , Using the property API, Hacking
10168 @section Using the mapping API
10169 @cindex API, for mapping
10170 @cindex mapping entries, API
10171
10172 Org has sophisticated mapping capabilities to find all entries satisfying
10173 certain criteria. Internally, this functionality is used to produce agenda
10174 views, but there is also an API that can be used to execute arbitrary
10175 functions for each or selected entries. The main entry point for this API
10176 is:
10177
10178 @defun org-map-entries func &optional match scope &rest skip
10179 Call FUNC at each headline selected by MATCH in SCOPE.
10180
10181 FUNC is a function or a lisp form. The function will be called without
10182 arguments, with the cursor positioned at the beginning of the headline.
10183 The return values of all calls to the function will be collected and
10184 returned as a list.
10185
10186 MATCH is a tags/property/todo match as it is used in the agenda match view.
10187 Only headlines that are matched by this query will be considered during
10188 the iteration. When MATCH is nil or t, all headlines will be
10189 visited by the iteration.
10190
10191 SCOPE determines the scope of this command. It can be any of:
10192
10193 @example
10194 nil @r{the current buffer, respecting the restriction if any}
10195 tree @r{the subtree started with the entry at point}
10196 file @r{the current buffer, without restriction}
10197 file-with-archives
10198 @r{the current buffer, and any archives associated with it}
10199 agenda @r{all agenda files}
10200 agenda-with-archives
10201 @r{all agenda files with any archive files associated with them}
10202 (file1 file2 ...)
10203 @r{if this is a list, all files in the list will be scanned}
10204 @end example
10205
10206 The remaining args are treated as settings for the skipping facilities of
10207 the scanner. The following items can be given here:
10208
10209 @example
10210 archive @r{skip trees with the archive tag}
10211 comment @r{skip trees with the COMMENT keyword}
10212 function or Lisp form
10213 @r{will be used as value for @code{org-agenda-skip-function},}
10214 @r{so whenever the the function returns t, FUNC}
10215 @r{will not be called for that entry and search will}
10216 @r{continue from the point where the function leaves it}
10217 @end example
10218 @end defun
10219
10220 The function given to that mapping routine can really do anything you like.
10221 It can use the property API (@pxref{Using the property API}) to gather more
10222 information about the entry, or in order to change metadata in the entry.
10223 Here are a couple of functions that might be handy:
10224
10225 @defun org-todo &optional arg
10226 Change the TODO state of the entry, see the docstring of the functions for
10227 the many possible values for the argument ARG.
10228 @end defun
10229
10230 @defun org-priority &optional action
10231 Change the priority of the entry, see the docstring of this function for the
10232 possible values for ACTION.
10233 @end defun
10234
10235 @defun org-toggle-tag tag &optional onoff
10236 Toggle the tag TAG in the current entry. Setting ONOFF to either @code{on}
10237 or @code{off} will not toggle tag, but ensure that it is either on or off.
10238 @end defun
10239
10240 @defun org-promote
10241 Promote the current entry.
10242 @end defun
10243
10244 @defun org-demote
10245 Demote the current entry.
10246 @end defun
10247
10248 Here is a simple example that will turn all entries in the current file with
10249 a tag @code{TOMORROW} into TODO entries with the keyword @code{UPCOMING}.
10250 Entries in comment trees and in archive trees will be ignored.
10251
10252 @lisp
10253 (org-map-entries
10254 '(org-todo "UPCOMING")
10255 "+TOMORROW" 'file 'archive 'comment)
10256 @end lisp
10257
10258 The following example counts the number of entries with TODO keyword
10259 @code{WAITING}, in all agenda files.
10260
10261 @lisp
10262 (length (org-map-entries t "/+WAITING" 'agenda))
10263 @end lisp
10264
10265 @node History and Acknowledgments, Main Index, Hacking, Top
10266 @appendix History and Acknowledgments
10267 @cindex acknowledgments
10268 @cindex history
10269 @cindex thanks
10270
10271 Org was borne in 2003, out of frustration over the user interface
10272 of the Emacs Outline mode. I was trying to organize my notes and
10273 projects, and using Emacs seemed to be the natural way to go. However,
10274 having to remember eleven different commands with two or three keys per
10275 command, only to hide and show parts of the outline tree, that seemed
10276 entirely unacceptable to me. Also, when using outlines to take notes, I
10277 constantly want to restructure the tree, organizing it parallel to my
10278 thoughts and plans. @emph{Visibility cycling} and @emph{structure
10279 editing} were originally implemented in the package
10280 @file{outline-magic.el}, but quickly moved to the more general
10281 @file{org.el}. As this environment became comfortable for project
10282 planning, the next step was adding @emph{TODO entries}, basic @emph{time
10283 stamps}, and @emph{table support}. These areas highlight the two main
10284 goals that Org still has today: To create a new, outline-based,
10285 plain text mode with innovative and intuitive editing features, and to
10286 incorporate project planning functionality directly into a notes file.
10287
10288 A special thanks goes to @i{Bastien Guerry} who has not only written a large
10289 number of extensions to Org (most of them integrated into the core by now),
10290 but has also helped the development and maintenance of Org so much that he
10291 should be considered the main co-contributor to this package.
10292
10293 Since the first release, literally thousands of emails to me or on
10294 @code{emacs-orgmode@@gnu.org} have provided a constant stream of bug
10295 reports, feedback, new ideas, and sometimes patches and add-on code.
10296 Many thanks to everyone who has helped to improve this package. I am
10297 trying to keep here a list of the people who had significant influence
10298 in shaping one or more aspects of Org. The list may not be
10299 complete, if I have forgotten someone, please accept my apologies and
10300 let me know.
10301
10302 @itemize @bullet
10303
10304 @item
10305 @i{Russel Adams} came up with the idea for drawers.
10306 @item
10307 @i{Thomas Baumann} wrote @file{org-bbdb.el} and @file{org-mhe.el}.
10308 @item
10309 @i{Christophe Bataillon} created the great unicorn logo that we use on the
10310 Org-mode website.
10311 @item
10312 @i{Alex Bochannek} provided a patch for rounding time stamps.
10313 @item
10314 @i{Charles Cave}'s suggestion sparked the implementation of templates
10315 for Remember.
10316 @item
10317 @i{Pavel Chalmoviansky} influenced the agenda treatment of items with
10318 specified time.
10319 @item
10320 @i{Gregory Chernov} patched support for lisp forms into table
10321 calculations and improved XEmacs compatibility, in particular by porting
10322 @file{nouline.el} to XEmacs.
10323 @item
10324 @i{Sacha Chua} suggested to copy some linking code from Planner.
10325 @item
10326 @i{Eddward DeVilla} proposed and tested checkbox statistics. He also
10327 came up with the idea of properties, and that there should be an API for
10328 them.
10329 @item
10330 @i{Kees Dullemond} used to edit projects lists directly in HTML and so
10331 inspired some of the early development, including HTML export. He also
10332 asked for a way to narrow wide table columns.
10333 @item
10334 @i{Christian Egli} converted the documentation into Texinfo format,
10335 patched CSS formatting into the HTML exporter, and inspired the agenda.
10336 @item
10337 @i{David Emery} provided a patch for custom CSS support in exported
10338 HTML agendas.
10339 @item
10340 @i{Nic Ferrier} contributed mailcap and XOXO support.
10341 @item
10342 @i{Miguel A. Figueroa-Villanueva} implemented hierarchical checkboxes.
10343 @item
10344 @i{John Foerch} figured out how to make incremental search show context
10345 around a match in a hidden outline tree.
10346 @item
10347 @i{Niels Giesen} had the idea to automatically archive DONE trees.
10348 @item
10349 @i{Bastien Guerry} wrote the La@TeX{} exporter and @file{org-bibtex.el}, and
10350 has been prolific with patches, ideas, and bug reports.
10351 @item
10352 @i{Kai Grossjohann} pointed out key-binding conflicts with other packages.
10353 @item
10354 @i{Bernt Hansen} has driven much of the support for auto-repeating tasks,
10355 task state change logging, and the clocktable. His clear explanations have
10356 been critical when we started to adopt the GIT version control system.
10357 @item
10358 @i{Manuel Hermenegildo} has contributed various ideas, small fixed and
10359 patches.
10360 @item
10361 @i{Phil Jackson} wrote @file{org-irc.el}.
10362 @item
10363 @i{Scott Jaderholm} proposed footnotes, control over whitespace between
10364 folded entries, and column view for properties.
10365 @item
10366 @i{Tokuya Kameshima} wrote @file{org-wl.el} and @file{org-mew.el}.
10367 @item
10368 @i{Shidai Liu} ("Leo") asked for embedded La@TeX{} and tested it. He also
10369 provided frequent feedback and some patches.
10370 @item
10371 @i{Matt Lundin} has proposed last-row references for table formulas and named
10372 invisible anchors. He has also worked a lot on the FAQ.
10373 @item
10374 @i{Jason F. McBrayer} suggested agenda export to CSV format.
10375 @item
10376 @i{Max Mikhanosha} came up with the idea of refiling.
10377 @item
10378 @i{Dmitri Minaev} sent a patch to set priority limits on a per-file
10379 basis.
10380 @item
10381 @i{Stefan Monnier} provided a patch to keep the Emacs-Lisp compiler
10382 happy.
10383 @item
10384 @i{Rick Moynihan} proposed to allow multiple TODO sequences in a file
10385 and to be able to quickly restrict the agenda to a subtree.
10386 @item
10387 @i{Todd Neal} provided patches for links to Info files and elisp forms.
10388 @item
10389 @i{Tim O'Callaghan} suggested in-file links, search options for general
10390 file links, and TAGS.
10391 @item
10392 @i{Takeshi Okano} translated the manual and David O'Toole's tutorial
10393 into Japanese.
10394 @item
10395 @i{Oliver Oppitz} suggested multi-state TODO items.
10396 @item
10397 @i{Scott Otterson} sparked the introduction of descriptive text for
10398 links, among other things.
10399 @item
10400 @i{Pete Phillips} helped during the development of the TAGS feature, and
10401 provided frequent feedback.
10402 @item
10403 @i{T.V. Raman} reported bugs and suggested improvements.
10404 @item
10405 @i{Matthias Rempe} (Oelde) provided ideas, Windows support, and quality
10406 control.
10407 @item
10408 @i{Paul Rivier} provided the basic implementation of named footnotes.
10409 @item
10410 @i{Kevin Rogers} contributed code to access VM files on remote hosts.
10411 @item
10412 @i{Sebastian Rose} wrote @file{org-info.js}, a Java script for displaying
10413 webpages derived from Org using an Info-like, or a folding interface with
10414 single key navigation.
10415 @item
10416 @i{Frank Ruell} solved the mystery of the @code{keymapp nil} bug, a
10417 conflict with @file{allout.el}.
10418 @item
10419 @i{Jason Riedy} generalized the send-receive mechanism for orgtbl tables with
10420 extensive patches.
10421 @item
10422 @i{Philip Rooke} created the Org reference card, provided lots
10423 of feedback, developed and applied standards to the Org documentation.
10424 @item
10425 @i{Christian Schlauer} proposed angular brackets around links, among
10426 other things.
10427 @item
10428 @i{Eric Schulte} wrote @file{org-plot.el}.
10429 @item
10430 Linking to VM/BBDB/Gnus was first inspired by @i{Tom Shannon}'s
10431 @file{organizer-mode.el}.
10432 @item
10433 @i{Ilya Shlyakhter} proposed the Archive Sibling, line numbering in literal
10434 examples, and remote highlighting for referenced code lines.
10435 @item
10436 @i{Stathis Sideris} wrote the @file{ditaa.jar} ASCII to PNG converter that is
10437 now packaged into Org's @file{contrib} directory.
10438 @item
10439 @i{Daniel Sinder} came up with the idea of internal archiving by locking
10440 subtrees.
10441 @item
10442 @i{Dale Smith} proposed link abbreviations.
10443 @item
10444 @i{James TD Smith} has contributed a large number of patches for useful
10445 tweaks and features.
10446 @item
10447 @i{Adam Spiers} asked for global linking commands, inspired the link
10448 extension system, added support for mairix, and proposed the mapping API.
10449 @item
10450 @i{Andy Stewart} contributed code to @file{org-w3m.el}, to copy HTML content
10451 with links transformation to Org syntax.
10452 @item
10453 @i{David O'Toole} wrote @file{org-publish.el} and drafted the manual
10454 chapter about publishing.
10455 @item
10456 @i{J@"urgen Vollmer} contributed code generating the table of contents
10457 in HTML output.
10458 @item
10459 @i{Chris Wallace} provided a patch implementing the @samp{QUOTE}
10460 keyword.
10461 @item
10462 @i{David Wainberg} suggested archiving, and improvements to the linking
10463 system.
10464 @item
10465 @i{John Wiegley} wrote @file{emacs-wiki.el}, @file{planner.el}, and
10466 @file{muse.el}, which have some overlap with Org. Initially the development
10467 of Org was fully independent because I was not aware of the existence of
10468 these packages. But with time I have occasionally looked at John's code and
10469 learned a lot from it. John has also contributed a number of great ideas and
10470 patches directly to Org, including the attachment system
10471 (@file{org-attach.el}), integration with Apple Mail
10472 (@file{org-mac-message.el}), and hierarchical dependencies of TODO items.
10473 @item
10474 @i{Carsten Wimmer} suggested some changes and helped fix a bug in
10475 linking to Gnus.
10476 @item
10477 @i{Roland Winkler} requested additional key bindings to make Org
10478 work on a tty.
10479 @item
10480 @i{Piotr Zielinski} wrote @file{org-mouse.el}, proposed agenda blocks
10481 and contributed various ideas and code snippets.
10482 @end itemize
10483
10484
10485 @node Main Index, Key Index, History and Acknowledgments, Top
10486 @unnumbered The Main Index
10487
10488 @printindex cp
10489
10490 @node Key Index, , Main Index, Top
10491 @unnumbered Key Index
10492
10493 @printindex ky
10494
10495 @bye
10496
10497 @ignore
10498 arch-tag: 7893d1Fe-cc57-4d13-b5e5-f494a1CBC7ac
10499 @end ignore
10500
10501 @c Local variables:
10502 @c ispell-local-dictionary: "en_US-w_accents"
10503 @c ispell-local-pdict: "./.aspell.org.pws"
10504 @c fill-column: 77
10505 @c End:
10506